Tupperware Brands
Annual Report 2006

Plain-text annual report

TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORP FORM 10-K (Annual Report) Filed 2/28/2007 For Period Ending 12/30/2006 Address 14901 S ORANGE BLOSSOM TRAIL ORLANDO, Florida 32837-6600 Telephone (407) 826-5050 CIK Industry Sector 0001008654 Personal & Household Prods. Consumer/Non-Cyclical Fiscal Year 12/31 Table of Contents UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION Washington, D.C. 20549 FORM 10-K (Mark One)     ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the fiscal year ended December 30, 2006 OR (cid:3)(cid:3)(cid:3)(cid:3) TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the transition period from to Commission file number 1-11657 TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) Delaware (State of incorporation) 14901 South Orange Blossom Trail, Orlando, Florida (Address of principal executive offices) 36-4062333 (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 32837 (Zip Code) Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (407) 826-5050 Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: Title of Each Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered New York Stock Exchange Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes  No (cid:3) Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes (cid:3) No  Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes  No (cid:3) Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. (cid:3) Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one): Large accelerated filer  Accelerated filer (cid:3) Non-accelerated filer (cid:3) Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.): Yes (cid:3) No  The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates computed by reference to the average bid and asked price ($19.80) of such common equity on the New York Stock Exchange-Composite Transaction Listing on June 30, 2006 (the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter) was $1,173,559,642.20. As of February 26, 2007, 61,026,120 shares of the Common Stock, $0.01 par value, of the Registrant were outstanding. Documents Incorporated by Reference: Portions of the Proxy Statement relating to the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held May 16, 2007 are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Report. Table of Contents Item Item 1 Business Item 1a Risk Factors Item 1b Unresolved Staff Comments Item 2 Properties Item 3 Legal Proceedings Item 4 Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders Table of Contents Part I Page Part II Item 5 Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Item 5a Stock Performance Graph Item 5c Changes in Securities, Use of Proceeds and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Item 6 Selected Financial Data Item 7 Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations Item 7a Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk Item 8 Financial Statements and Supplementary Data Item 9 Changes In and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure Item 9a Controls and Procedures Item 9b Other Information Item 10 Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant Item 11 Executive Compensation Item 12 Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters Item 13 Certain Relationships and Related Transactions Item 14 Principal Accounting Fees and Services Part III Item 15 Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules 15 (a)(1) List of Financial Statements 15 (a)(2) List of Financial Statement Schedule 15 (a)(3) Index to Exhibits Signatures Part IV 2 3 9 10 10 10 11 12 12 13 14 17 39 80 80 82 82 82 82 82 82 82 82 83 83 86 Table of Contents Item 1. Business (a) General Development of Business PART I Tupperware Brands Corporation (“Registrant”, “Tupperware Brands” or the “Company”), is a global direct seller of premium, innovative products across multiple brands and categories through an independent sales force of approximately 1.9 million. Product brands and categories include design-centric preparation, storage and serving solutions for the kitchen and home through the Tupperware ® brand and beauty and personal care products through its Avroy Shlain ® , BeautiControl ® , Fuller ® , NaturCare ® , Nutrimetics ® , Nuvo ® and Swissgarde ® brands. The Registrant is a Delaware corporation that was organized on February 8, 1996 in connection with the corporate reorganization of Premark International, Inc. (“Premark”). In the reorganization, certain businesses of the Registrant and certain other assets and liabilities of Premark and its subsidiaries were transferred to the Registrant. On May 31, 1996, the Registrant became a publicly held company through the pro rata distribution by Premark to its shareholders of all of the then outstanding shares of common stock of the Registrant. Prior to December 5, 2005, the Registrant’s name was Tupperware Corporation. On October 18, 2000, the Registrant acquired 100 percent of the stock of BeautiControl, Inc. (“BeautiControl”) and on December 5, 2005, the Registrant acquired the direct selling businesses of Sara Lee Corporation (the “Acquisition” or the “Acquired Units”). This acquisition was made to advance the strategy, begun with the acquisition of BeautiControl in 2000, of adding consumable items to the product category mix by expanding into beauty and personal care products. (b) New York Stock Exchange—Required Disclosures General. The address of the Registrant’s principal office is 14901 S. Orange Blossom Trail, Orlando, Florida 32837. The names of the Registrant’s directors are Catherine A. Bertini, Rita Bornstein, Kriss Cloninger, III, E.V. Goings, Clifford J. Grum, Joe R. Lee, Bob Marbut, Angel R. Martinez, Robert J. Murray, David R. Parker, Joyce M. Roché, J. Patrick Spainhour and M. Anne Szostak. Members of the Audit, Finance and Corporate Responsibility Committee of the Board of Directors are Dr. Bornstein and Messrs. Cloninger (Chair), Grum, Martinez, Murray and Spainhour. The members of the Compensation and Management Development Committee of the Board of Directors are Ms. Bertini, Ms. Roché, Ms. Szostak (Chair), and Messrs. Lee, Marbut and Parker. The members of the Nominating and Governance Committee of the Board of Directors are Ms. Roché, Ms. Szostak, and Messrs. Parker (Chair), Cloninger, Grum and Murray. The members of the Executive Committee of the Board of Directors are Ms. Szostak and Messrs. Goings (Chair), Cloninger and Parker. The Chairman and Chief Executive Officer is E.V. Goings and the Presiding Director is David R. Parker. The Registrant’s officers and the number of its employees are set forth below in Part I of this Report. The name and address of the Registrant’s transfer agent and registrar is Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., c/o Wells Fargo Shareowner Services, 161 North Concord Exchange, South St. Paul, MN 55075. The number of the Registrant’s shareholders is set forth below in Part II, Item 5 of this Report. The Registrant is satisfying its annual distribution requirement to shareholders under the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) rules by the distribution of its Annual Report on Form 10-K as filed with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) in lieu of a separate annual report. Corporate Governance. Investors can obtain access to periodic reports and corporate governance documents, including board committee charters, corporate governance principles and codes of conduct and ethics for financial executives, and the Registrant’s transfer agent and registrar through the Registrant’s website free of charge (as soon as reasonably practicable after reports are filed with the SEC in the case of periodic reports) by going to www.tupperwarebrands.com and searching under Investor Relations / SEC Filings and Governance Documents. Such information, which is provided for convenience but is not incorporated by reference into this Report, is available in print to any shareholder who requests it in writing from the Corporate Secretary’s Department, Tupperware Brands Corporation, P.O. Box 2353, Orlando, Florida 32802-2353. The Chief Executive Officer of the Registrant has certified to the NYSE that he is not aware of any violation by the Registrant of NYSE corporate governance listing standards. The Registrant’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief 3 Table of Contents Financial Officer have filed with the SEC their respective certifications in Exhibits 31.1, 31.2, 32.1 and 32.2 of this Report in response to Sections 302 and 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. BUSINESS OF TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION The Registrant is a worldwide direct selling consumer products company engaged in the manufacture and sale of Tupperware ® products and cosmetics and personal care products under a variety of trade names, including Avroy Shlain ® , BeautiControl ® , Fuller ® , NatureCare ® , Nutrimetics ® , Nuvo Cosmeticos ® and Swissgarde ® . Each business manufactures and/or markets a broad line of high quality products. I. PRINCIPAL PRODUCTS Tupperware. The core of Tupperware’s product line consists of food storage, serving and preparation products. Tupperware also has an established line of kitchen tools, children’s educational toys, microwave products and gifts. The line of Tupperware products has expanded over the years with products such as Modular Mates*, FridgeSmart*, One Touch* canisters, the Rock ‘N Serve* microwave line, OvenWorks* and silicon baking forms for microwave or oven use, Open House and Elegant serving lines, the Chef Series* knives and cookware, Flat Out*, Stuffables* and CheeseSmart* storage containers, plus many specialized products for kitchen and home. Tupperware continues to introduce new designs, colors and decoration in its product lines, to vary its product offerings by season and to extend existing products into new markets around the world. The development of new products varies in different markets in order to address differences in cultures, lifestyles, tastes and needs of the markets. New products introduced in 2006 included a wide range of products in all three of Tupperware’s geographic areas, covering both core business areas and new categories. Among these new products were the Happy Chopper, BreadSmart*, Full Contact* and the Outdoor Dining product line. New product development and introduction will continue to be an important part of Tupperware’s strategy. Beauty. The Beauty businesses manufacture and distribute skin care products, cosmetics, bath and body care, toiletries, fragrances, nutritional products, apparel and related products. New products introduced in 2006 in the Fuller Mexico business included Vivir by Lucia Mendez, Maximum by Ernesto Laguardia and Festivity, which are all fragrances. New products introduced in 2006 in the BeautiControl business included Regeneration Platinum Line Arrest, BeautiBistro bath and body line and Regeneration Time to Go Time Capsules. Sales of products are made through or facilitated by independent sales persons called directors and consultants in the home, workplace or other venues. Outside the United States and Canada, BeautiControl products are sold in selected markets within the Tupperware organization structure. (Words followed by * are registered or unregistered Trademarks of the Registrant.) II. MARKETS Tupperware. Tupperware’s business is operated on the basis of three geographic markets: Europe (Europe, Africa and the Middle East), Asia Pacific and North America. Market penetration varies throughout the world. Several “developing” areas that have low penetration, such as Latin America, Asia and Eastern and Central Europe, provide significant growth potential for Tupperware. Tupperware’s strategy continues to include expansion and greater penetration in markets throughout the world. Beauty. Beauty products and image services are provided to clients via independent sales forces in 22 markets throughout the world with particularly high shares of the direct selling and/or beauty market in Mexico, South Africa, the Philippines and Australia. Tupperware Brands’ products are sold in almost 100 foreign countries and in the United States and it has operations in many of such countries. For the past five fiscal years, sales in foreign countries represented, 75 to 85 percent of total revenues from the sale of Tupperware Brands’ products. 4 Table of Contents III. DISTRIBUTION OF PRODUCTS Tupperware. Tupperware’s products are distributed worldwide primarily through “direct selling” under which products are sold to consumers outside traditional retail store channels. The system facilitates the timely distribution of products to consumers, without having to work through intermediaries, and establishes uniform practices regarding the use of Tupperware trademarks and administrative arrangements with Tupperware, such as order entering, delivering and paying along with recruiting and training dealers. Tupperware products are primarily sold directly to distributors, directors, managers and dealers (“Sales Force”) throughout the world. Where distributorships are granted, they have the right to market Tupperware products using parties and other non-traditional retail methods and to utilize the Tupperware trademark. The vast majority of the sales force is independent contractors and not employees of Tupperware. In certain limited circumstances, Tupperware acquires ownership of distributorships for a period of time, until an independent distributor can be installed, in order to maintain market presence. In addition to the introduction of new products and development of new geographic markets, a key element of Tupperware’s strategy is expanding its business by increasing the size of its Sales Force. Under the system, distributors and directors recruit, train, and motivate a large number of dealers. Managers are developed from among the dealer group and promoted by distributors and directors to assist in recruiting, training and motivating dealers, while continuing to hold their own parties. As of December 30, 2006, the Tupperware distribution system had 1,800 distributors, 47,500 managers, and 848,000 dealers worldwide. During the year 11.9 million Tupperware demonstrations took place worldwide. Tupperware relies primarily on the “party” method of sales, which is designed to enable the purchaser to appreciate through demonstration the features and benefits of Tupperware products. Demonstrations, which are sometimes referred to as “Tupperware parties,” are held in homes, offices, social clubs and other locations. Tupperware products are also promoted through brochures mailed to persons invited to attend Tupperware parties and various other types of demonstrations. Sales of Tupperware products are supported by Tupperware through a program of sales promotions, sales and training aids and motivational conferences for the sales force. In addition, to support its sales force, Tupperware utilizes catalogs, television and magazine advertising, which help increase its sales levels with hard-to-reach customers and generate sales force leads for parties and new dealers. In 2006, Tupperware continued the implementation around the world of its integrated direct access strategies to enhance its core party plan business and to allow consumers to obtain Tupperware products other than by attending a Tupperware party. These strategies include retail access points, Internet selling (which includes the option of personal websites for the United States sales force), and television shopping. In addition, Tupperware enters into business-to-business transactions, in which Tupperware sells products to a partner company for sale to consumers through the partner’s distribution channel, with a link back to Tupperware’s party plan business to generate additional Tupperware parties. Beauty. Beauty products are sold primarily through consultants and directors who are primarily independent contractors. Of the larger beauty businesses operated by the Company, BeautiControl North America and Nutrimetics Australia operate under the party plan, one-to- many selling system. In order to provide immediate product delivery, the sales force in these businesses may maintain a small inventory of products. The other large beauty businesses operate primarily through one-on-one sales interactions with product shipments made by the Company after end consumers have ordered product. BeautiControl consultants in the United States are encouraged to use, company-developed and -sponsored personal internet web pages called BeautiPage* in order to utilize multiple selling opportunities. As of December 30, 2006, BeautiControl North America had a total sales force of 118,000 and the businesses in the Company’s International Beauty reporting segment had a total sales force of 898,000. 5 Table of Contents IV. COMPETITION Tupperware. There are two primary competitive factors which affect the Registrant’s business: (i) competition with other “direct sales” companies for sales personnel and demonstration dates; and (ii) competition in the markets for food storage, serving and preparation containers, toys and gifts in general. Also, Tupperware has differentiated itself from its competitors through price, quality of products (lifetime warranty on most Tupperware products) and new products. Tupperware believes it holds a significant market share in each of these markets in many countries. Beauty. There are many competitors in the beauty and personal care market and the principal bases of competition generally are marketing, price, quality and innovation of products, as well as competition with other “direct sales” companies for sales personnel and demonstration dates. The beauty businesses work to differentiate themselves and their products from the industry in general through the use of value-added services, technological sophistication, brand development, new product introductions and sales force training, motivation and compensation arrangements. V. EMPLOYEES The Registrant employs approximately 12,300 people, of whom approximately 900 are based in the United States. VI. RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT The Registrant incurred $15.6 million, $13.9 million and $13.0 million for fiscal years ended 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively, on research and development activities for new products. VII. RAW MATERIALS Tupperware. Products manufactured by Tupperware require plastic resins meeting its specifications. These resins are purchased through various arrangements with a number of large chemical companies located throughout Tupperware’s markets. As a result, Tupperware has not experienced difficulties in obtaining adequate supplies and generally has been successful in obtaining favorable resin prices on a relative basis. Research and development relating to resins used in Tupperware products are performed by both Tupperware and its suppliers. Beauty. Materials used in the beauty businesses’ skin care, cosmetic and bath and body care products consist primarily of readily available ingredients, containers and packaging materials. Such raw materials and components used in goods manufactured and assembled by the beauty businesses and through outsource arrangements are available from a number of sources. To date, the beauty businesses have been able to secure an adequate supply of raw materials for its products, and it endeavors to maintain relationships with backup suppliers in an effort to ensure that no interruptions occur in its operations. VIII. TRADEMARKS AND PATENTS Tupperware Brands considers its trademarks and patents to be of material importance to its business; however, except for the Tupperware ® , Fuller ® and BeautiControl ® trademarks, Tupperware Brands is not dependent upon any single patent or trademark, or group of patents or trademarks. The Tupperware ® , Fuller ® and BeautiControl ® trademarks are registered on a country-by-country basis. The current duration for such registration ranges from five years to ten years; however, each such registration may be renewed an unlimited number of times. The patents and trademarks used in Tupperware Brands’ business are registered and maintained on a worldwide basis, with a variety of durations. Tupperware Brands has followed the practice of applying for design and utility patents with respect to most of its significant patentable developments. The Company has a patent on the formulae for its “REGENERATION” ® and “REGENERATION 2 ” ® alpha-hydroxy acid- based products. 6 Table of Contents IX. ENVIRONMENTAL LAWS Compliance with federal, state and local environmental protection laws has not had in the past, and is not expected to have in the future, a material effect upon the Registrant’s capital expenditures, liquidity, earnings or competitive position. X. OTHER Sales do not vary significantly on a quarterly basis; however, third quarter sales are generally lower than the other quarters in any year due to vacations by dealers and their customers, as well as reduced promotional activities during such quarter. Sales generally increase in the fourth quarter as it includes traditional gift-giving occasions in many markets and as children return to school and households refocus on activities that include the use of Tupperware’s products along with increased promotional activities supporting these opportunities. Generally, there are no working capital practices or backlog conditions which are material to an understanding of the Registrant’s business, although the Company generally seeks to minimize its net working capital position at the end of each fiscal year. The Registrant’s business is not dependent on a small number of customers, nor is any of its business subject to renegotiation of profits or termination of contracts or subcontracts at the election of the United States government. XI. EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT Following is a list of the names and ages of all the Executive Officers of the Registrant, indicating all positions and offices with the Registrant held by each such person, and each such person’s principal occupations or employment during the past five years. Each such person has been elected to serve until the next annual election of officers of the Registrant (expected to occur on May 16, 2007). Name and Age Carl Benkovich, age 50 Edward R. Davis III, age 44 R. Glenn Drake, age 54 Lillian D. Garcia, age 51 V. Jane Garrard, age 44 Positions and Offices Held and Principal Occupations of Employment During Past Five Years Office and Experience Vice President, Internal Audit since October 2005, after serving as Chief Financial Officer of Tupperware North America since August 2000. Vice President and Treasurer since May 2004, after serving as Treasurer since May 2002. Prior thereto, he served as Director, International Finance since May 1998. Group President, Europe, Africa and the Middle East since August 2006, after serving as Group President, North America, Europe, Africa and the Middle East since January 2002. Executive Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer since August 2005, after serving as Senior Vice President, Human Resources since December 1999. Vice President, Investor Relations since April 2002. Prior thereto, she was Vice President-Controller of Tupperware Brands’ BeautiControl subsidiary since May 2000. 7 Table of Contents Name and Age E.V. Goings, age 61 Josef Hajek, age 49 David T. Halversen, age 62 Simon C. Hemus, age 57 C. Morgan Hare, age 59 Christa M. Hart, age 47 Timothy A. Kulhanek, age 42 Michael S. Poteshman, age 43 Thomas M. Roehlk, age 56 Office and Experience Chairman and Chief Executive Officer since October 1997. Mr. Goings serves as a director of SunTrust Bank of Central Florida, N.A. Senior Vice President, Tax and Governmental Affairs since February 2006, after serving as Vice President, Tax since September 2001. Group President, Asia Pacific and North America since August 2006, after serving as Group President, Tupperware Asia Pacific, Mexico and BeautiControl since January 2005, and as Group President, Latin America and BeautiControl since March 2003. Prior thereto, he served as Senior Vice President, Business Development and Planning since May 2002 and as Senior Vice President, Business Development and Communications since November 1996. President and Chief Operating Officer since January 2007, after serving as Group President, International Beauty since December 2005. Prior thereto he served as Group President and CEO of the direct selling division of Sara Lee Corporation since 1993. Executive Vice President and Chief Marketing Officer since August 2005, after serving as Senior Vice President and Senior Global Marketing Officer since October 2001. Executive Vice President, Beauty since January 2007, after serving as Executive Vice President, Strategy and Business Development since February 2006, as Senior Vice President, Strategy and Business Development since August 2004, and as Vice President, Strategy and Business Development since July 2003. Prior to such date she served as a consultant from October 2002 to July 2003 with International Business Machines Corporation, after serving as a consultant with PricewaterhouseCoopers LLC. Vice President and Controller since January 2005 after serving as Assistant Controller since June 1999. Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since August 2004 after serving as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since November 2003. Prior thereto, he served as Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Tupperware Europe, Africa and the Middle East since May 2002. He served as Vice President, Finance and Investor Relations from May 2001 to May 2002. Executive Vice President, Chief Legal Officer & Secretary since August 2005 after serving as Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary since December 1995. 8 Table of Contents Name and Age Christian E. Skroeder, age 58 José R. Timmerman, age 58 Robert F. Wagner, age 46 Item 1A. Risk Factors. Office and Experience Senior Vice President, Worldwide Market Development since April 2001, responsible for emerging markets in Asia Pacific and also NaturCare Japan beginning in 2006. Senior Vice President, Worldwide Operations since August 1997. Vice President and Chief Technology Officer since August 2002. Prior thereto, he was Vice President of Information Technology, Worldwide from June 2001. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones facing the Company. Other events that the Company does not currently anticipate or that the Company currently deems immaterial also may affect results of operations and financial condition. Sales Force Factors The Company’s products are marketed and sold through the direct selling method of distribution, in which products are primarily marketed and sold by a sales force made up of independent contractors to consumers without the use of retail establishments. This distribution system depends upon the successful recruitment, retention and motivation of a large force of sales personnel to compensate for a high turnover rate. The recruitment and retention of sales force members is dependent upon the competitive environment among direct sellers and upon the general labor market, unemployment levels, general economic conditions, and demographic and cultural changes in the workforce. The motivation of the sales force is dependent in part upon the effectiveness of compensation and promotional programs of the Company, the competitiveness of the same compared with other direct selling companies, the introduction of new products, and the ability to advance through the sales force structure. The Company’s sales are directly tied to the activity levels of its sales force, which in large part is a temporary working activity for sales force members. Activity levels may be affected by the degree to which a market is penetrated by the presence of the Company’s sales force, the amount of average sales per product demonstration, the amount of sales per sales force member and the mix of high-margin and low-margin products sold at product demonstrations and elsewhere, and the activities and actions of the Company’s product line and channel competitors. In addition, the Company’s sales force members may be affected by initiatives undertaken by the Company to grow the revenue base of the Company and the inaccurate perception that the independent sales force system is at risk of being phased out. Legal and Regulatory Issues The U.S. Federal Trade Commission has proposed business opportunity regulations which may have an effect upon the Company’s method of operating in the United States, but such regulations are in the early stages of development and it is not possible to gauge the impact or the effective date at this time. The Company’s business may also be affected by the actions of governments to restrict the activities of direct selling companies for various reasons, including the limitation on the ability of direct selling companies to operate through direct sales without the involvement of a traditional retail channel. Foreign governments may also seek to require that non-domestic companies doing or seeking to do business place a certain percentage of ownership of legal entities in the hands of local nationals to protect the commercial interests of its citizens. 9 Table of Contents Customs laws, tariffs, import duties, export quotas and restrictions on repatriation of foreign earnings may negatively affect the Company’s international operations. Governments may seek either to impose taxes on independent sales force members or to classify independent sales force members as employees of direct selling companies with whom they may be associated, triggering employment-related taxes on the part of the direct selling companies. The U.S. Federal government may impose restrictions on the Company’s ability to engage in business in a foreign country in connection with the foreign policy of the United States. Product Safety The materials used in the Company’s product lines may give rise to concerns of consumers based upon scientific theories which are espoused from time to time, including the risk of certain materials leaching out of plastic containers used for their intended purposes or the ingredients used in cosmetics or personal care products causing harm to human health. It is the Company’s policy to use only those materials or ingredients which are approved by relevant regulatory authorities for contact with food or skin or for ingestion by consumers, as applicable. General Business Factors The Company’s business can be affected by a wide range of factors that affect other businesses. Weather, natural disasters, strikes and political instability may have a significant impact on the willingness or ability of consumers to attend product demonstrations or otherwise purchase the Company’s products. The supply and cost of raw materials, particularly petroleum and natural gas-based products, may have an impact on the availability or profitability of the Company’s plastic products. The Company is also subject to frequent counterfeiting and intellectual property infringement, which may be difficult to police and prevent, dependent upon the existence and enforceability of laws affording protection to Company property. Other risks, as discussed under the sub-heading “Forward-Looking Statements” contained in Part II, Item 7 of this Report under the heading “Management Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” may be relevant to performance as well. Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments None. Item 2. Properties The principal executive office of the Registrant is owned by the Registrant and is located in Orlando, Florida. The Registrant owns and maintains manufacturing plants in Belgium, Brazil, France, Greece, Japan, Korea, Mexico, New Zealand, the Philippines, Portugal, South Africa and the United States, and leases manufacturing and distribution facilities in China, India, and Venezuela. The Registrant owns and maintains the BeautiControl headquarters in Texas and leases its manufacturing and distribution facilities in Texas. The Registrant conducts a continuing program of new product design and development at its facilities in Florida, Texas, Japan, Mexico, New Zealand and Belgium. None of the owned principal properties is subject to any encumbrance material to the consolidated operations of the Registrant except for the Registrant’s United States properties and its New Zealand plant. The Registrant considers the condition and extent of utilization of its plants, warehouses and other properties to be good, the capacity of its plants and warehouses generally to be adequate for its needs, and the nature of the properties to be suitable for its needs. In addition to the above-described improved properties, the Registrant owns approximately 1200 acres of unimproved real estate surrounding its corporate headquarters in Orlando, Florida, of which 300 acres have been prepared for a variety of development purposes. The Registrant began selling portions of this property in 2002, and this project is expected to continue through 2009. Item 3. Legal Proceedings A number of ordinary-course legal and administrative proceedings against the Registrant or its subsidiaries are pending. In addition to such proceedings, there are certain proceedings that involve the discharge of materials 10 Table of Contents into or otherwise relating to the protection of the environment. Certain of such proceedings involve federal environmental laws such as the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, as well as state and local laws. The Registrant has established reserves with respect to certain of such proceedings. Because of the involvement of other parties and the uncertainty of potential environmental impacts, the eventual outcomes of such actions and the cost and timing of expenditures cannot be determined with certainty. It is not expected that the outcome of such proceedings, either individually or in the aggregate, will have a materially adverse effect upon the Registrant. As part of the 1986 reorganization involving the formation of Premark, Premark was spun-off by Dart & Kraft, Inc., and Kraft Foods, Inc. assumed any liabilities arising out of any legal proceedings in connection with certain divested or discontinued former businesses of Dart Industries Inc., a subsidiary of the Registrant, including matters alleging product and environmental liability. The assumption of liabilities by Kraft Foods, Inc. remains effective subsequent to the distribution of the equity of the Registrant to Premark shareholders in 1996. As part of the Acquisition, Sara Lee Corporation indemnified the Registrant for any liabilities arising out of any existing litigation at the time of the acquisition and for certain legal matters arising out of circumstances that might relate to periods before or after the date of the acquisition. Item 4. Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders None. 11 Table of Contents PART II Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities The Registrant has not sold any securities in 2004 through 2006 that were not registered under the Securities Act of 1933. As of February 23, 2007, the Registrant had 39,489 shareholders of record and beneficial holders. The principal United States market on which the Registrant’s common stock is being traded is the New York Stock Exchange. The stock price and dividend information set forth in Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements, entitled “Quarterly Financial Summary (Unaudited),” is included in Item 8 of Part II of this Report and is incorporated by reference into this Item 5. Item 5a. Performance Graph The following performance graph compares the performance of the Company’s common stock to the Standard & Poor’s 400 Mid-Cap Stock Index and the Standard & Poor’s 400 Mid-Cap Consumer Discretionary Index. The graph assumes that the value of the investment in the Company’s common stock and each index was $100 at December 29, 2001 and that all dividends were reinvested. The Company is included in both indices. Measurement Period (Fiscal Year Ended) 12/29/2001 12/28/2002 12/27/2003 12/25/2004 12/31/2005 12/30/2006 Tupperware S&P 400 Brands Corporation 100.00 81.00 96.68 121.35 139.63 147.38 Mid- Cap 100.00 84.02 113.88 132.48 150.27 165.78 S&P 400 Mid-Cap Consumer Discretionary Index 100.00 91.60 125.63 148.41 155.16 160.14 12 Table of Contents Item 5c. Changes in Securities, Use of Proceeds and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities The following information relates to the repurchase of the Registrant’s equity securities by the Registrant during any month within the fourth quarter of the Registrant’s fiscal year covered by this report: 10/1/06 – 11/4/06 11/5/06 – 12/2/06 12/3/06 – 12/30/06 Total Number of Shares Purchased (a) 391,780 4,750 — 396,530 Average Price Paid Per Share 21.35 21.51 — Total Number of Shares Purchased as Part of Publicly Announced Plans or Programs n/a n/a n/a n/a Maximum Number of Shares that May yet be Purchased Under the Plans or Programs n/a n/a n/a n/a (a) Represents common stock surrendered to the Company as settlement of $8.5 million in amounts owed pursuant to loans by the Company to various executives for the purchase of the stock as contemplated under the Management Stock Purchase Plan and as settlement of Mr. Goings’ separate 1998 loan from the Company to purchase shares of the Registrant’s common stock. There is no publicly announced plan or program to repurchase Company shares. 13 Table of Contents Item 6. Selected Financial Data The following table contains the Company’s selected historical financial information for the last five years. The selected financial information below has been derived from the Company’s audited consolidated financial statements which, for data presented for fiscal years 2006, 2005 and 2004, are included as Item 8 of this Report. This data should be read in conjunction with the Company’s other financial information, including “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (MD&A)” and the Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements included as Items 7 and 8, respectively, in this Report. (Dollars in millions, except per share amounts) Operating results Net sales: Europe (a) Asia Pacific (a) North America (a), (b), (d) BeautiControl North America (a) International Beauty (a), (c) Total net sales Segment profit (loss): Europe (a), (d) Asia Pacific (a), (d) North America (a), (b), (d) BeautiControl North America (a) International Beauty (a), (c) Unallocated expenses (d), (e) Other, net (d), (e), (f), (g) Re-engineering and impairment charges (d) Interest expense, net (h) Income before income taxes Provision for (benefit from) income taxes Net income before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change, net of tax Net Income Basic earnings per common share before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change Diluted earnings per common share before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change See footnotes beginning on the following page. 2006 2005 2004 2003 2002 $ 602.5 204.5 253.6 146.7 72.0 $ 1,279.3 $ 116.2 20.2 0.5 14.0 0.9 (28.3 ) 4.0 (16.7 ) (45.1 ) 65.7 (20.5 ) 86.2 (0.8 ) 85.4 1.45 (0.01 ) 1.44 1.42 (0.01 ) 1.41 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 597.0 194.8 278.7 118.0 35.7 $ 1,224.3 $ 133.4 20.5 (22.3 ) 8.0 1.6 (32.7 ) 13.1 (7.0 ) (13.0 ) 102.0 15.1 $ 86.9 — $ 86.9 1.49 $ — 1.49 $ $ 1.48 — 1.48 $ $ 546.0 213.6 315.0 92.7 26.7 $ 1,194.0 $ 110.0 21.0 (16.7 ) 5.1 (6.0 ) (40.5 ) 4.3 (6.8 ) (13.8 ) 56.6 8.7 $ 47.9 — $ 47.9 0.82 $ — 0.82 $ $ 0.82 — 0.82 $ $ 426.7 211.8 374.9 75.4 33.9 $ 1,122.7 $ 88.3 35.7 45.5 5.9 (8.9 ) (20.9 ) 14.4 (20.8 ) (21.8 ) 117.4 27.3 $ 90.1 — $ 90.1 1.55 $ — 1.55 $ $ 1.54 — 1.54 $ $ 615.9 239.7 255.5 150.0 482.6 $ 1,743.7 $ 94.4 33. 8 8.7 14.6 30.8 (36.4 ) 12.5 (7.6 ) (47.0 ) 103.8 9.6 $ 94.2 — $ 94.2 1.57 $ — 1.57 $ $ 1.54 — 1.54 $ 14 Table of Contents Selected Financial Data (continued) (Dollars in millions, except per share amounts) Profitability ratios Segment profit as a percent of sales: Europe (a), (d) Asia Pacific (a), (d) North America (a), (b), (d) BeautiControl North America (a) International Beauty (a), (c) Return on average equity (i) Return on average invested capital(i) Financial Condition Cash and cash equivalents Working capital Property, plant and equipment, net Total assets Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt Long-term obligations Shareholders’ equity Current ratio Long-term debt-to-equity Total debt-to-capital (j) Other Data Net cash provided by operating activities (h) Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities (h) Capital expenditures Depreciation and amortization Common Stock Data Dividends declared per share Dividend payout ratio (k) Average common shares outstanding (thousands): Basic Diluted Year-end book value per share (l) Year-end price/earnings ratio (m) Year-end market/book ratio (n) Year-end shareholders (thousands) 2006 2005 2004 2003 2002 16 % 16 3 10 5 25.5 11.2 $ 102.2 220.5 256.6 1,696.2 0.9 680.5 399.2 1.59 170.4 % 63.1 % $ 172.8 (131.5 ) (122.5 ) 52.1 72.9 19 % 10 — 10 1 26.3 18.2 $ 181.5 218.0 254.5 1,740.2 1.1 750.5 335.5 1.48 223.7 % 69.1 % $ 140.2 (511.4 ) 459.8 52.0 50.8 22 % 11 nm 7 5 34.6 17.3 $ 90.9 173.9 216.0 983.2 2.6 246.5 290.9 1.60 84.7 % 46.1 % $ 121.4 (27.0 ) (50.1 ) 43.6 50.8 20 % 10 nm 6 nm 24.1 10.9 $ 45.0 121.0 221.4 915.9 5.6 263.5 228.2 1.42 115.5 % 54.1 % $ 105.6 (30.6 ) (64.7 ) 40.0 52.6 21 % 17 12 8 nm 61.0 19.4 $ 32.6 77.1 228.9 838.7 21.2 265.1 177.5 1.27 149.4 % 61.7 % $ 128.2 14.4 (132.1 ) 46.9 48.8 $ 0.88 57.1 % $ 0.88 62.4 % $ 0.88 59.5 % $ 0.88 107.3 % $ 0.88 57.1 % 60,140 61,171 59,424 60,617 $ 6.59 14.7 3.4 7.7 $ 5.53 13.7 3.5 8.3 58,432 58,848 $ 4.96 13.7 4.1 8.9 58,382 58,440 $ 3.90 20.6 4.3 9.4 58,242 58,716 $ 3.04 9.8 4.9 10.1 a. As a result of changes in the Company’s management structure as well as a re-evaluation of the Company’s operating segment definitions, the Company reorganized its previously reported segments as follows: • • • There have been no changes to the Company’s BeautiControl North America segment. International BeautiControl operations are reported in the segments in which the business component geographically resides. The International Beauty reportable segment includes the Acquired Units other than those operated in Southern Africa and Japan, as well as the Company’s Tupperware operations in Central and South America and the Philippines which were included in the Company’s Latin America and Asia Pacific reportable segments prior to 2006, respectively. 15 Table of Contents • • • • The Company’s Tupperware and BeautiControl operations in Mexico are included in the North America segment; they were included in the Latin America reportable segment prior to 2006. With the movement of Central and South America as well as Mexico, the Company no longer has a Latin America reportable segment. The Company’s NaturCare ® brand business operating in Japan is included in the Asia Pacific segment; it was previously included in the International Beauty reporting segment. This change included the transfer of intangible assets and goodwill of $30.2 million and $24.3 million, respectively. The Company’s Avroy Shlain ® and Swissgarde ® brand businesses operating in Southern Africa are now included in the Europe segment; they were previously included in the International Beauty reportable segment. This change included the transfer of intangible assets and goodwill of $16.6 million and $16.3 million, respectively. Prior period data has been reclassified to reflect these changes. b. Beginning in 2001 and concluding in 2003, the Tupperware United States business transitioned to a new business model. Under this model, sales are made directly to the sales force with distributors compensated through commission payments. This model results in a higher company sales price that includes the margin previously realized by the distributors and has no material impact on profit. The impact of this change on the comparison with prior year sales was approximately $27.0 million and $16.2 million, in 2003 and 2002, respectively. There was no material impact on the 2006, 2005 and 2004 comparisons with the prior year. In December 2005, the Company purchased Sara Lee Corporation’s direct selling businesses, and the results of these operations have been included since the date of acquisition. The re-engineering and impairment charges line provides for severance and other exit costs. In addition to these costs, the Company has incurred various costs associated with it re-engineering activities that are not defined as exit costs under SFAS No. 146, Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit and Disposal Activities . These costs are included in the results of the applicable segment in which they were incurred or as part of unallocated expenses In January 2005, the Company reached a decision to restructure its manufacturing facility in Hemingway, South Carolina. As a result, in 2005, $0.9 million, $0.5 million and $0.6 million was recorded in Europe, Asia Pacific and North America, respectively, for pretax costs incurred to relocate equipment from Hemingway to production facilities in those regions. As a result of the capacity shift, the Company also recorded a $5.6 million reduction of its reserve for United States-produced inventory that is accounted for under the last-in first-out (LIFO) method as that inventory was sold and $1.2 million in the United States for equipment relocation. Both of these items are included in the North America results for 2005. In 2002, $1.6 million was recorded as a reduction of Europe segment profit related to the write-down of inventory and reserves for receivables as a result of restructuring the business model of the Company’s United Kingdom operations. Also, 2002 Asia Pacific segment profit was reduced by $2.7 million primarily related to costs associated with the closure of one of the Company’s Japanese manufacturing/distribution facilities. In addition, in 2002, $0.1 million was recorded as a reduction of North America segment profit primarily as a result of reserves for receivables as a result of a restructure of BeautiControl operations in Mexico. As part of re-engineering actions, in 2002, the Company sold its former Spanish manufacturing facility, its Convention Center complex in Orlando, Florida and one of its Japanese manufacturing/distribution facilities generating pretax gains of $21.9 million, $4.4 million and $13.1 million, respectively. The Spanish and Japanese gains were included in the Europe and Asia Pacific segments, respectively, and the Convention Center gain was recorded in other, net in the table above. In addition, unallocated expenses included $0.1 million for internal and external consulting costs incurred in connection with implementing restructuring actions in 2002. Total after-tax impact of these costs (gains) was $5.8 million, $(1.6) million, $4.3 million, $3.1 million and $(8.5) million in 2006, 2005, 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively. See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements. In 2002, the Company began to sell land held for development near its Orlando, Florida headquarters. During 2006, 2005, 2004, and 2003, pretax gains from these sales were $9.3 million, $4.0 million, $11.6 million and $3.7 million, respectively, and were recorded in other net. Certain members of management, c. d. e. 16 Table of Contents including executive officers, received incentive compensation totaling $0.2 million, $0.1 million, $0.3 million, $0.2 million and $1.3 million in 2006, 2005, 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively, based upon completion of performance goals related to real estate development. These costs were recorded in unallocated expenses. Effective December 30, 2006, this incentive compensation program has been terminated. During 2006 and 2004, the Company recorded pretax gains of $4.4 million and $1.5 million, respectively, as a result of insurance recoveries from hurricane damage suffered in 2004 at its headquarters location in Orlando, Florida. These gains are included in other net. f. g. During 2006, the Company recorded a pretax loss of $1.2 million as a result of a fire at its former manufacturing facility in Halls, h. i. Tennessee. In 2005, interest expense includes approximately $29 million in net expense related to settling the Company’s $100 million 2006 notes and $150 million 2011 notes as part of its refinancing in conjunction with its December 2005 acquisition of Sara Lee Corporation’s direct selling business. $27.4 million of cash outflows associated with these transactions was included in the Company’s 2005 10-K as an outflow within the net cash used in financing activities section of the cash flow statement. They have been reclassified to be included within 2005’s net cash provided by operating activities. See Note 1 to consolidated financial statements. Returns on average equity and invested capital are calculated by dividing net income by the average monthly balance of shareholders’ equity and invested capital, respectively. Invested capital equals shareholders’ equity plus debt. Capital is defined as total debt plus shareholders’ equity. The dividend payout ratio is dividends declared per share divided by diluted earnings per share. Year-end book value per share is calculated as year-end shareholders’ equity divided by average diluted shares. j. k. l. m. Year-end price/earnings ratio is calculated as the year-end market price of the Company’s common stock divided by the full year diluted earnings per share. n. Year-end market/book ratio is calculated as the year-end market price of the Company’s common stock divided by the year-end book value per share. Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations The following is a discussion of the results of operations for 2006 compared with 2005 and 2005 compared with 2004, and changes in financial condition during 2006. The Company’s fiscal year ends on the last Saturday of December and included 52 weeks during 2006 as compared with 53 weeks in 2005 and 52 weeks in 2004. This information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial information provided in Item 8 of this Annual Report. The Company’s primary means of distributing its product is through independent sales organizations and individuals, which are also its customers. The majority of the Company’s products are in turn sold to end customers who are not members of the Company’s sales forces. The Company is largely dependent upon these independent sales organizations and individuals to reach end consumers and any significant disruption of this distribution network would have a negative financial impact on the Company and its ability to generate sales, earnings and operating cash flows. The Company’s primary business drivers are the size, activity and productivity of its independent sales organizations. Estimates included herein are those of the Company’s management and are subject to the disclosure in the Forward Looking Statements section at the end of this Item 7. 17 Table of Contents Overview Net sales Gross margin Delivery, sales & administrative as percent of sales Operating income Net income 52 weeks ended Dec. 30, 2006 $1,743.7 64.7% 56.3 $152.2 94.1 53 weeks ended Dec. 31, 2005 $1,279.3 64.3% 54.6 $110.1 85.4 Change 36.3% 0.4pp 1.7 38.2% 10.2 Change excluding foreign exchange 35.6% 0.2pp 1.9 35.3% 9.2 Foreign exchange impact $8.5 0.2pp (0.2) $1.4 1.1 The 2006 sales increase reflected $458.9 more sales from the Acquired Units than in 2005 when they were only included in the Company’s results following their December 5, 2005 acquisition. Total 2006 sales by the Acquired Units were $496.7 million. There was also a net increase from the Tupperware units in Asia Pacific and North America, which includes Tupperware Mexico, and BeautiControl North America. Sales in Europe were up, from the benefit of including the South African beauty units in the segment, which did not have sales for the first eleven months of 2005 prior to their acquisition. For the year, net income was up primarily due to the full year inclusion of the Acquired Units, which generated $33.1 million in profit, or $57.5 million before considering amortization of intangible assets recorded in purchase accounting, compared with $2.2 million in 2005 for the one month they were owned by the Company. Profit also improved in the Tupperware units in Asia Pacific; there was a significantly lower loss by Tupperware United States and Canada, and a small improvement in profit by BeautiControl North America. Also impacting the comparison was $23.7 million of amortization of purchase accounting intangibles in 2006 versus $1.7 million in 2005, higher unallocated corporate expenses, lower re-engineering and impairment charges, and a large, favorable 2005 tax related settlement with the Company’s former parent. Net interest expense did not change significantly, reflecting higher ongoing expense in 2006 associated with higher average borrowings and costs in 2005 associated with changes in the Company’s debt financing, both in connection with the Acquisition. The higher unallocated corporate expenses in 2006 were due to higher public relations costs in an effort to contemporize the Company’s brand perception, increased equity compensation and a net loss from foreign exchange versus net gains in 2005. In 2006, the Company generated cash flow from operating activities of $172.8 million. The year-end debt to total capital ratio was 63 percent compared with 69 percent last year. In 2006, the Company adopted SFAS 123(R) Share Based Payment in 2006, which requires the Company to record compensation expense for all unvested options that were issued prior to the Company’s adoption of fair-value accounting. These options were not previously considered under the Company’s decision to adopt fair-value accounting prospectively in 2003. This change resulted in $0.8 million of incremental expense in 2006. Additionally, 2006 included an incremental $1.5 million of compensation expense related to clarification from the Securities and Exchange Commission regarding accounting for stock options granted to retiree-eligible participants (see Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion). This change did not impact the total compensation cost to be recognized but did accelerate it. Net sales increased four percent in 2005 versus 2004, both as reported and in local currency. Three percentage points of the increase reflected the inclusion of the Acquired Units’ results for one month in 2005. BeautiControl North America achieved a strong sales increase, which was mostly offset by a decrease in Tupperware North America coming from the United States business. Net income was down two percent in spite of improvements from 2004 in both sales and profit from the segments. This was primarily due to higher interest expense and re-engineering and impairment charges, along with lower land sales. The Company had a negative provision for income taxes due to a settlement related to pre-June 1996 taxes as well as various audit settlements and planning transactions. 18 Table of Contents Unallocated Expenses : The Company allocates corporate operating expenses to its reporting segments based upon estimated time spent related to those segments where a direct relationship is present and based upon segment revenue for general expenses. The unallocated expenses reflect amounts unrelated to segment operations. Allocations are determined at the beginning of the year based upon estimated expenditures. The unallocated expenses increased during 2006 as compared with 2005 primarily due to equity compensation, net losses from foreign exchange and higher public relations costs in an effort to contemporize the Company’s brand perception. During 2006, the Company continued its program to sell land for development near its Orlando, Florida headquarters which began in 2002. Pretax gains totaling $9.3 million ($5.5 million after tax) were recognized as a result of transactions completed during 2006. This amount compared with pretax gains of $4.0 million ($2.4 million after tax) during 2005 and $11.6 million ($7.1 million after tax) during 2004. Gains on land transactions are recorded based upon when the transactions close and proceeds are collected. Transactions in one period may not be representative of what may occur in other periods. Additionally in 2006, the Company recorded a pretax loss of $1.2 million as a result of a fire at its former manufacturing facility in Halls, Tennessee. The amount recorded is based on its current best estimate. As more information becomes available related to this event, adjustments may be necessary. The Company also recognized in 2004 a $1.5 million gain for the preliminary settlement of an insurance claim related to hurricane damage incurred at the Company’s headquarters, and in 2006 a $4.4 million gain related to the final settlement of this claim. Included in 2006 net income were pretax charges of $7.6 million for re-engineering and impairment compared with $16.7 million in 2005 ($5.7 million and $11.2 million after tax, respectively). These charges are discussed in the re-engineering costs section following. International operations accounted for 84, 76 and 75 percent of the Company’s sales in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. They also accounted for 90 and 97 percent of the Company’s net segment profit in 2006 and 2005, respectively, and all of the Company’s net segment profit in 2004. The increase in the percent of sales from international operations in 2006 was due to the inclusion of the Acquired Units’ results of operations for a full year. Gross Margin: Gross margin as a percentage of sales increased to 64.7 percent in 2006 compared with 64.3 percent in 2005, which was down from 65.3 percent in 2004. The slightly higher gross margin percentage in 2006 was due to the inclusion of a full year of the Acquired Units’ results, which run a slightly higher margin rate than the other units, as well as improvement in North America from the utilization of previously written down product, lower sales under incentive offers and LIFO reserve liquidation. These were partially offset by a lower margin percentage in Europe due to lower utilization of production capacity and a higher proportion of sales under incentive offers with a lower margin percentage for such items in Germany. On an overall basis in 2005, the decrease was primarily due to higher raw material costs, particularly resin, and a higher proportion of promotional sales in Europe reflecting efforts to stimulate sales force recruiting, customer demand and party attendance. Costs and Expenses: Delivery, sales and administrative expense (DS&A) as a percentage of sales was 56.3, 54.6, and 56.3 percent, in 2006, 2005, and 2004, respectively. In 2006, the increase in DS&A as a percent of sales was due to the inclusion of a full year of the Acquired Units’ results, which run a slightly higher rate than the other units and $23.7 million of amortization of intangible assets recorded in purchase accounting for the Acquired Units’ sales force relationships compared to $1.7 million in 2005. Excluding the amortization of intangible assets, DS&A as a percentage of sales was 54.9 and 54.5 percent in 2006 and 2005, respectively. In 2005, the decline in DS&A as a percent of sales was due to a continued focus on operating expense reductions throughout the Company, particularly in Tupperware United States and Canada despite the lower sales volume. 19 Table of Contents As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company includes costs related to the distribution of its products in DS&A expense. As a result, the Company’s gross margin may not be comparable with other companies that include these costs in cost of products sold. Re-engineering Costs. As the Company continuously evaluates its operating structure in light of current business conditions and strives to maintain the most efficient possible cost structure, it periodically implements actions designed to reduce costs and improve operating efficiency. These actions may result in re-engineering costs related to facility downsizing and closure as well as related asset write downs and other costs that may be necessary in light of the revised operating landscape. In addition, the Company may recognize gains upon disposal of closed facilities or other activities directly related to its re-engineering efforts. Over the past three years, the Company has incurred such costs (gains) as detailed below that were included in the following income statement captions (in millions): Re-engineering and impairment charges Cost of products sold Total pretax re-engineering costs Total after-tax re-engineering costs 2006 $ 7.6 — $ 7.6 $ 5.8 2005 $16.7 (2.4) $14.3 $9.6 2004 $ 7.0 — $ 7.0 $ 4.3 In 2006, re-engineering and impairment charges of $7.6 million included $7.5 million primarily related to severance costs incurred to reduce headcount in the Company’s Canada, Belgium, Philippines, Australian mold making and Europe operations. The remaining $0.1 million was to write down the value of certain assets of the Company’s Philippines facility. In 2005, re-engineering and impairment charges of $16.7 million included $10.2 million primarily related to severance costs incurred to reduce headcount in the Company’s South Carolina, Orlando, Australian mold making, Belgium, France and Portugal operations. In December 2004, the Company reached a decision to restructure its manufacturing facility in Hemingway, South Carolina. In 2005, the Company implemented its plans related to the Hemingway facility which resulted in the elimination of 269 positions and pretax severance and outplacement costs of approximately $7.2 million. An additional $0.9 million of severance was recorded for the elimination of 43 positions in the Company’s U.S. sales operation. The balance of the $16.7 million charge was largely related to impairment charges recorded to write down the value of certain of the Company’s United States warehousing and distribution capacity and related equipment, as well as a former manufacturing facility in Halls, Tennessee. In addition to headcount reductions, $3.2 million of pretax costs were incurred to relocate equipment to other facilities. As a result of the capacity shift, the Company also realized a $5.6 million reduction of its reserve for United States produced inventory that is accounted for under the last-in first-out (LIFO) method as that inventory was sold. Both of these items were recorded in cost of products sold. In 2004, the re-engineering and impairment charges included severance costs of approximately $3.3 million primarily related to headcount reductions in the United States, Japan and the Philippines. The Philippines action also resulted in an asset impairment charge of approximately $0.7 million. Also included in 2004 charges was a $3.2 million write off of currency translation adjustments related to the Company’s decision to liquidate a foreign subsidiary during the year which was previously classified in other comprehensive income. The decision in December of 2004 to restructure the manufacturing facility in Hemingway, South Carolina in early 2005 resulted in an asset impairment charge of approximately $0.4 million in the fourth quarter of 2004. Partially offsetting these charges was the reversal of approximately $0.8 million of prior accruals primarily due to lower than estimated severance costs in Europe as all activities were concluded. For further details of the re-engineering actions, refer to Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. Tax Rate. The effective tax rates for 2006, 2005, and 2004 were 9.2, (31.2), and 14.8 percent, respectively. In 2006, the tax rate was impacted by tax planning and tax law changes in 2006, which was partially offset by the inclusion of the Acquired Units’ operations which currently carry a higher effective tax rate than the remainder of the Company’s operations. 20 Table of Contents In 2005, the Company reached a settlement with its former parent company resulting in a cash receipt of $46 million including interest related to pre-June 1996 tax liabilities. This generated a net tax benefit of approximately $25 million after considering amounts previously recorded as a receivable on the Company’s balance sheet and a provision for taxes related to the interest portion of the settlement. This transaction, together with various audit settlements and year-end tax planning transactions, resulted in the negative provision for income taxes for 2005. The 2004 rate reflected the impact of re-engineering actions and gains on property dispositions, including the hurricane related insurance gain discussed earlier, as well as the net favorable resolution of domestic and international tax audit contingencies. The Company has recognized deferred tax assets based upon its analysis of the likelihood of realizing the benefits inherent in them and where it has concluded that it is more likely than not that the benefits would ultimately be realized and as such, no valuation allowance was necessary. This assessment was based upon expectations of improving domestic operating results as well as anticipated gains related to the Company’s sales of land held for development near its Orlando, Florida headquarters. In addition, certain tax planning transactions may be entered into to facilitate realization of these benefits. Refer to the critical accounting policies section and Note 10 to the consolidated financial statements for additional discussions of the Company’s methodology for evaluating deferred tax assets. Based on expected revenue and profit contributions of the Company’s various operations, management expects a tax rate in the low 20 percent range for 2007. Net Interest Expense. The Company incurred $47.0 million of net interest expense in 2006 compared with $45.1 million in 2005 and $13.0 million in 2004. Increased interest expense in 2006 was driven largely by the higher level of borrowing that resulted from financing the Acquisition in late 2005. The Company’s primary borrowing in 2006 was through term loans due in 2012 under its credit facility. The principal balance on these term loans at the beginning of 2006 was $745.0 million, but was reduced by principal payments to $669.2 million as of the end of 2006. The interest rate charged on these loans is a floating LIBOR based rate and resulted in interest expense of $47.7 million in 2006, net of the impact from floating-to-fixed interest rate swap agreements on $375 million of the outstanding term loans. Additional interest expense on borrowings under the Company’s $200.0 million committed revolving line of credit totaled $4.6 million. The Company maintained a portfolio of foreign exchange forward contracts that reduced interest expense by approximately two million dollars in 2006. Other interest expense resulted from bank borrowings at the Company’s subsidiaries around the world and a loan secured by the BeautiControl headquarters in Dallas. Interest income during 2006 was approximately $8 million, including $3.6 million earned from an escrow account funded in December 2005 at the time of the Acquisition. In order to discharge the Company’s $100.0 million 7.25 percent Notes due in October 2006, the Company funded an escrow account with cash in December 2005. Since the Notes were paid off from the escrowed funds in October 2006, the escrow account has been closed, and no interest income was earned thereon after October 1, 2006. The sharp increase in 2005 was due to slightly higher interest rates in 2005, along with the requirement to pay a make-whole payment of $21.9 million for the early retirement of the Company’s $150 million notes in connection with entering into new financing arrangements for the Acquisition and $6.0 million for the discharge of obligations related to $100 million of notes due in 2006. Issuance costs of approximately $0.8 million related to retired debt were also written off as part of interest expense. A credit of $3.2 million to recognize net deferred gains on interest rate swaps related to these debt agreements that were previously closed offset some of this expense. Interest expense also included a $3.1 million payment to close an interest rate hedge the Company previously entered into to lock in the base interest rate on the previously expected refinancing of its 2006 notes. As the Company progressed toward closing the Acquisition it became no longer probable in the third quarter of 2005 that the debt would be refinanced, and this agreement was no longer an effective hedge. See additional discussion in Liquidity and Capital Resources. 21 Table of Contents During the first quarter of 2007, the Company will begin hedging $50 million worth of its yen net equity and $300 million of its euro net equity through a series of new forward contracts. This will significantly reduce interest expense in the future with an approximate $5.0 million impact in 2007. The initial forward contracts will mature in 2007 and 2008 and will be settled in cash such that the Company will be exposed to fluctuations in the value of the yen and euro versus the U.S. dollar. Over time, this exposure is expected to be offset by changes in the value of operating cash flows generated in the yen and the euro. Segment Results 2006 vs. 2005 As a result of changes in the Company’s management structure as well as a re-evaluation of the Company’s operating segment definitions, the Company reorganized its previously reported segments as follows: • • • • • • • There have been no changes to the Company’s BeautiControl North America segment. International BeautiControl operations are reported in the segments in which the business component geographically resides. The International Beauty reportable segment includes the Acquired Units other than those operated in Southern Africa and Japan, as well as the Company’s Tupperware operations in Central and South America and the Philippines which were included in the Company’s Latin America and Asia Pacific reportable segments prior to 2006, respectively. The Company’s Tupperware and BeautiControl operations in Mexico are included in the North America segment; they were included in the Latin America reportable segment prior to 2006. With the movement of Central and South America as well as Mexico, the Company no longer has a Latin America reportable segment. The Company’s NaturCare ® brand business operating in Japan is included in the Asia Pacific segment; it was previously included in the International Beauty reporting segment. This change included the transfer of intangible assets and goodwill of $30.2 million and $24.3 million, respectively. The Company’s Avroy Shlain ® and Swissgarde ® brand businesses operating in Southern Africa are now included in the Europe segment; they were previously included in the International Beauty reportable segment. This change included the transfer of intangible assets and goodwill of $16.6 million and $16.3 million, respectively. 22 Table of Contents Prior period data has been reclassified to reflect these changes. (Dollars in millions) Sales Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl N.A. International Beauty Total net sales Segment profit Europe (b), (c) Asia Pacific (b), (d) North America (d) BeautiControl N.A. International Beauty (b), (e) Segment profit as a percentage of sales Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl N.A. International Beauty Change 2006 2005 Dollar Percent $ 615.9 239.7 255.5 150.0 482.6 $ 1,743.7 $ 94.4 33.8 8.7 14.6 30.8 $ 602.5 204.5 253.6 146.7 72.0 $ 1,279.3 $ 116.2 20.2 0.5 14.0 0.9 $ 13.4 35.2 1.9 3.3 410.6 $ 464.4 $ (21.8 ) 13.6 8.2 0.6 29.9 15 % 14 3 10 6 19 % 10 — 10 1 na na na na na 2% 17 1 2 + 36.3 (19)% 67 + 4 + (4.0) pp 4.2 3.2 0.2 5.1 (a) Change excluding the impact of foreign exchange 1% 17 — 2 + 35 (19)% 59 + 4 + Foreign exchange impact $ 4.9 0.3 0.7 0.2 2.4 $ 8.5 $ 0.5 1.1 (0.2 ) — (0.3 ) (3.9)pp 3.7 3.3 0.2 5.6 (0.1 )pp 0.5 (0.1 ) — (0.5 ) na na na na na Percent of total 2006 2005 35% 14 15 9 28 100 47% 16 20 12 6 100 77% 13 — 52% 19 5 8 17 9 1 na na na na na a. b. c. 2006 actual compared with 2005 translated at 2006 exchange rates. In December 2005, the Company purchased Sara Lee Corporation’s direct selling businesses and its results of operations have been included since the date of acquisition. Europe includes 2006 and 2005 amortization for identified intangibles valued as part of acquisition accounting of $1.7 million and $0.1 million, respectively. d. Asia Pacific includes 2006 and 2005 amortization for identified intangibles valued as part of acquisition accounting of $3.9 million and e. $0.3 million, respectively. International Beauty includes 2006 and 2005 amortization for identified intangibles valued as part of acquisition accounting of $18.1 million and $1.3 million, respectively. Increase greater than 100 percent. + na Not applicable Europe The slight increase in European sales was primarily due to the inclusion of the acquired South African beauty units. Excluding these units, local currency sales were three percent lower largely due to a 14 percent sales decline in Germany, the segment’s largest market, driven by a reduction in total and active sales force. In 2006 and 2005 the German market accounted for $198.0 million and $231.0 million of the segment’s sales, respectively. Additionally, in the Europe segment approximately $8 million less business-to-business sales than last year contributed to the sales decline. While the Company actively pursues business-to-business opportunities, sales from this channel are based on reaching agreements with business partners and their product needs, along with consideration of how the arrangements will be integrated with the party-plan channel. Consequently, activity in one period may not be indicative of future trends. Other markets that were down versus 23 Table of Contents 2005 were the Netherlands, Austria and Switzerland all due to a decrease in average active sales force, and in the case of Switzerland a large business to business transaction that did not recur. These declines were partially offset by Tupperware Southern Africa which had a significant increase in sales versus 2005 driven by good recruiting and increases in total and average active sales force. The emerging markets of Russia, Turkey and Poland had strong increases in 2006 with growth of 46 percent versus last year, while their contribution to total sales for the segment grew from 8 percent in 2005 to 11 percent in 2006. The largest sales growth contribution came from Russia, which was up 60 percent and contributed the largest dollar increase from last year of all markets in the segment. The segment overall ended the year with an eight percent sales force size advantage, but had a decline of eight percent in average active sales force in 2006 versus 2005. Although local currency sales increased slightly, profit was down 17 percent as reported and in local currency resulting in a decline of 3.6 percentage points in return on sales. The lower return on sales was driven by the decline in German sales which, despite the downturn, continue to carry a return above the segment average, and the mix of markets generating the profit, with a slight impact driven by the inclusion of a full year of results for the South African beauty units which operate at a lower return on sales. The higher operating costs were driven by increased costs in the growth markets and higher promotional expenses in an effort to increase the size of the total and active sales forces. Asia Pacific Net sales for the year increased both as reported and in local currency. Excluding NaturCare, the acquired Japan beauty unit that only had sales in one month in 2005, sales were up eight percent in local currency. Sales were up in virtually all markets, led by the emerging markets of China, India and Indonesia, which in total were up 28 percent, with the largest increase coming from China up 44 percent. In China, direct selling has been limited by law, and the Company reaches consumers through independent store fronts where the number of storefronts grew 25 percent to over 2,300. Japan, Korea and Australia had modest growth in local currency versus 2005 driven by a more productive sales force offset by less business-to-business sales in Korea. The decline in Korea’s business-to-business sales is likely to continue. Excluding NaturCare, segment profit increased in both reported and local currency reflecting improvement in most markets and led by the emerging markets. Though costs showed a dollar increase versus 2005, as a percent of sales they were down driven primarily by strong sales growth, resulting in a 4.2 percentage point increase in return on sales. North America The slight increase in North American sales was primarily due to growth by Tupperware Mexico offset by a slight decrease in the United States. Mexico sales were up slightly in local currency driven by a slightly larger sales force, an increase in business-to-business sales and five percent growth in the sale of BeautiControl products. Canada sales were up modestly due to better productivity by the sales force partially due to the implementation of a new compensation plan which mirrors the plan implemented in the U.S. last year. In the United States, sales were down slightly versus last year although they were up in each of the third and fourth quarters versus the prior year. Though total and active sales forces were down for the year, productivity was up driven by the new multi-tier sales force compensation system implemented in 2005. This new compensation system provides for override commissions on group sales with an emphasis on the earnings opportunity and recruiting new sellers into the business. This along with increased Company sponsored training and an experience based party format are designed to continue to improve future results. The Company is seeking to improve its U.S. business through a refreshed, interactive party format, continuing to introduce innovative and fashion forward products, public relations activities to ensure a broad understanding of the Company’s current product categories, innovations and fashionability and a better balance between its emphasis on products and its sales force earnings opportunity. 24 Table of Contents North America’s profit came from Tupperware Mexico where profit was up 12 percent primarily reflecting sales growth but also a slight improvement in promotion and distribution expenses. There was a decrease in the U.S. loss of over 90 percent. The lower loss was driven by a higher gross margin percentage and a reduction in DS&A expenses. The improvement in gross margin was due to the utilization of previously written down product, fewer sales incentive offers and a reduction in the LIFO reserve. The improvement in expenses was primarily due to a reduction in distribution costs driven by improved freight pricing and a greater number of consolidated shipments. Additionally, in the United States, post retirement benefit costs were $1.2 million favorable to last year and are expected to decline another $1.0 to $1.5 million in 2007 (see Note 12 “Retirement Benefit Plans” for further details). BeautiControl North America BeautiControl North America had a slight increase in sales and profit. The business started the year slow but was up 6 percent in the second half of the year. The improvement in sales, particularly in the second half of the year, was due to increased volume reflecting a year- over-year total and active sales force size advantage. Recruiting remained strong again this year with a Spring campaign that was the second largest in BeautiControl’s history. The sales force growth continued to be fueled by both a strong earnings opportunity and an easy, replicable interactive party experience, the “Spa ESCAPE”. The sales growth was the primary reason for the profit improvement along with a slight improvement in gross margin driven by a better mix of sales. These were partially offset by higher operating expenses due to strong recruiting and transition costs incurred for a new manufacturing facility. The transition should be complete by the end of the first quarter of 2007. International Beauty The Acquired Units’ sales and profit were included in the Company’s results beginning on December 5, 2005 with the closing of the Acquisition. The sales increase in the International Beauty segment reflected $442 million of sales by the Acquired Units in the segment. The largest market in the segment, Fuller Mexico, accounts for more than 60 percent of sales and an even greater proportion of segment profit. This business achieved significant sales growth from a larger and more productive sales force versus 2005, which was partially offset primarily by lower sales in the Philippines due a smaller sales force. The prior year results reflect $72.0 million of sales by the Acquired Units and the operations of Tupperware businesses in Central and South America and the Philippines. Combined, these businesses did not materially impact the comparison. Segment profit reflected the same factors as sales, along with approximately $18.1 million of negative impact from amortization expense primarily associated with intangible assets recorded in purchase accounting for the Acquired Units’ sales force relationships. Good progress was made during the year transitioning the Acquired Units into Tupperware Brands. The Nutrimetics Australia business is similar to BeautiControl North America in terms of its skin care focused product line, party plan orientation and sales force compensation model. Its party format and compensation model have been adjusted to be more similar to what has worked well for BeautiControl North America and are expected to reenergize that business. In Central and South America, progress has been made in combining back-office functions in Brazil and in some cases both beauty and Tupperware ® products are being sold by the same sales force. 25 Table of Contents Segment Results 2005 vs. 2004 Change (Dollars in millions) Sales Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl N.A. International Beauty Total net sales Segment profit (loss) Europe (c), (d) Asia Pacific (c), (e) North America (c) BeautiControl N.A. International Beauty (b), (f) Segment profit as a percentage of sales Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl N.A. International Beauty 2005 2004 Dollar Percent $ 602.5 204.5 253.6 146.7 72.0 $ 1,279.3 $ 116.2 20.2 0.5 14.0 0.9 19 % 10 — 10 1 $ 597.0 194.8 278.7 118.0 35.7 $ 1,224.3 $ 133.4 20.5 (22.3 ) 8.0 1.6 $ 5.5 9.7 (25.1 ) 28.7 36.3 $ 55.1 $ (17.2 ) (0.3 ) 22.8 6.0 (0.7 ) 22 % 11 nm 7 4 na na na na na 1% 5 (9) 24 + 5 (13)% (1) nm 75.0 (44) (3.1) pp (0.6) 8.2 2.8 (3.2) (a) Change excluding the impact of foreign exchange —% 5 (11) 24 88 3 (13)% (5) nm 74 (55) Foreign exchange impact $ 6.2 0.6 5.2 0.2 2.6 $ 14.8 $ 0.7 0.8 0.2 — (0.4 ) (2.9)pp (1.0) 8.0 2.7 (4.0) (0.2 )pp 0.4 0.2 — 0.8 Percent of total 2005 2004 47% 16 20 11 6 100 77% 13 — 9 1 na na na na na 49% 16 23 10 3 100 82% 13 na 5 1 na na na na na c. a. b. 2005 actual compared with 2004 translated at 2005 exchange rates. In December 2005, the Company purchased Sara Lee Corporation’s direct selling businesses and its results of operations have been included since the date of acquisition. Includes machinery relocation costs incurred in 2005 in connection with a shift of capacity from Hemingway, South Carolina to other manufacturing facilities. Amounts included are $0.9 million in Europe, $0.5 million in Asia Pacific and $1.8 million in North America. Also includes a credit of $5.6 million due to a reduction in LIFO reserve requirements as a result of the shift of capacity to facilities that cost inventory on a FIFO basis. d. Europe includes 2005 amortization for identified intangibles valued as part of acquisition accounting of $0.1 million. e. Asia Pacific includes 2005 amortization for identified intangibles valued as part of acquisition accounting of $0.3 million. f. + na Not applicable nm Not meaningful International Beauty includes 2005 amortization for identified intangibles valued as part of acquisition accounting of $1.3 million. Increase greater than 100 percent. Europe The slight increase in European sales was primarily due to higher business-to-business sales of $11.5 million at exchange rates consistent with 2004. The emerging markets of Russia, Turkey and Poland had strong increases in 2005 with growth of 41 percent from last year. The largest sales growth contribution came from Russia, which was up over 50 percent and contributed the largest dollar increase from last year of all markets in 26 Table of Contents the segment. South Africa and France also contributed nicely to sales growth from 2004 due to larger total and active sales forces. These positive results were partially offset by large sales declines in the Nordics, Netherlands, Austria and Germany. The segment’s largest market, Germany, was down eight percent from last year. While it ended the year with a larger sales force size, for most of the year it operated at a sales force size disadvantage. Additionally, a sales force size advantage for most of the fourth quarter did not offset lower sales force productivity due to a difficult consumer environment. Sales in 2005 in Germany totaled $231.0 million, as compared with $251.1 million in 2004. The segment overall ended the year with a 13 percent sales force size advantage and achieved a 6 percent average active sales force size advantage in the fourth quarter of 2005 versus 2004. Overall, the segment’s sales decline absent the business-to-business impact noted above was due to lower sales volume, partially offset by a slight increase in overall pricing. The average pricing increase was negatively impacted by the mix of products sold. There was also a negative impact from the mix of markets generating sales. Although local currency sales increased slightly, profit was down 13 percent as reported and 12 percent in local currency primarily due to a lower gross margin and higher operating expenses. The lower gross margin was a result of higher resin costs, which were not totally offset by price increases, and a less favorable sales mix. The increased operating expenses were primarily for higher promotional expenses in Germany to increase the size of the sales force. Asia Pacific Net sales for the year increased slightly both as reported and in local currency. This comparison benefited from the inclusion in 2004 of a product recall in Japan that resulted in sales returns of $5.5 million, at the 2005 foreign exchange rate. Excluding this benefit, local currency sales would have been flat. Significant sales increases in China and Korea combined with a strong increase in Australia were partially offset by a significant sales decline in Japan. China sales grew over 70 percent and contributed the largest dollar increase in the Asia Pacific segment during 2005 with almost 2,000 storefronts operating at the end of 2005, which was up over 50 percent from 2004. Storefront sales productivity was up as well. Korea benefited from higher business-to-business transactions and core sales during the year, while Australia grew sales through a higher active and more productive sales force. Asia Pacific had a small decline in overall sales volume for the year, but was able to offset that with a more favorable mix of products sold as well as lower overall sales discounting. In spite of a slight sales increase, both reported and local currency profit was flat reflecting results in Japan. The product recall in Japan mentioned earlier had no impact on the profitability comparison as the vendor reimbursed the Company for lost profit and costs related to the recall. North America North America had a decline in sales in 2005 due to lower volume that was only partially offset by an improved product mix that included fewer sales force support items. This was due almost exclusively to the performance in the United States, which continued to struggle and had a 28 percent decline in the number of average active sellers in 2005 versus 2004. In April 2005, the Company completed its implementation of a multi- tier compensation system for its sales force. The new system is more competitive in the U.S. market than the previous format and emphasizes building one’s business through recruiting. The Company started training its independent sales force in 2004 to operate successfully under this new model. 27 Table of Contents Mexico had a slight increase in sales for the year driven by an increase in the total and active sales force count along with continued growth in the sale of BeautiControl products. Beauty sales grew 20 percent compared with 2004 and accounted for 10 percent of Mexican sales. Mexico profit improved slightly due to sales growth however, profit growth was less due to strategic investments made to expand BeautiControl’s sales contribution. The segment was about break even in spite of the substantial sales decline in the United States results. This improvement was largely due to the significant improvements in the United States driven by value chain improvements implemented during 2004 and 2005 including a restructure of its manufacturing operations in Hemingway, South Carolina to source the majority of its products from the Company’s other manufacturing facilities. The Company also realized a benefit of $7.2 million from reduced LIFO reserve needs as United States-produced inventory was sold including $5.6 million directly related to the capacity shift. Additionally, the United States benefited from an approximate four million dollars reallocation of corporate overhead charges. BeautiControl North America BeautiControl North America had substantial increases in both sales and segment profit in 2005 which were largely volume related. A higher proportion of sales of low priced items to support increased recruiting resulted in a slightly lower average selling price. The improved performance was a result of substantial increases in both the total and active sales forces during the year with the business closing 2005 with a 20 percent advantage in the total sales force. The sales force growth was fueled by both a strong earnings opportunity and an easy, replicable interactive party experience, the “Spa ESCAPE”. The sales growth was the primary reason for the profit improvement along with the absence of an approximate $2.5 million charge in the first quarter of 2004 related to an accrual for legal matters and an executive retirement. International Beauty The Acquired Units’ sales and profit were included in the Company’s results beginning on December 5, 2005 with the closing of the acquisition of Sara Lee Corporation’s direct selling businesses. The sales and profit were $37.9 million and $0.9 million, respectively, including $1.3 million of purchase accounting amortization. Sales and profit were strong in Fuller Mexico, partially offset by some weakness in Australia and Fuller Philippines. After considering incremental interest expense related to the acquisition, the Acquired Units had little net impact on 2005 earnings. The balance of this segment consisted of Tupperware Central and South America and the Philippines. Combined, these operations did not have a significant impact on segment results as the negative impact of a large decline in the Philippines’ average active sales force was balanced by improvement in Central and South America. Financial Condition Liquidity and Capital Resources . Working capital increased, reaching $220.5 million as of December 30, 2006 compared with $218.0 million as of December 31, 2005 and $173.9 million as of December 25, 2004. The current ratio was 1.6 to 1 at the end of 2006 compared with 1.5 to 1 at the end of 2005 and 1.6 to 1 at the end of 2004. The 2006 working capital increase was primarily due to cash generated from operations and an increase in accounts receivable driven by strong year-end sales in Mexico. These were partially offset by an increase in accounts payable. See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for further details. The 2005 working capital increase, exclusive of the impact from the Acquired Units, was due to an increase in cash primarily from cash generated from operations, including the settlement of pre-June 1996 income taxes with the Company’s former parent, along with proceeds received upon the exercise of stock options, partially offset by the pay down of debt. Another impact was a decrease in accounts payable in the existing businesses 28 Table of Contents primarily due to the timing of year end. The December 31 year-end for 2005 resulted in more of the Company’s trade payables coming due before the end of the year. Of the Company’s year-end cash balance of $181.5 million, $105 million was paid out in 2006 in connection with the Acquisition. This included approximately $80 million of taxes that had been withheld for the benefit of a subsidiary of Sara Lee Corporation related to its sale of the Mexican operations and other income tax items related to the Acquisition. The $44.1 million overall working capital increase in relation to the Acquisition is summarized as follows: (In millions) Acquired Units Tax accruals related to the Acquisition Pre-acquisition existing business Total working capital increase 2005 vs. 2004 $94.1 (93.7) 43.7 $44.1 In conjunction with closing the Acquisition on December 5, 2005, the Company entered into a new credit agreement that included a seven-year $775 million term loan bearing an annual interest rate of 150 basis points over the LIBOR rate and a $200 million revolving credit facility. This agreement replaced the Company’s previously existing $200 million revolving line of credit. The Company used cash on hand and the term loan borrowings to fund the amount due to Sara Lee Corporation, to discharge its then outstanding $100 million notes due in 2006 and to repay its $150 million notes due in 2011. The settlement of the 2011 notes required make-whole payments to the note holders of approximately $22 million. In anticipation of this transaction, the Company closed fixed to variable interest rate swaps with combined notional amounts totaling $150 million that were scheduled to expire in 2011 with the notes. These swaps were entered to convert the Company’s $150 million notes from fixed to variable interest rates. Closing these swaps resulted in a loss of approximately $3.1 million that was recorded as a component of income when the notes were settled. As also discussed in the market risk section, the Company exited an agreement to lock in a fixed 10-year treasury rate that was to provide the base interest for an anticipated refinancing of its $100 million 2006 notes. The $3.1 million cost to exit this arrangement was recorded as a component of interest expense in the third quarter of 2005. In addition to the amounts discussed above, upon closure of the transaction, the Company expensed unamortized debt issuance costs relating to the settled debt totaling approximately $0.8 million and recognized deferred net gains related to previously terminated hedging arrangements associated with the settled debt. These net gains were $3.2 million. Unamortized debt issuance costs of approximately $0.6 million related to the Company’s existing revolving credit agreement were added to the costs related to the new revolver and are being amortized over its 5-year term. Borrowings under the credit agreement are secured by substantially all of the Company’s domestic assets and 65 percent of its stock in its significant foreign subsidiaries. Principal payments on the term loan are 1 percent of the original amount per year in years 1 to 6 and the first 3 quarters of year 7 in quarterly installments. The balance will be due in a balloon payment at the end of the seven-year term. The agreement also requires additional principal payments consisting of 100 percent of cash generated from certain asset sales and new debt issuances as well as up to 50 percent of excess cash flows. Excess cash flows are substantively defined as net cash provided by operating activities less capital expenditures, required debt payments and dividends paid up to $60 million annually. While the covenants are restrictive and could inhibit the Company’s ability to pay dividends or buy back stock, the Company currently believes it will be able to continue paying its current $0.22 per share quarterly dividend under the covenant requirements. See further information in Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements. The $775.0 million Term Loan was reduced to $745.0 million at the end of 2005, and principal payments made during 2006 further reduced the balance to $669.2 million as of December 30, 2006. Due to prepayments made in the fourth quarter of 2005, the Company had no scheduled payments in 2006. However, the Company made voluntary payments of $63.0 million and mandatory payments of $12.8 million. The mandatory payments were a result of the sale of land in the Orlando, Florida area. The Company’s two debt rating agencies, Standard and Poor’s and Moody’s, have both rated the Company. Standard and Poor’s currently rates the corporate credit rating of the Company BB and assigns a stable outlook. Moody’s assigns a rating of Ba2 to the corporate family rating of the Company. 29 Table of Contents As of December 30, 2006, the Company had $186.2 million available under its revolving line of credit and $121.0 million available under other uncommitted lines of credit, along with a cash balance of $102.2 million. Current and committed borrowing facilities and cash generated by operating activities are expected to be adequate to finance working capital needs and capital expenditures. The Company’s major markets for its products are Australia, France, Germany, Japan, Mexico, Russia and the United States. A significant downturn in the Company’s business in these markets would adversely impact the Company’s ability to generate operating cash flows. The previously discussed downturn in the Company’s German business has impacted its ability to contribute the same historical level of operating cash flows to the Company and the operating losses in the Tupperware United States business has impacted its ability to contribute operating cash flows. However, neither of these situations has resulted in a material negative impact to the Company as a whole. Operating cash flows would also be adversely impacted by significant difficulties in the recruitment, retention and activity of the Company’s independent sales force, the success of new products and promotional programs. Included in the cash balance of $102.2 million reported at the end of 2006 was $10.3 million denominated in Venezuela bolivars. The balance is primarily a result of favorable operating cash flows in the market. Due to Venezuelan government restrictions on transfers of cash out of the country and control of exchange rates, the Company can not immediately repatriate this cash at the exchange rate used to translate the Venezuelan bolivars into U.S. dollars for inclusion on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. It will apply for, and expects to receive, authorization in 2007 to transfer approximately half of such amount out of the country. It has also implemented other strategies in an effort to eventually repatriate the entire cash balance. The Company believes it could immediately repatriate the cash from Venezuela, but it would only be able to do so at a significantly less favorable exchange rate. This would result in the Company having fewer U.S. dollars than currently reported as a component of cash and cash equivalents on its consolidated balance sheet with the difference recorded as a foreign exchange loss in its consolidated income statement. The debt-to-total capital ratio at the end of 2006 was 63 percent compared with 69 percent at the end of 2005. Debt is defined as total debt and capital is defined as total debt plus shareholders’ equity. The decrease in debt from the same period a year ago reflected the debt principal payments made from cash generated from operations and from the sale of real estate in the Orlando, Florida area. The increase in equity resulted largely from earnings in 2006, reduced by dividends paid during the year. Operating Activities . Net cash provided by operating activities for 2006 was $172.8 compared with $139.9 million in 2005 and $121.4 million in 2004. The increase in cash from operating activities in 2006 versus 2005 reflected higher cash pretax income, excluding land sales, of close to $70 million, along with a cash inflow from higher payables and accruals this year as opposed to an outflow last year. The improvement in payables and accruals was largely due to the management of the timing of payments and the volume of business in certain markets. There were also smaller improvements in inventory from the sale of slow moving items in certain markets and in non-trade receivables reflecting lower VAT receivables and amounts relating to hedging transactions. The main offsets were from cash tax payments of $30 million this year versus net receipts of $35 million in 2005 that included a $46 million receipt from the Company’s former parent. There was also an outflow from trade receivables in 2006, versus an inflow in 2005, reflecting higher December sales in certain markets, as well as higher past due amounts. The increase from 2004 to 2005 was primarily due to the $46 million received in connection with settling pre-June 1996 income taxes with the Company’s former parent. The Company also received a refund of approximately $10 million from the United States Internal Revenue Service in settlement of audits for the period 1996 to 2001. These items were partially offset by a decrease in accounts payable and accrued liabilities. There was a cash inflow from settling hedge contracts this year versus an outflow last year due to a weaker U.S. dollar during 2005 than in 2004. 30 Table of Contents Investing Activities . For 2006, 2005 and 2004, the Company spent $52.1 million, $52.0 million and $43.6 million respectively, for capital expenditures. The most significant type of spending in all years was for molds for new products with the greatest amount spent in Europe. The slight increase from last year was primarily due to higher spending on improvements made for capacity expansion at BeautiControl North America. See Note 14 to the consolidated financial statements. Partially offsetting the capital spending was $25.5 million in 2006, $8.0 million in 2005 and $16.6 million in 2004, of proceeds related to the sale of certain property, plant and equipment in addition to insurance proceeds received in 2006 and 2004 for property damaged by a hurricane in 2004. The proceeds from the sales were primarily related to land for development near the Company’s Orlando, Florida headquarters. Cumulative proceeds from the Company’s program to sell land for development which began in 2002, are now expected to be up to $125 million by the end of 2009, including $58 million received through the end of 2006, inclusive of the sale of the Company’s former convention center facility. Additionally, 2006 and 2005 included net cash outflows of $104.9 million and $464.3 million, respectively, in connection with the Acquisition. See discussion above in Liquidity and Capital Resources. Financing Activities . The primary financing activities were the net proceeds from issuance of term debt of $762.5 million to fund the Acquisition and refinance existing debt in 2005 as well as net repayments of $77 million primarily related to the term loan. See detailed discussion in Liquidity and Capital resources including settlement of historical debt and related covenant restrictions. Dividends. During 2006, 2005 and 2004, the Company paid dividends of $0.88 per share of common stock totaling $53.3 million, $52.4 million and $51.6 million, respectively. At the time of its emergence as a publicly held corporation with its spin off from Premark International, Inc. in May 1996, the Company established a target of paying 35 percent of trailing four quarter income as a dividend. At that time, such a policy equated to a dividend level of approximately $0.88 per share annually. Despite decreases in income, the Company has generated sufficient cash flows from operations, dispositions of property and available borrowing capacity to fund its historical requirement for cash over the period since the spin off, including working capital and capital spending needs, its share repurchase program concluded in 1998, its acquisition of BeautiControl in 2000, the Sara Lee direct selling businesses in 2005, debt service and its dividend. As noted above, a majority of the Acquisition was funded through new borrowings. While the payment of a dividend on common shares is a discretionary decision made on a quarterly basis, in the absence of a significant event requiring cash, the Company has no current expectation of altering the dividend level as projected cash flows from operations as well as additional property sales are expected to be sufficient to maintain the dividend without restricting the Company’s ability to finance its operations, make necessary investments in the future growth of the business or its near-term debt repayment obligations. If there is an event requiring the use of cash, such as a strategic acquisition, the Company would need to reevaluate whether to maintain its current dividend payout. Stock Option Exercises . During 2006, 2005 and 2004, the Company received proceeds of $7.4 million, $30.2 million and $4.1 million, respectively, related to the exercise of outstanding stock options. The corresponding shares were issued out of the Company’s balance held in treasury. Subscriptions Receivable. In October 2000, a subsidiary of the Company adopted a Management Stock Purchase Plan (the MSPP), which provided for eligible executives to purchase Company stock using full recourse loans provided by the subsidiary. Under the MSPP, the Company loaned $13.6 million to 33 senior executives to purchase 847,000 common shares from treasury stock. In 2001 and 2002, an additional nine senior executives purchased 74,500 shares of common stock from treasury stock utilizing loans totaling $1.7 million. The loans have annual interest rates of 5.21 percent to 5.96 percent, and all dividends, while the loans are outstanding, are applied toward interest due. Each of the loans has scheduled repayment dates of 25 percent on the fifth and sixth anniversaries of the loan issuance, with the balance due on the eighth anniversary. There were no new participants during 2006, 2005, or 2004. During each of 2005 and 2004, two participants left the Company and surrendered 38,802 and 37,000 shares, respectively, to the Company, at the current market price, to satisfy loans 31 Table of Contents totaling $0.8 million and $0.7 million, respectively. The MSPP permits the surrender of shares in lieu of payment of the loan with the surrendered shares valued at the then current market price. During 2006, thirteen participants surrendered a total of 99,388 shares of the Company’s common stock to the Company at current market prices to satisfy loans totaling $2.1 million as part of both scheduled and voluntary repayments. In addition, participants made cash payments to satisfy loan and interest payment obligations totaling $0.5 million. During 2005, 22 executives surrendered 254,441 shares to satisfy $5.6 million of loans and four participants made cash payments to satisfy loan payment obligations totaling $0.6 million. An additional participant left the Company during 2004 and made a cash payment of $0.7 million to satisfy the loan obligation. Also during 2004, a participant elected to make a voluntary advance loan payment totaling $0.6 million. Based upon the provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, no further loans under this plan will be permitted. Based upon the loan payment schedule, the Company expects to receive $1.3 million of payments during 2007. On November 30, 1998, the Company made a non-recourse, non-interest bearing loan of $7.7 million (the loan) to its chairman and chief executive officer (chairman), the proceeds of which were used by the chairman to buy in the open market 400,000 shares of the Company’s common stock (the shares) at an average price of $19.12 per share. The shares were pledged to secure the repayment of the loan. The loan was recorded as a subscription receivable and was due November 12, 2006, with voluntary prepayments permitted commencing November 12, 2002, and mandatory repayments equal to 10 percent of annual bonus payments. On October 26, 2006 the Company’s chairman and chief executive officer surrendered 330,368 shares of the Company’s common stock at the current market price of $21.49 in satisfaction of the $7.1 million outstanding balance, which had previously been reduced through cash payments of $0.6 million. Contractual Obligations The following summarizes the Company’s contractual obligations at December 30, 2006, and the effect such obligations are expected to have on its liquidity and cash flow in future periods (in millions). Other borrowings Long-term debt (a) Interest payments on term debt (b) Pension funding Post employment medical benefits Operating lease obligations Total contractual obligations Total $ 1.2 680.2 261.2 130.5 40.5 69.8 $ 1,134.8 Less than 1 year $ 0.9 — 44.3 8.6 4.4 24.7 $ 82.2 1 –3 years $ 0.3 21.3 87.3 18.5 8.8 26.0 $ 156.7 3 –5 years $ — 16.7 84.5 30.8 8.6 10.3 $ 134.8 More than 5 Years $ — 642.2 45.1 72.6 18.7 8.8 $ 761.1 a. b. Includes balance under the Company’s term loan facility due 2012 and 8.33 percent Mortgage Note due 2009 Includes interest payments due on the Company’s term loan facility due 2012, 8.33 percent Mortgage Note due 2009, borrowings on its revolving credit facilities and the estimated impact of interest rate swap agreements in place. Year end 2006 interest rates were used where the underlying instrument calls for a variable rate. Application of Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations is based upon the Company’s consolidated financial statements which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The preparation of these financial statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported and disclosed amounts. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions. The Company believes the following critical accounting policies affect its more significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation of its consolidated financial statements. 32 Table of Contents Allowance for Doubtful Accounts. The Company maintains current and long-term receivable amounts with most of its independent distributors and sales force in certain markets. The Company regularly monitors and assesses its risk of not collecting amounts owed to it by its customers. This evaluation is based upon an analysis of amounts currently and past due along with relevant history and facts particular to the customer. It is also based upon estimates of distributor business prospects, particularly related to the evaluation of the recoverability of long- term amounts due. This evaluation is performed market by market and account by account based upon historical experience, market penetration levels, access to alternative channels and similar factors. It also considers collateral of the customer that could be recovered to satisfy debts. Based upon the results of this analysis, for this risk the Company records an allowance for uncollectible accounts. This analysis requires the Company to make significant estimates, and changes in facts and circumstances could result in material changes in the allowance for doubtful accounts. Inventory Valuation . The Company writes down its inventory for estimated obsolescence or unmarketable inventory equal to the difference between the cost of the inventory and the estimated market value based upon estimates of future demand. The demand is estimated based upon the historical success of product lines as well as the projected success of promotional programs, new product introductions and new markets or distribution channels. The Company prepares projections of demand on an item by item basis for all of its products. If inventory quantity exceeds projected demand, the excess inventory is written down. However, if actual demand is less than projected by management, additional inventory write-downs may be required. Income Taxes. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets also are recognized for credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted rates applicable to taxable income in the years in which the temporary differences are expected to reverse and the credits are expected to be used. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of the change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. An assessment is made as to whether or not a valuation allowance is required to offset deferred tax assets. This assessment requires estimates as to future operating results as well as an evaluation of the effectiveness of the Company’s tax planning strategies. These estimates are made based upon the Company’s business plans and growth strategies in each market and are made on an ongoing basis; consequently, future material changes in the valuation allowance are possible. Any change in valuation allowance amounts is reflected in the period in which the change occurs. At the end of 2006, the Company had net domestic deferred tax assets of approximately $186.5 million against which a valuation allowance of $2.4 million has been provided. Of this total, approximately $63.9 million relates to recurring type temporary differences which reverse regularly and are replaced by newly originated items. The balance is primarily related to foreign tax credits and federal and state net operating losses that are expected to be realized prior to expiration based upon an increase in domestic income from BeautiControl North America as well as expected improvement in the Tupperware United States business. Also, expected gains related to the Company’s previously discussed Orlando land sales activities will result in the realization of a portion of these assets. In addition, certain tax planning transactions are available to the Company should they be necessary. Promotional and Other Accruals. The Company frequently makes promotional offers to its independent sales force to encourage them to meet specific goals or targets for sales levels, party attendance, recruiting or other business critical activities. The awards offered are in the form of cash, product awards, special prizes or trips. The cost of these awards is recorded during the period over which the sales force qualifies for the award. These accruals require estimates as to the cost of the awards based upon estimates of achievement and actual cost to be incurred. The Company makes these estimates on a market by market and program by program basis. It considers the historical success of similar programs, current market trends and perceived enthusiasm of the sales force when the program is launched. During the promotion qualification period, actual results are monitored and changes to the original estimates that are necessary are made when known. Like the promotional accruals, other accruals are recorded at a time when the liability is probable and the amount is reasonably estimable. Adjustments to amounts previously accrued are made when changes in the facts and circumstances that generated the accrual occur. 33 Table of Contents Valuation of Goodwill . The Company’s recorded goodwill relates primarily to that generated by its acquisition of BeautiControl in October 2000 and the Acquired Units in December 2005. The Company conducts an annual impairment test of its recorded goodwill in the second and third quarter of each year related to the BeautiControl and the Acquired Units, respectively. Additionally, in the event of a change in circumstances that would lead the Company to believe that a triggering event for impairment may have occurred, a test would be completed at that time. The valuation of its goodwill is dependent upon the estimated fair market value of its BeautiControl operations both in North America and internationally and the operations of the Acquired Units. The Company estimates the fair value of its BeautiControl and Acquired Units’ operations using discounted future cash flow estimates. Such a valuation requires the Company to make significant estimates regarding future operations and the ability to generate cash flows including projections of revenue, costs, utilization of assets and capital requirements. It also requires estimates in allocating the goodwill to the different segments that include BeautiControl operations (BeautiControl North America, Asia Pacific and Mexico) and the Acquired Units operations (Europe, Asia Pacific and International Beauty). Lastly, it requires estimates as to the appropriate discounting rates to be used. The results of the reviews conducted to date related to BeautiControl and the Acquired Units indicate fair values in excess of the carrying values of the respective business operations. The most sensitive estimate in this evaluation is the projection of operating cash flows as these provide the basis for the fair market valuation. If operating cash flows were to be more than 20 percent worse than projected, the Company would need to calculate a potential impairment as it relates to BeautiControl operations in Mexico and the Acquired Units operations at Nutrimetics ® , NaturCare ® and the South African beauty units. In BeautiControl and the remaining Acquired Units’ operations, a reduction of operating cash flows of more than 75 percent would be required to necessitate calculating a potential impairment. A significant impairment would have an adverse impact on the Company’s net income and could result in a lack of compliance with the Company’s debt covenants. Other Intangible Assets. The Company recorded as assets the fair value of various trademarks and trade names of $197.4 million in conjunction with its purchase of the Acquired Units. These amounts have an indefinite life and will be evaluated for impairment as discussed in goodwill valuation above. Additionally, the Company recorded $62 million for valuation of the Acquired Units’ sales forces, and $3.6 million for product formulations. The estimated aggregate annual amortization expense associated with the above intangibles for each of the five succeeding years is $12.7 million, $8.7 million, $5.4 million, $3.8 million and $2.7 million, respectively. Retirement Obligations. The Company’s employee pension and other post-employment benefits (health care) costs and obligations are dependent on its assumptions used by actuaries in calculating such amounts. These assumptions include health care cost trend rates, salary growth, long-term return on plan assets, discount rates and other factors. The health care cost trend assumptions are based upon historical results, the near-term outlook and an assessment of long-term trends. The salary growth assumptions reflect the Company’s historical experience and outlook. The long-term return on plan assets are based upon historical results of the plan and investment market overall, as well as the Company’s belief as to the future returns to be earned over the life of the plans. The discount rate is based upon current yields of AA- rated corporate long-term bond yields. The Company’s key assumptions and funding expectations are indicated in Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements. In the fourth quarter of 2006 the Company amended its domestic retiree medical plan effective April 1, 2007. Prior to the effective date but after January 1, 1995, the Company subsidized the cost of health care for retirees based on age and years of service. For under age 65 retirees, the amendment altered the Company’s contribution from a percent of cost to a fixed amount. For over age 65 retirees, the amendment lowered the fixed subsidy amount. For former associates retired prior to January 1, 1995 and under the age of 80, the amendment introduced a monthly premium charge of $35 per covered adult. The change resulted in a decrease of expense of $0.3 million in 2006 and is expected to decrease the annual cost by approximately $1.5 million in 2007 and thereafter. 34 Table of Contents Effective December 30, 2006, the Company adopted the recognition and disclosure provisions of SFAS No.158 Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R) . This Statement requires employers to recognize in their balance sheets the overfunded or underfunded status of defined benefit post-retirement plans, measured as the difference between the fair value of plan assets and the benefit obligation (the projected benefit obligation for pension plans and the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation for other post-retirement plans). Employers must recognize the change in the funded status of the plan in the year in which the change occurs through accumulated other comprehensive income. This Statement also requires plan assets and obligations to be measured as of the employers’ balance sheet date. Prior to the adoption of the recognition provisions of SFAS No. 158, the Company accounted for its defined benefit post-retirement plans under SFAS No. 87, Employers Accounting for Pensions and SFAS No. 106, Employers’ Accounting for Postretirement Benefits Other Than Pensions . SFAS No. 87 required that a liability (minimum pension liability) be recorded when the accumulated benefit obligation (ABO) liability exceeded the fair value of plan assets. Any adjustment was recorded as a non-cash charge to accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity. SFAS No. 106 required that the liability recorded should represent the actuarial present value of all future benefits attributable to an employee’s service rendered to date. Under both SFAS No. 87 and No. 106, changes in the funded status were not immediately recognized, rather they were deferred and recognized ratably over future periods. Upon adoption of the recognition provisions of SFAS No. 158, the Company recognized the amounts of prior changes in the funded status of its post-retirement benefit plans through accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). For 2005, the Company increased its health care cost trend rate to 10 percent for all participants grading down to 5 percent in 2010. This change represented an increase of one percentage point for post-65 age participants and three percentage points for pre-65 age participants. As a result, 2005 pretax expense related to the Company’s post-employment health care plan increased approximately $0.5 million. Unrecognized losses on post-employment plans as shown in Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements are not expected to result in a material increase of pretax expense as compared with that of 2005. Effective June 30, 2005, the Company froze the accrual of benefits to participants under its domestic defined benefit pension plans. This action necessitated a re-measurement of its accumulated benefit obligation under the plans and resulted in a pretax increase of $4.8 million ($3.1 million after tax). This change resulted in the elimination of the service cost component of net periodic pension expense as it relates to these plans and an ongoing annual reduction of approximately $2.5 million or about $1.2 million as compared with 2005. Due to an excess of lump sum retirement distributions from its domestic pension plans as compared with service and interest costs, the Company recorded a settlement charge of approximately $0.9 million in 2005. In conjunction with the benefit freeze, the Company increased its basic contribution related to one of its domestic defined contribution plans from 3 percent of eligible employee compensation up to the Social Security Wage Base to 5 percent. Impact of Inflation Inflation as measured by consumer price indices has continued at a low level in most of the countries in which the Company operates. New Pronouncements Refer to discussion of new pronouncements in the notes to the consolidated financial statements. 35 Table of Contents Market Risk One of the Company’s market risks is its exposure to the impact of interest rate changes. The Company has elected to manage this risk through the maturity structure of its borrowings, interest rate swaps, the currencies in which it borrows and the interest rate lock described below. The Company has previously set a target, over time, of having approximately half of its borrowings with fixed rates based either on the stated terms or through the use of interest rate swap agreements. As discussed earlier, the Company’s post-acquisition term debt carries a variable interest rate, but requires the Company to maintain a fixed interest rate on at least 40 percent of total debt during the term of the loan. The Company entered into swap agreements in December 2005 and January 2006 to fix the rate on $375 million of its debt for at least three years from the date of the contracts at a rate of approximately 6.3 percent. If short-term interest rates varied by 10 percent the Company’s annual interest expense would be impacted by approximately $2.5 million. The Company had intended to refinance its $100 million notes when they came due in 2006. To protect itself from the risk of higher interest rates, in March 2005, the Company entered into an agreement to lock in a fixed 10-year treasury rate of approximately 4.70 percent that would provide the base interest for the debt to be issued in the refinancing. This derivative was designated as a cash flow hedge and was recorded at its fair value on a quarterly basis. In light of the refinancing necessary for the Acquisition, the agreement was terminated since it was no longer an effective hedge. This action resulted in a charge of $3.1 million in interest expense during the third quarter of 2005. During 2002, the Company entered an interest rate swap agreement with a notional amount of 6.7 billion Japanese yen that matured on January 24, 2007. The Company paid a fixed rate payment of 0.63 percent semi-annually and received a Japanese yen floating rate payment based on the LIBOR rate which is determined two days before each interest payment date. At inception the Company believed that this agreement would provide a valuable economic hedge against rising interest rates in Japan by converting the variable interest rate implicit in the Company’s rolling net equity hedges in Japan to a fixed rate. The balance of net equity hedges in Japan was reduced with a large reduction occurring in the second quarter of 2005. The Company, however, maintained the interest rate swap agreement until maturity. This agreement did not qualify for hedge accounting treatment under SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities . Accordingly, changes in the market value of the swap were recorded as a component of net interest expense as incurred. As of December 30, 2006, the cumulative loss was about $0.4 million, which was fully recognized in 2007. A significant portion of the Company’s sales and profit comes from its international operations. Although these operations are geographically dispersed, which partially mitigates the risks associated with operating in particular countries, the Company is subject to the usual risks associated with international operations. These risks include local political and economic environments, and relations between foreign and U.S. governments. Another economic risk of the Company is exposure to foreign currency exchange rates on the earnings, cash flows and financial position of the Company’s international operations. The Company is not able to project in any meaningful way the possible effect of these fluctuations on translated amounts or future earnings. This is due to the Company’s constantly changing exposure to various currencies, the fact that all foreign currencies do not react in the same manner in relation to the U.S. dollar and the large number of currencies involved, although the Company’s most significant exposures are to the euro and Mexican peso. Although this currency risk is partially mitigated by the natural hedge arising from the Company’s local product sourcing in many markets, a strengthening U.S. dollar generally has a negative impact on the Company. In response to this fact, the Company uses financial instruments, such as forward contracts, to hedge its exposure to certain foreign exchange risks associated with a portion of its investment in international operations. In addition to hedging against the balance sheet impact of changes in exchange rates, the hedge of investments in international operations also has the effect of hedging a portion of cash flows from those operations. The Company also hedges with these instruments certain other exposures to various currencies arising from amounts payable and receivable, non-permanent intercompany loans and forecasted purchases. 36 Table of Contents During the first quarter of 2007, the Company expects to enter into a series of new forward contracts that will significantly reduce interest expense in the future by selling forward and additional $50 million of Japanese yen and $300 million of euro. The forward contracts will deemed to be Net Equity Hedges under the guidelines provided by SFAS 133, and will effectively convert a larger portion of the Company’s US dollar denominated debt into euro and Japanese yen. This action is expected to reduce interest expense during 2007 by approximately $5.0 million. It will increase the risk to the Company’s cash flow, as the settlement at maturity of these new forward contracts will be impacted by changes in exchange rates but be mitigated somewhat by allowing the Company to settle debt effectively in currencies generating a greater proportion of its operating cash flows. During the first quarter of 2007, the Company will begin hedging $50 million worth of its yen net equity and $300 million of its euro net equity through a series of new forward contracts. This will significantly reduce interest expense in the future with an approximate $5.0 million impact in 2007. The initial forward contracts will mature in 2007 and 2008 and will be settled in cash such that the Company will be exposed to fluctuations in the value of the yen and euro versus the U.S. dollar. Over time, this exposure is expected to be offset by changes in the value of operating cash flows generated in the yen and the euro. The Company continuously monitors its foreign currency exposure and may enter into additional contracts to hedge exposure in the future. See further discussion regarding the Company’s hedging activities for foreign currency in Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements. The Company is also exposed to rising material prices in its manufacturing operations and in particular the cost of oil and natural gas- based resins. This is the primary material used in production of Tupperware products, and totaled about $85 million in 2006. A 10 percent fluctuation in the cost of resin could therefore impact the Company’s annual cost of sales in the eight to nine million dollar range as compared with the prior year. The Company manages this risk by utilizing a centralized procurement function that is able to take advantage of bulk discounts while maintaining multiple suppliers and also enters into short-term pricing arrangements. It also manages its margin through the pricing of its products, with price increases generally in line with consumer inflation, and its mix of sales through its promotional programs and discount offers. It may also, on occasion, make advance material purchases to take advantage of what it perceives to be favorable pricing. At this point in time, the Company has determined that entering forward contracts for resin prices is not cost beneficial and has no such contracts in place. However, should circumstances warrant, the Company may consider such contracts in the future. The Company’s program to sell land held for development is also exposed to the risks inherent in the real estate development process. Included among these risks are the ability to obtain all government approvals, the success of buyers in attracting tenants for commercial developments in the Orlando real estate market and general economic conditions, such as interest rate increases. Forward-Looking Statements Certain written and oral statements made or incorporated by reference from time to time by the Company or its representatives in this report, other reports, filings with the SEC, press releases, conferences or otherwise are “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Statements in this report that are not based on historical facts or information are forward- looking statements. Such forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties which may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected in forward-looking statements. Such risks and uncertainties include, among others, the following: • • successful recruitment, retention and productivity levels of the Company’s independent sales force; disruptions caused by the introduction of new distributor operating models or sales force compensation systems; 37 Table of Contents • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • success of new products and promotional programs; the ability to implement appropriate product mix and pricing strategies; the impact of changes in consumer spending patterns and preferences, particularly given the global nature of the Company’s business the value of long-term assets, particularly goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles associated with acquisitions, and the realizability of the value of recognized tax assets; increases in plastic resin prices; the introduction of Company operations in new markets outside the United States; general economic and business conditions in markets, including social, economic, political and competitive uncertainties; the impact of substantial currency fluctuations on the results of foreign operations and the cost of sourcing foreign products and the success of foreign hedging and risk management strategies; the ability to obtain all government approvals on and to control the cost of infrastructure obligations associated with land development; the success of land buyers in attracting tenants for commercial development; the costs and covenant restrictions associated with financing the acquisition of new businesses and the disruption caused by taking focus from on-going lines of business to integrate acquired businesses into the organization; integration of non-traditional product lines into Company operations; the effect of legal, regulatory and tax proceedings, as well as restrictions imposed on the Company, operations or Company representatives by foreign governments; the Company’s access to financing; and other risks discussed in Item 1A, Risk Factors , as well as the Company’s consolidated financial statements, notes, other financial information appearing elsewhere in this report and the Company’s other filings with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission. The Company does not intend to regularly update forward-looking information. Investors should also be aware that while the Company does, from time to time, communicate with securities analysts, it is against the Company’s policy to disclose to them any material non-public information or other confidential commercial information. Accordingly, it should not be assumed that the Company agrees with any statement or report issued by any analyst irrespective of the content of the confirming financial forecasts or projections issued by others. 38 Table of Contents Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data Tupperware Brands Corporation Consolidated Statements of Income (In millions, except per share amounts) Net sales Cost of products sold Gross margin Delivery, sales and administration Re-engineering and impairment charges Gains on disposal of assets Operating income Interest income Other income Interest expense Other expense Income before income taxes Provision for (benefit from) income taxes Net income before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change, net of tax of $0.4 million Net income Basic earnings per common share: Before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change Diluted earnings per common share: Before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change December 30, 2006 $ 1,743.7 615.0 1,128.7 Year Ended December 31, 2005 $ 1,279.3 456.2 823.1 December 25, 2004 $ 1,224.3 425.4 798.9 981.5 7.6 12.5 152.1 8.1 — 55.1 1.3 103.8 9.6 94.2 — 94.2 1.57 — 1.57 1.54 — 1.54 $ $ $ $ $ $ 699.0 16.7 4.0 111.4 3.8 0.5 48.9 1.1 65.7 (20.5 ) 86.2 0.8 85.4 1.45 (0.01 ) 1.44 1.42 (0.01 ) 1.41 $ $ $ $ $ $ 688.8 7.0 13.1 116.2 1.9 1.0 14.9 2.2 102.0 15.1 86.9 — 86.9 1.49 — 1.49 1.48 — 1.48 $ $ $ $ $ $ The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements. 39 Table of Contents Tupperware Brands Corporation Consolidated Balance Sheets (In millions) ASSETS Cash and cash equivalents Accounts receivable, less allowances of $22.8 million in 2006 and $17.2 million in 2005 Inventories Deferred income tax benefits, net Non-trade amounts receivable, net Prepaid expenses Total current assets Deferred income tax benefits, net Property, plant and equipment, net Long-term receivables, net of allowances of $17.6 million in 2006 and $17.9 million in 2005 Other intangible assets, net Goodwill Other assets, net Total assets LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY Accounts payable Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt Accrued liabilities Total current liabilities Long-term debt Other liabilities Shareholders’ equity: Preferred stock, $0.01 par value, 200,000,000 shares authorized; none issued Common stock, $0.01 par value, 600,000,000 shares authorized; 62,367,289 shares issued Paid-in capital Subscriptions receivable Retained earnings Treasury stock 1,805,803 and 1,935,746 shares in 2006 and 2005, respectively, at cost Accumulated other comprehensive loss Total shareholders’ equity Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity December 30, December 31, 2006 2005 $ 102.2 144.8 232.7 57.9 23.0 26.0 586.6 243.9 256.6 41.2 239.7 312.6 31.5 $ 1,712.1 $ 127.1 0.9 253.6 381.6 680.5 249.5 — 0.6 26.2 (3.3 ) 613.9 (46.1 ) (190.8 ) 400.5 $ 1,712.1 $ 181.5 125.8 235.1 66.8 32.9 24.5 666.6 168.4 254.5 37.3 261.3 309.9 36.1 $ 1,734.1 $ 105.7 1.1 341.8 448.6 750.5 199.5 — 0.6 22.0 (12.7 ) 577.4 (51.7 ) (200.1 ) 335.5 $ 1,734.1 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements. 40 Table of Contents Tupperware Brands Corporation Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity and Comprehensive Income (In millions) December 27, 2003 Net income Other comprehensive income: Foreign currency translation adjustments benefit of $1.0 million Minimum pension liability, net of tax Net settlement of deferred losses on Net equity hedge loss, net of tax benefit of $8.5 million cash flow hedges Comprehensive income Cash dividends declared ($0.88 per share) receivable Net settlements of subscriptions Restricted stock grants, net Stock and options issued for incentive plans and related tax benefits Minimum pension liability, net of tax December 25, 2004 Net income Other comprehensive income: Foreign currency translation adjustments benefit of $1.8 million Net equity hedge gain, net of tax provision of $9.5 million Net settlement of deferred losses on cash flow hedges Comprehensive income Cash dividends declared ($0.88 per Settlements of subscriptions receivable Restricted stock grants, net Stock and options issued for incentive plans, net of related tax benefits of $2.0 million share) December 31, 2005 Net income Other comprehensive income: Foreign currency translation adjustments $12.0 million cash flow hedges Comprehensive income Cash dividends declared ($0.88 per Net equity hedge loss, net of tax of Net settlement of deferred losses on share) $6.1 million Pension liability, net of tax benefit of Settlements of subscriptions receivable Restricted stock grants, net Stock and options issued for incentive plans December 30, 2006 Common Stock Treasury Stock Shares Dollars Shares Dollars Paid- In Capital Subscriptions Receivable Retained Earnings Unearned Portion of Restricted Stock for Future Service 62.4 $ 0.6 3.9 $ (105.5 ) $ 23.1 $ (20.6 ) $ 529.0 $ (1.6 ) $ Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss Total Share holders’ Equity (196.8 ) $ 228.2 Comprehensive Income 86.9 86.9 $ 86.9 35.7 35.7 (1.8 ) (15.1 ) (1.8 ) (15.1 ) 0.2 0.2 35.7 (1.8 ) (15.1 ) 0.2 $ 105.9 62.4 $ 0.6 (0.4 ) 8.7 3.5 $ (96.8 ) $ 25.6 $ 2.5 1.9 (51.6 ) (3.4 ) (1.3 ) (18.7 ) $ 560.9 $ (2.9 ) $ (51.6 ) 1.9 (1.3 ) 7.8 (177.8 ) $ 290.9 85.4 85.4 85.4 (33.9 ) (33.9 ) (33.9 ) (5.0 ) 16.9 (0.3 ) 63.1 (5.0 ) (5.0 ) 16.9 16.9 (0.3 ) (0.3 ) $ (52.7 ) 6.0 (3.5 ) (52.7 ) 6.0 (3.5 ) 62.4 $ 0.6 45.1 (1.6 ) 1.9 ($ 51.7 ) $ 28.4 ($ 2.8 (16.2 ) 12.7 ) $ 577.4 ($ 6.4 ) ($ 31.7 200.1 ) $ 335.5 94.2 94.2 94.2 9.4 (53.4 ) (4.3 ) — (0.1 ) 5.6 1.8 ($ 46.1 ) $ 32.6 ($ 4.2 0.6 62.4 $ 6.4 ) ($ The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements. 3.3 ) $ 613.9 ($ 41 42.5 (21.3 ) 0.6 116.0 42.5 42.5 (21.3 ) (21.3 ) 0.6 0.6 $ (53.4 ) (12.5 ) (12.5 ) 9.4 — 5.5 190.8 ) $ 400.5 Table of Contents Tupperware Brands Corporation Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (In millions) Operating activities: Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Depreciation and amortization Amortization of deferred gains, equity compensation and other Amortization of debt issuance costs Net gains on disposal of assets Provision for bad debts Net impact of write-down of inventories and change in LIFO reserve Non-cash impact of re-engineering, impairment costs and loss on disposal Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle Net change in deferred income taxes Termination of interest rate hedge Changes in assets and liabilities: Accounts and notes receivable Inventories Non-trade amounts receivable Prepaid expenses Other assets Accounts payable and accrued liabilities Income taxes payable Other liabilities Net cash impact from hedging activity Other Net cash provided by operating activities Investing activities: Capital expenditures Purchase of direct selling businesses of Sara Lee Corporation, net of cash acquired Proceeds from disposal of property, plant and equipment Payment to terminate interest rate hedge Net cash used in investing activities Financing activities: Dividend payments to shareholders Proceeds from exercise of stock options Proceeds from payments of subscriptions receivable Proceeds from issuance of term debt Repayment of long-term debt Net change in short-term debt Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents Net change in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year Cash and cash equivalents at end of year Supplemental disclosure: Loans settled with common stock (Note 9) December 30, Year Ended December 31, December 25, 2006 2005 2004 $ 94.2 $ 85.4 $ 86.9 72.9 6.6 3.2 (10.7 ) 8.3 6.4 0.4 — (10.1 ) — (21.3 ) 5.4 10.1 (1.3 ) (0.2 ) 18.8 (4.0 ) 3.2 (9.1 ) — 172.8 (52.1 ) (104.9 ) 25.5 — (131.5 ) (53.3 ) 7.4 0.5 — (75.8 ) (1.3 ) (122.5 ) 1.9 (79.3 ) 181.5 102.2 9.2 $ $ 50.8 (1.2 ) 0.2 (0.6 ) 5.4 (3.7 ) 4.1 0.8 (4.3 ) 3.1 9.6 (6.2 ) (6.3 ) 0.5 17.4 (23.9 ) 7.3 (2.1 ) 3.7 0.2 140.2 (52.0 ) (464.3 ) 8.0 (3.1 ) (511.4 ) (52.4 ) 30.2 0.6 762.5 (280.5 ) (0.9 ) 459.8 2.3 90.6 90.9 181.5 5.6 $ $ 50.8 0.5 (12.8 ) 5.5 9.9 2.8 — (21.8 ) — 3.8 (3.1 ) 3.3 5.8 1.3 13.9 (11.3 ) (2.6 ) (11.0 ) (0.5 ) 121.4 (43.6 ) — 16.6 — (27.0 ) (51.5 ) 4.1 1.5 — — (4.2 ) (50.1 ) 1.6 45.9 45.0 90.9 0.7 $ $ The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements. 42 Table of Contents Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies Principles of Consolidation. The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Tupperware Brands Corporation and all of its subsidiaries (Tupperware Brands, the Company). All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated. The Company acquired the direct selling businesses of Sara Lee Corporation on December 5, 2005 (the “Acquisition” or the “Acquired Units”), and the results of operations of the Acquired Units are included as of that date. The Company’s fiscal year ends on the last Saturday of December. As a result, the 2006 and 2004 fiscal years contain 52 weeks as compared with 53 weeks for fiscal year 2005. Use of Estimates. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions. These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the financial statements, as well as the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from these estimates. In May 2005, the FASB issued SFAS 154, Accounting Changes and Error Corrections . This statement replaces APB No. 20, Accounting Changes and SFAS 3, Accounting Changes in Interim Financial Statements, and changed the requirements for the accounting for and reporting of a change in accounting principle. The statement required retrospective application to prior periods’ financial statements of changes in accounting principle, unless it was impracticable to determine either the period-specific effects or the cumulative effect of the change. This statement was effective for all accounting changes and corrections of errors in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2005. The Company has adopted all components of this standard without material impact. Cash and Cash Equivalents. The Company considers all highly liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less when purchased to be cash equivalents. As of December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, $33.4 million and $79.0 million, respectively, of the cash and cash equivalents included on the consolidated balance sheets were held in the form of time deposits, certificates of deposit, high grade commercial paper, or similar instruments. Included in the cash balance of $102.2 million reported at the end of 2006, the Company had a cash balance of $10.3 million denominated in Venezuelan bolivars. The balance was primarily a result of favorable operating cash flows in the market. Due to Venezuelan government restrictions on transfers of cash out of the country and control of exchange rates, the Company can not immediately repatriate this cash at the exchange rate used to translate the Venezuelan bolivars into U.S. dollars for inclusion on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. It has applied for, and expects to receive, authorization in 2007 to transfer approximately half of the balance out of the country. It has also implemented other strategies in an effort to eventually repatriate the entire amount. The Company believes it could immediately repatriate the cash from Venezuela, but only at a significantly less favorable exchange rate. This would result in the Company having fewer U.S. dollars than currently reported as a component of cash and cash equivalents on its consolidated balance sheet with the difference recorded as a foreign exchange loss in its consolidated income statement. Allowance for Doubtful Accounts. The Company maintains current and long-term receivable amounts with most of its independent distributors and sales force in certain markets. The Company regularly monitors and assesses its risk of not collecting amounts owed to it by customers. This evaluation is based upon an analysis of amounts currently and past due along with relevant history and facts particular to the customer. It is also based upon estimates of distributor business prospects, particularly related to the evaluation of the recoverability of long- term amounts due. This evaluation is performed market by market and account by account based upon historical experience, market penetration levels, access to alternative channels and similar factors. It also considers collateral of the customer that could be recovered to satisfy debts. The Company records its allowance 43 Table of Contents for uncollectible accounts based on the results of this analysis. The analysis requires the Company to make significant estimates and as such, changes in facts and circumstances could result in material changes in the allowance for doubtful accounts. Inventories . Inventories are valued at the lower of cost or market. Inventory cost includes cost of raw material, labor and overhead. Domestically produced Tupperware inventories, approximately three percent of consolidated inventories at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, are valued on the last-in, first-out (LIFO) cost method. The first-in, first-out (FIFO) cost method is used for the remaining inventories. If inventories valued on the LIFO method had been valued using the FIFO method, they would have been $3.6 million and $4.9 million higher at the end of 2006 and 2005, respectively. The Company writes down its inventory for obsolescence or unmarketable items equal to the difference between the cost of the inventory and estimated market value based upon expected future demand. The demand is estimated based upon the historical success of product lines as well as the projected success of promotional programs, new product introductions and new markets or distribution channels. The Company prepares projections of demand on an item by item basis for all of its products. If inventory on hand exceeds projected demand, the excess inventory is written down to its net realizable value. However, if actual demand is less than projected by management, additional write-downs may be required. In November 2004, the FASB issued SFAS 151 , Inventory Costs—an amendment of ARB no. 43, Chapter 4 . This statement amended the guidance in ARB No. 43, Chapter 4, Inventory Pricing , to clarify the accounting for abnormal amounts of idle facility expense, freight, handling costs and wasted material (spoilage). It was effective for fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2004 and did not have a material impact on the Company. Internal Use Software Development Costs. The Company capitalizes internal use software development costs as they are incurred and amortizes such costs over their estimated useful lives of three to five years beginning when the software is placed in service. In December 2005, the Company capitalized $1.3 million of software development costs as part of the assets recorded resulting from the Acquisition. This amount represented the fair market value of internal use software development costs at the acquisition date as determined by an internal analysis performed by the Company. The Company recorded these and all other previously capitalized internal use software development costs in property, plant and equipment. Net unamortized costs included in property, plant and equipment were $17.7 million and $16.1 million at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, respectively. Amortization cost related to internal use software development costs totaled $4.1 million, $5.0 million and $4.7 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Property, Plant and Equipment. Property, plant and equipment are initially stated at cost. The Company recorded property, plant and equipment arising from the Acquisition at its fair market value as determined by the review of an independent third party with expertise in such valuation judgments. Depreciation is determined on a straight-line basis over the following estimated useful lives of the assets: Building and improvements Molds Production equipment Distribution equipment Computer/telecom equipment Capitalized software 10 – 40 years 4 years 10 – 20 years 3 – 5 years 3 – 5 years 3 – 5 years Depreciation expense was $43.7 million, $44.1 million and $46.1 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The Company considers the need for an impairment review when events occur that indicate that the book value of a long-lived asset may exceed its recoverable value. Impairments are discussed further in Note 3 to 44 Table of Contents the consolidated financial statements. Upon the sale or retirement of property, plant and equipment, a gain or loss is recognized equal to the difference between sales price and net book value. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are charged to DS&A expense. In December 2004, the FASB issued SFAS 153, Exchanges of Non-monetary Assets—an amendment of APB Opinion No. 29 . The amendments eliminate the exception to fair value accounting for non-monetary exchanges of similar productive assets and replace it with a broader exception for exchanges of non-monetary assets that do not have commercial substance. Under APB 29, accounting for an exchange of a productive asset for a similar productive asset or an equivalent interest in the same or similar productive asset is to be based upon the recorded amount of the asset relinquished (carryover basis with no gain or loss recognition). The transaction will now be accounted for based upon the fair value of the assets exchanged. The Statement was effective for exchanges occurring in fiscal years beginning after June 15, 2005 and is to be applied prospectively. This Statement has not had a material impact on the Company. Goodwill. Goodwill represents the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets acquired. The Company’s recorded goodwill was predominantly generated by the Acquisition in December 2005 and the acquisition of BeautiControl in October 2000. The Company uses discounted future cash flow estimates to determine the fair market value of the Acquired Units’ and BeautiControl operations worldwide for purposes of conducting impairment reviews. The annual impairment reviews for the Acquisition and BeautiControl goodwill were completed in the third and second quarters, respectively, and no impairment charges were necessary. The goodwill recorded on the Company’s balance sheet at December 30, 2006 which is primarily included in the International Beauty and BeautiControl North America segments, was $273.6 million and $39.0 million, respectively, with smaller amounts included in the Europe, Asia Pacific and North America segments. Other Intangible Assets . Other intangible assets are recorded at their fair market values at the date of acquisition in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 141, Business Combinations and definite lived intangibles are amortized over their estimated useful lives in accordance with SFAS 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. The other intangible assets included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005 are primarily related to the Acquisition and are recorded at their respective fair market values. The value of other intangible assets and weighted average estimated useful lives excluding the impact of foreign currency translation are as follows: (in millions) Trademarks and Trade names Sales force relationships—single level Sales force relationships—multi tier Acquired proprietary product formulations Total other intangible assets Gross Carrying Value $ $ 197.4 33.0 29.0 3.6 263.0 December 30, 2006 Accumulated Amortization — $ 16.8 7.2 1.4 25.4 $ Weighted Average Useful Life Indefinite 6 – 8 years 10 – 12 years 3 years Amortization expense was $23.7 million and $1.7 million in 2006 and 2005, respectively. The Company had no amortizable intangibles during 2004. The estimated aggregate annual amortization expense associated with the above intangibles for each of the five succeeding years is $12.7 million, $8.7 million, $5.4 million, $3.8 million and $2.7 million, respectively. Promotional and Other Accruals. The Company frequently makes promotional offers to members of its independent sales force to encourage them to fulfill specific goals or targets for sales levels, party attendance, recruiting of new sales force members or other business- critical functions. The awards offered are in the form of cash, product awards, special prizes or trips. A program is generally designed to recognize sales force members for achieving a primary objective. An example is to reward the independent sales force for recruiting new sales force members. In this situation, the 45 Table of Contents Company offers a prize to sales force members that achieve a targeted number of recruits over a specified period. The period runs from a couple of weeks to several months. The prizes are generally graded in that meeting one level may result in receiving a piece of jewelry with higher achievement resulting in more valuable prizes such as televisions and trips. Similar programs are designed to reward current sales force members who reach certain goals by promoting them to a higher level in the organization where their earning opportunity would be expanded and they would take on additional responsibilities for recruiting new sales force members and providing training and motivation to new and existing sales force members. Other business drivers such as the scheduling of new direct selling demonstrations, increasing the number of sales force members holding parties or increasing end consumer attendance at parties may also be the focus of a program. The Company also offers cash awards for achieving targeted sales levels. These types of awards are generally based upon the sales achievement of at least a mid-level member of the sales force and his or her down-line members. The down-line consists of those sales force members that have been recruited directly by a given sales force member, as well as those recruited by his or her recruits. In this manner, sales force members can build an extensive organization over time if they are committed to recruiting and developing their units. In addition to the bonus, the positive performance of a unit may also entitle its leader to the use of a company-provided vehicle and in some cases, the permanent awarding of a vehicle. Similar to the prize program noted earlier, these programs generally offer varying levels of vehicles that are dependent upon performance. The Company accrues for the costs of these awards during the period over which the sales force qualifies for the award and reports these costs primarily as delivery, sales and administrative expense. These accruals require estimates as to the cost of the awards based upon estimates of achievement and actual cost to be incurred. During the qualification period, actual results are monitored and changes to the original estimates that are necessary are made when known. Total promotional expenses included in delivery, sales and administrative expense were $251.6 million, $215.2 and $196.6 million for 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Like promotional accruals, other accruals are recorded at the time when the liability is probable and the amount is reasonably estimable. Adjustments to amounts previously accrued are made when changes in the facts and circumstances that generated the accrual occur. Revenue Recognition. Revenue is recognized when goods are shipped to customers and the risks and rewards of ownership have passed to the customer who, in most cases, is one of the Company’s independent directors or distributors or a member of its independent sales force. When revenue is recorded, estimates of returns are made and recorded as a reduction of revenue. Discounts earned based on promotional programs in place, volume of purchases or other factors are also estimated at the time of revenue recognition and recorded as a reduction of that revenue. Shipping and Handling Costs. The cost of products sold line item includes costs related to the purchase and manufacture of goods sold by the Company. Among these costs are inbound freight charges, purchasing and receiving costs, inspection costs, internal transfer costs, and warehousing costs of raw material, work in process and packing materials. The warehousing and distribution costs of finished goods are included in the delivery, sales and administrative expense line item. Distribution costs are comprised of outbound freight and associated labor costs. Fees billed to customers associated with the distribution of its products are classified as revenue. The shipping and handling costs included in delivery, sales and administrative expense in 2006, 2005 and 2004 were $85.6 million, $65.8 million and $60.8 million, respectively. Advertising and Research and Development Costs. Advertising and research and development costs are charged to expense as incurred. Advertising expense totaled $14.7 million, $8.9 million and $7.5 million 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Research and development costs totaled $15.6 million, $13.9 million and $13.0 million, in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Research and development expenses primarily include salaries, contractor costs and facility costs. Both advertising and research and development costs are included in delivery, selling and administrative expenses. 46 Table of Contents Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation . The Company has several stock-based employee and director compensation plans, which are described more fully in Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements. Through 2002, the Company accounted for those plans under the intrinsic value recognition and measurement principles of Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees , and related Interpretations. Effective with fiscal 2003, the Company began accounting for those plans using the fair-value-based method of accounting for stock options under the provisions of SFAS 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation , prospectively to all employee awards granted, modified, or settled after December 28, 2002 as permitted under the transition guidance of SFAS 148, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation—Transition and Disclosure—an amendment of FAS 123 . Awards under the Company’s plans vest over periods up to seven years. Compensation cost for options that vest on a graduated schedule is recorded over that time period. Therefore, the cost related to the stock-based employee compensation included in the determination of net income for 2005 and 2004 is less than that which would have been recognized if the fair-value-based method had been applied to all awards since the original effective date of SFAS 123. Compensation expense associated with restricted stock grants is equal to the market value of the shares on the date of grant and is recorded pro rata over the required holding period. For those restricted stock grants with performance criteria, the expense is recorded based on an assessment of achieving the criteria. Compensation expense associated with restricted stock grants was $2.5 million, $1.4 million and $0.6 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The following table illustrates the effect on net income and earnings per share if the fair value recognition provisions of SFAS No. 123(R) had been applied to stock-based compensation since its effective date. (In millions except per share amounts) Net Income, as reported Add: Stock-based employee compensation expense included in reported net income, net of related tax effects Deduct: Total stock-based compensation expense determined under fair-value-based method for all awards, net of related tax effects Pro forma net income Earnings per share: Basic—as reported Basic—pro forma Diluted—as reported Diluted—pro forma 2005 $ 85.4 2004 $ 86.9 2.5 1.5 (3.6 ) $ 84.3 $ 1.44 $ 1.42 $ 1.41 $ 1.39 (4.4 ) $ 84.0 $ 1.49 $ 1.44 $ 1.48 $ 1.43 The fair value of the stock option grants was estimated using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following assumptions: dividend yield of 4.3 percent for 2006, 4.2 percent for 2005 and 5.1 percent for 2004 grants; expected volatility of 27 percent for 2006, 29 percent for 2005 and 40 percent for 2004; risk-free interest rates of 4.6 percent for 2006, 4.4 percent for 2005 and 3.9 percent for 2004; and expected lives of 6 years for 2006 and 2005 and 8 years for 2004. On March 29, 2005, the Staff of the SEC issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 107 (SAB 107), Share-Based Payment . SAB 107 was issued to provide guidance on SFAS 123(R) and its interaction with certain SEC rules and regulations and to provide the SEC staff views regarding valuation of share-based payment arrangements. On April 14, 2005, the SEC adopted a new rule through release number 33-8568, Amendment to Rule 4-01(a) of Regulation S-X regarding the Compliance Date for Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (Revised 2004), Share-based Payment , to amend the effective date of SFAS 123(R) for registrants to fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2005. As such, effective January 1, 2006, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R), Share-Based Payment, and related interpretations, or SFAS 123(R), to account for stock-based compensation using the modified prospective transition method and therefore did not restate prior period results. SFAS 123(R) supersedes Accounting Principles Board Opinion 47 Table of Contents No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees, and revises guidance in SFAS 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation. Among other things, SFAS 123(R) requires that compensation expense be recognized in the financial statements for share-based awards based on the grant date fair value of those awards. The modified prospective transition method applies to (a) unvested stock options outstanding as of December 31, 2005 and granted prior to December 29, 2002, when the Company began recognizing in income the fair value of all newly issued or modified stock-based compensation awards under SFAS 123, and (b) any new share-based awards granted subsequent to December 31, 2005. Stock-based compensation expense in 2006 also includes the cumulative effect of estimating forfeitures as part of the fair value measurement that the Company previously accounted for based on actual activity. This change had no material impact on results of operations. In 2005, the SEC Staff offered its views on how companies should address non-substantive vesting conditions, such as retirement eligibility provisions, of share-based payment awards under SFAS 123 , Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation , and APB 25 , Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees . Under SFAS 123 and APB 25, it specifies that awards are vested when the employee’s retention of the award is no longer contingent on providing subsequent service. The SEC clarified this provision to specify that this would be the case for awards issued to employees who are or become retirement eligible during the vesting period when the award provides for accelerated vesting upon retirement. However, the prevalent accounting for this situation had been to recognize the compensation cost over the nominal vesting period (the vesting terms of the award). Companies that had been using this method, including the Company, were advised to continue doing so until adopting the provisions under SFAS 123(R). Upon adoption of 123(R), any new grants going forward are to be recognized as compensation immediately if issued to individuals who are already retirement eligible, or vest over the period of time the individuals will become retirement eligible if it is prior to the nominal vesting period of the grant. The impact to the Company of using this vesting approach for its 2006 grants was to accelerate recognition of $1.5 million of compensation expense. This is reflected in the amounts above. The table below summarizes the impact on results of operations for the year ended December 30, 2006, of expensing, under the provisions of SFAS 123(R), unvested options granted prior to December 29, 2002: (in millions, except per share data) Stock-based compensation expense Income tax benefit Net decrease in net income Decrease in income per common share: Basic Diluted Year Ended December 30, 2006 0.8 $ (0.3 ) 0.5 $ $ $ 0.01 0.01 SFAS 123 (R) requires the benefits associated with tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation cost, generated upon the exercise of stock options, to be reported as a financing cash flow rather than as an operating cash flow as previously required. For the year ended December 30, 2006 the Company did not generate any excess cash tax benefits from option exercises, while for the year ended December 31, 2005, it generated $0.3 million of such benefits. Additionally, prior to the Company’s adoption of SFAS 123(R), unearned compensation was presented as a separate component of shareholders’ equity. In accordance with the provisions of SFAS 123(R), on January 1, 2006, unearned compensation was reclassified as additional paid-in-capital on the balance sheet for all periods presented. On August 31, 2005, the FASB issued FSP 123(R)-1, Classification and Measurement of Freestanding Financial Instruments Originally Issued in Exchange for Employee Services under FASB Statement No. 123(R) . The guidance defers the requirements of SFAS 123(R) that a freestanding financial instrument originally subject 48 Table of Contents to Statement 123(R) becomes subject to the recognition and measurement requirements of other applicable accounting standards when the rights conveyed by the instrument to the holder are no longer dependent upon the holder being an employee of the Company. A freestanding financial instrument originally issued as employee compensation would be subject to the recognition and measurement provisions of SFAS 123 (R) throughout the life of the instrument, unless its terms are modified after the time the rights conveyed by the instrument are no longer dependent on the holder being an employee. This FSP supersedes guidance in FSP EITF 00-19-1, Application of EITF Issue No. 00-19 to Freestanding Financial Instruments Originally Issued as Employee Compensation which was issued on May 31, 2005. The FSP was effective in conjunction with SFAS 123(R) which was the first quarter of 2006. There was no impact to the Company upon implementation of the guidance in FSP 123(R)-1. On October 18, 2005, the FASB issued FSP SFAS 123(R)-2, Practical Accommodation to the Application of Grant Date as Defined in FASB Statement No. 123(R) . Under SFAS 123(R), there is a requirement that a mutual understanding of the key terms and conditions of a share-based payment award has been communicated before a grant can be deemed to have been made. This FSP clarifies that a mutual understanding of the key terms and conditions of the award can be presumed on the date the award is approved if (1) the award is a unilateral grant and the recipient does not have the ability to negotiate key terms and conditions of the award and (2) if the key terms and conditions are communicated to the individual recipients within a relatively short time period from the date of approval. The Company had no impact from the adoption of this standard. Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations. In March 2005, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 47 Accounting for Conditional Asset Retirement Obligations (FIN 47) , which was issued to clarify the term “conditional asset retirement obligation” as used in SFAS, 143 Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations, issued in June 2001. SFAS 143 refers to a company’s legal obligation to perform an asset retirement activity in which the timing and (or) method of settlement are conditional on a future event that may or may not be within the control of the entity. The obligation to perform the asset retirement activity is unconditional even though uncertainty exists about the timing and (or) method of settlement. Thus, the timing and (or) method of settlement may be conditional on a future event. Accordingly, a company is required to recognize a liability for the fair value of a conditional asset retirement obligation if the fair value of the liability can be reasonably estimated. The fair value of a liability for the conditional asset retirement obligation should be recognized when incurred-generally upon acquisition, construction, or development and (or) through the normal operation of the asset. Uncertainty about the timing and (or) method of settlement of a conditional asset retirement obligation should be factored into the measurement of the liability when sufficient information exists. In the fourth quarter of 2005, the Company recognized a liability for the fair market value of conditional future obligations associated with environmental issues at its manufacturing facilities in Belgium and the United States that the Company will be required to remedy in Belgium in 2007 or 2008 and at some future date in the United States, when these assets are retired. In the fourth quarter of 2005, the Company recognized $0.8 million of expense, net of $0.4 million of tax benefit, representing the cumulative effect of these conditional future obligations. The Company performs an annual evaluation of its obligations regarding this matter and is required to record depreciation and costs associated with accretion of the obligation. This was not material for 2006 and is not expected to be material in the future. Income Taxes. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets also are recognized for credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted rates applicable to taxable income in the years in which the temporary differences are expected to reverse and the credits are expected to be used. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. An assessment is made as to whether or not a valuation allowance is required to offset deferred tax assets. This assessment requires estimates as to future operating results as well as an evaluation of the effectiveness of the Company’s tax planning strategies. These estimates are made on an ongoing basis based upon the Company’s business plans and growth strategies in each market and consequently, future material changes in the valuation allowance are possible. 49 Table of Contents In July 2006, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (FIN 48). FIN 48 clarifies the accounting for income taxes by prescribing a minimum probability threshold that a tax position must meet before a financial statement benefit is recognized. The minimum threshold is defined in FIN 48 as a tax position that is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by the applicable taxing authority, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefit to be recognized is measured as the largest amount of benefit that is greater than 50 percent likely of being realized upon ultimate settlement. FIN 48 must be applied to all existing tax positions upon initial adoption. The cumulative effect of applying FIN 48 at adoption, if any, is to be reported as an adjustment to opening retained earnings for the year of adoption. FIN 48 is effective for the Company’s 2007 fiscal year. The Company is currently assessing the potential effect of FIN 48 on its financial statements. Interest and penalties related to tax contingency or settlement items are recorded as a component of the provision for income taxes on the Company’s statement of income. The Company records accruals for tax contingencies as a component of accrued liabilities or other long-term liabilities on its balance sheet. Net Income Per Common Share. Basic per share information is calculated by dividing net income by the weighted average number of shares outstanding. Diluted per share information is calculated by also considering the impact of potential common stock on both net income and the weighted average number of shares outstanding. The Company’s potential common stock consists of employee and director stock options and restricted stock. Restricted stock is excluded from the basic per share calculation and is included in the diluted per share calculation when doing so would not be anti-dilutive. The common stock elements of the earnings per share computations are as follows (in millions): Net income Weighted-average shares of common stock outstanding Common equivalent shares: Assumed exercise of outstanding dilutive options Weighted-average common and common equivalent shares outstanding Basic earnings per share Diluted earnings per share Potential common stock excluded from diluted earnings per share because inclusion would have been anti-dilutive 2006 $ 94.2 60.1 1.1 61.2 $ 1.57 $ 1.54 2005 $ 85.4 59.4 1.2 60.6 $ 1.44 $ 1.41 2004 $ 86.9 58.4 0.4 58.8 $ 1.49 $ 1.48 2.5 1.5 5.9 Derivative Financial Instruments . The Company recognizes all derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets and measures those instruments at fair value. If certain conditions are met, a derivative may be specifically designated as a hedge. The accounting for changes in the value of a derivative accounted for as a hedge depends on the intended use of the derivative and the resulting designation of the hedge exposure. Depending on how the hedge is used and the designation, the gain or loss due to changes in value is reported either in earnings or in other comprehensive income. Gains or losses that are reported in other comprehensive income eventually are recognized in earnings; with the timing of this recognition governed by SFAS 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities , as amended by SFAS 149, Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities (SFAS 149), and SFAS 138, Accounting for Certain Derivative Instruments and Certain Hedging Activities . In February 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 159, The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (SFAS No. 159). SFAS No. 159 permits companies to choose to measure certain financial instruments and certain other items at fair value. The standard requires that unrealized gains and losses on items for which the fair value option has been elected be reported in earnings. SFAS No. 159 is effective for the company beginning in the first quarter of fiscal year 2008, although earlier adoption is permitted. The company is currently evaluating the impact that SFAS No. 159 will have on its consolidated financial statements. 50 Table of Contents The Company uses derivative financial instruments, principally over-the-counter forward exchange contracts and local currency options with major international financial institutions, to offset the effects of exchange rate changes on net investments in certain foreign subsidiaries, forecasted purchase commitments, certain intercompany loan transactions and the value of international cash flows. Gains and losses on instruments designated as hedges of net investments in a foreign subsidiary or intercompany transactions that are permanent in nature are accrued as exchange rates change, and are recognized in shareholders’ equity, as foreign currency translation adjustments. Forward points and option costs associated with these net investment hedges are included in interest expense and other expense, respectively. Gains and losses on contracts designated as hedges of intercompany transactions that are not permanent in nature are accrued as exchange rates change and are recognized in income. Gains and losses on contracts designated as hedges of identifiable foreign currency firm commitments are deferred and included in the measurement of the related foreign currency transaction. Contracts hedging non-permanent intercompany transactions and identifiable foreign currency firm commitments are held to maturity. In 2005 the Company utilized interest rate swap agreements to convert a portion of its fixed-rate U.S. dollar long-term debt to floating rate U.S. dollar debt. Changes in the fair value of the swaps resulting from changes in market interest rates were recorded as a component of net income which offset the changes in the related long-term debt. Finally, the Company has entered into a series of euro put options that it considers to be a hedge of a portion of its expected current year euro- denominated cash flow from operating activities. However, these options are not considered to be a hedge under U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, and therefore when they are marked to market at the end of each accounting period, gain or losses will be included as a component of other income or expense, as applicable. See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements. Foreign Currency Translation. Results of operations of foreign subsidiaries are translated into U.S. dollars using the average exchange rates during the year. The assets and liabilities of those subsidiaries, other than those of operations in highly inflationary countries, are translated into U.S. dollars using exchange rates at the balance sheet date. The related translation adjustments are included in accumulated other comprehensive loss. Foreign currency transaction gains and losses, as well as re-measurement of financial statements of subsidiaries in highly inflationary countries, are included in income. Product Warranty. Tupperware ® brand products are guaranteed against chipping, cracking, breaking or peeling under normal non- commercial use of the product. The cost of replacing defective products is not material. Reclassifications. Certain prior year amounts have been reclassified in the consolidated financial statements to conform to current year presentation. The statement of cash flows for 2005 includes a reclassification between net cash provided by operating activities and net cash from financing activities. In the fourth quarter of 2005 the Company made make-whole payments of $22 million related to the early repayment of its 7.91 percent Notes due 2011 and six million dollars for the discharge of obligations related to $100 million of notes due in 2006 (see Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements). These payments were included in the statement of cash flows as a $27.4 million increase to net income in arriving at net cash provided by operating activities and a decrease to net cash from financing activities for the same amount. Within the 2005 statement of income the $27.4 million was recorded as interest expense. This reclassification reduced the Company’s 2005 net cash provided by operating activities by $27.4 million to $140.2 million versus $167.6 million as previously disclosed and increased the Company’s 2005 net cash from financing activities by the same amount to $459.5 million versus $432.1 million as previously disclosed. There was no change to the net increase in cash and cash equivalents. Additionally, none of the Company’s debt covenants were affected by the reclassification. 51 Table of Contents A comparison of the 2005 statement of cash flows before and after the reclassification is shown below. (In millions) Operating activities: Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Depreciation and amortization Amortization of deferred gains, equity compensation and other Amortization of debt issuance costs Net gains on disposal of assets Provision for bad debts Net impact of write-down of inventories and change in LIFO reserve Non-cash impact of re-engineering and impairment costs Cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle Change in net deferred income taxes Termination of interest rate hedge Loss on repayment of debt Changes in assets and liabilities: Accounts and notes receivable Inventory Non-trade amounts receivable Prepaid expenses Other assets Accounts payable and accrued liabilities Income taxes payable Other liabilities Net cash impact from hedging activity Other Net cash provided by operating activities Investing activities: Capital expenditures Purchase of direct selling businesses of Sara Lee Corporation, net Proceeds from disposal of property, plant and equipment Payment to terminate interest rate hedge Net cash used in by investing activities Financing activities: Dividend payments to shareholders Proceeds from exercise of stock options Proceeds from payments of subscriptions receivable Proceeds from issuance of term debt Repayment of debt Net change in short-term debt Net cash from financing activities Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents Net change in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year Cash and cash equivalents at end of year Supplemental disclosure: Loans settled with common stock (Note 9) Year Ended December 31, 2005 As Reclassified Original Difference $ 85.4 $ 85.4 $ — 50.8 (1.2 ) 0.2 (0.6 ) 5.4 (3.7 ) 4.1 0.8 (4.3 ) 3.1 — 9.6 (6.2 ) (6.3 ) 0.5 17.4 (23.9 ) 7.3 (2.1 ) 3.7 0.2 140.2 (52.0 ) (464.3 ) 8.0 (3.1 ) (511.4 ) (52.4 ) 30.2 0.6 762.5 (280.5 ) (0.9 ) 459.5 2.3 90.6 90.9 $ 181.5 50.8 2.0 0.2 (0.6 ) 5.4 (3.7 ) 4.1 0.8 (4.3 ) 3.1 24.2 9.6 (6.2 ) (6.3 ) 0.5 17.4 (23.9 ) 7.3 (2.1 ) 3.7 0.2 167.6 (52.0 ) (464.3 ) 8.0 (3.1 ) (511.4 ) (52.4 ) 30.2 0.6 762.5 (307.9 ) (0.9 ) 432.1 2.3 90.6 90.9 $ 181.5 — (3.2 ) — — — — — — — (24.2 ) — — — — — — — — — — (27.4 ) — — — — — — — — — 27.4 — 27.4 — — — $ — $ 5.6 $ 5.6 $ — 52 Table of Contents Note 2: Business Combination On December 5, 2005, Tupperware Brands acquired 100 percent of the net assets of the direct selling businesses of Sara Lee Corporation and originally included these businesses in the International Beauty segment. See Note 13 for a description of the composition of the International Beauty segment. The Acquired Units sell a wide variety of consumable products, primarily color cosmetics, skin care, fragrances and toiletries in 21 countries in North and South America, Asia Pacific, Southern Africa and Europe under the brand names House of Fuller ® , Nutrimetics ® , NaturCare ® , Avroy Shlain ® , Nuvo Cosmeticos ® and Swissgarde ® through a sales force of 898,000 independent consultants as of December 30, 2006. This acquisition was made to advance the strategy, begun with the acquisition of BeautiControl in 2000, of adding consumable items to the product category mix by expanding into beauty and personal care products. The results of operations for the Acquired Units are included in the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Income beginning on the acquisition date. The acquisition cost was $569.2 million in cash. The acquisition and the retirement of the Company’s then existing $250 million in long term notes, was funded through cash on hand and a new $775 million secured seven-year term loans which carry an interest rate of LIBOR plus 150 basis points. The total cost of the acquisition has been allocated to the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed based on their respective fair values at the date of acquisition, in accordance with SFAS 141, Business Combinations . Goodwill, none of which is deductible for tax purposes, and other intangibles recorded in connection with the acquisition totaled $256.4 and $239.7 on December 30, 2006, respectively, and are reported primarily within the International Beauty segment with $29.9 million and $52.7 million in the Europe and Asia Pacific segments, respectively. The goodwill and intangible assets include a cumulative adjustment for foreign currency translation of $1.6 million and $2.1 million, respectively. The goodwill amounts recognized in the acquisition resulted primarily from the acquisition of the assembled workforce, including a management team with a proven track record of success in direct selling as well as employed field representatives in several significant markets. Of the $263.0 million of acquired intangible assets, $197.4 million was assigned to registered trademarks, which were determined to have indefinite useful lives. Of the remaining balance of intangible assets acquired, $62.0 million was assigned to sales force relationships and $3.6 million was assigned to product formulations which are being amortized over weighted average useful lives of 6 to 12 years and 3 years, respectively. Aggregate amortization expense associated with the above intangible assets recorded in 2006 and 2005 subsequent to the acquisition date was $23.7 million and $1.7 million, respectively, and the estimated annual amortization expense for each of the five succeeding years is $12.7 million, $8.7 million, $5.4 million, $3.8 million and $2.7 million, respectively. The unaudited condensed pro forma consolidated statements of income for 2005 and 2004, assuming the purchase of the Acquired Units as of the beginning of fiscal 2004 are as follows: (In millions except per share amounts) Net sales Operating income Net income from continuing operations Net income from continuing operations per common share Basic Diluted For the Year Ended December 31, December 25, 2005 $ 1,724.4 159.3 94.1 $ $ 1.58 1.55 2004 $ 1,691.1 155.0 90.3 $ $ 1.55 1.54 These pro forma statements have been prepared for comparative purposes only and are not intended to be indicative of what the Company’s results would have been had the acquisition occurred at the beginning of 2004 or the results which may occur in the future. 53 Table of Contents Note 3: Re-engineering Costs The Company continually reviews its business models and operating methods for opportunities to increase efficiencies and/or align costs with business performance. Pretax costs incurred in the re-engineering and impairment charges caption by category were as follows: (In millions) Severance Asset impairment Total re-engineering and impairment charges 2006 $ 7.5 0.1 $ 7.6 2005 $ 10.2 6.5 $ 16.7 2004 $ 2.5 4.5 $ 7.0 In 2006, the Company recorded $7.5 million of severance costs related primarily to actions taken to reduce headcount at the Company’s Canada, Philippines, Australia and European marketing and manufacturing operations. In total, approximately 260 positions were eliminated primarily in the Philippines and Europe. The asset impairment cost of $0.1 million was associated with the write down of assets at the Company’s Philippines facility. The current values are based on the assets’ fair market value as determined by market appraisals performed at the time of recording the impairment. In 2005, the Company recorded $10.2 million of severance costs related primarily to actions taken to reduce headcount at the Company’s South Carolina, Orlando, Belgium, France and Portugal operations. In total, approximately 350 positions were eliminated primarily in the United States. The shift of manufacturing capacity from the Company’s facility in South Carolina which accounts for inventory using the LIFO basis of valuation to other manufacturing facilities which use the FIFO method of valuation resulted in a reduction in the Company’s LIFO reserve of $5.6 million which is included as part of cost of products sold (See Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements). This shift was completed by the end of 2005. The asset impairment costs of $6.5 million were primarily associated with write-downs at the Company’s United States facilities including the write-down of certain warehousing and distribution facilities and equipment at the Company’s South Carolina facility and its former manufacturing facility in Halls, Tennessee. The current values are based on the assets’ fair market value as determined by market appraisals performed during 2006. In 2004 the Company incurred severance costs related to the reduction in headcount of approximately 220 associated with actions to reduce the sales and marketing function in the U.S. business due to a change in the Company’s sales force compensation plan, the rationalization of manufacturing operations in the Philippines and Japan, and downsizing of operations in North America, Brazil, Korea and New Zealand. Asset impairment costs incurred were primarily the result of write-downs of the book value of certain machinery in the United States and Philippines manufacturing operations, the Company’s former manufacturing facility in Halls, Tennessee and the net investment in the Company’s operations in Argentina. Total impairment write-downs are based on the excess of book value over the estimated fair market values of the assets impaired. Fair values were determined based on quoted market prices and discounted cash flows. Pretax costs incurred in connection with the re-engineering program included above and in cost of products sold were as follows: (In millions) Re-engineering and impairment charges Cost of products sold Total pretax re-engineering costs 2006 $ 7.6 — $ 7.6 2005 $ 16.7 (2.4 ) $ 14.3 2004 $ 7.0 — $ 7.0 In 2005, amounts included in cost of products sold included $3.2 million related to asset impairment write downs at the Company’s Hemingway, South Carolina and Halls, Tennessee facilities and the $5.6 million reduction in the LIFO reserve noted above. 54 Table of Contents The balances, included in accrued liabilities, related to re-engineering and impairment charges as of December 30, 2006, December 31, 2005 and December 25, 2004 were as follows: (In millions) Beginning balance Provision Accrual adjustments Cash expenditures: Severance Other Non-cash asset impairments Ending Balance 2006 $ 1.7 7.6 — (8.6 ) (0.1 ) — $ 0.6 2005 $ 1.9 17.2 (0.5 ) (9.3 ) (1.0 ) (6.6 ) $ 1.7 2004 $ 4.4 7.8 (0.8 ) (4.2 ) (0.8 ) (4.5 ) $ 1.9 The accrual at December 30, 2006 related primarily to costs of eliminating positions as a result of re-engineering actions taken in 2006 and is expected to be largely paid out by the end of the first quarter of 2007. The accrual adjustment in 2005 related to the resolution of a litigation claim. The 2004 adjustment was primarily related to lower severance costs than originally estimated. Note 4: Inventories (In millions) Finished goods Work in process Raw materials and supplies Total inventories 2006 $ 156.8 17.5 58.4 $ 232.7 2005 $ 161.4 18.4 55.2 $ 235.1 During 2006, LIFO inventory reserves were reduced approximately $1.6 million due to lower inventory levels. During 2005 the Company engaged in efforts to lower inventory levels in advance of the capacity shift made under its re-engineering initiative discussed in Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. As a result, LIFO inventory was reduced $7.3 million in 2005 including the $5.5 million referred to in Note 3 above, which was a direct result of the capacity shift. Note 5: Property, Plant and Equipment (In millions) Land Buildings and improvements Molds Production equipment Distribution equipment Computer/telecom equipment Furniture and fixtures Capitalized software Construction in progress Total property, plant and equipment Less accumulated depreciation Property, plant and equipment, net 55 2006 $ 31.2 186.2 479.7 237.6 125.7 72.0 27.0 47.2 23.3 1,229.9 (973.3 ) $ 256.6 2005 $ 25.1 181.3 443.8 247.0 96.4 69.0 24.3 42.8 20.2 1,149.9 (895.4 ) $ 254.5 Table of Contents Note 6: Accrued Liabilities (In millions) Income taxes payable Compensation and employee benefits Advertising and promotion Taxes other than income taxes Pensions Post-retirement benefit Dividends payable Other Total accrued liabilities Post-retirement benefit Pensions Income taxes Long-term deferred income tax Other Total other liabilities 2006 $ 22.3 80.2 33.3 28.4 2.3 4.3 13.2 69.6 $ 253.6 $ 42.3 82.4 17.6 77.0 30.2 $ 249.5 2005 $ 108.2 74.6 31.5 22.5 2.9 7.3 13.2 81.6 $ 341.8 $ 35.3 72.0 10.3 57.3 24.6 $ 199.5 Income taxes payable at December 31, 2005 included $79.8 million withheld on behalf of Sara Lee Corporation in connection with its sale of the Acquired Units to the Company. Note 7: Financing Arrangements Debt Debt consisted of the following: (In millions) Term loan facility due 2012 8.33% Mortgage Note due 2009 Belgium facility Other Less current portion Long-term debt (Dollars in millions) Total short-term borrowings at year-end Weighted average interest rate at year-end Average short-term borrowings during the year Weighted average interest rate for the year Maximum short-term borrowings during the year 2006 $ 669.2 4.8 6.6 0.8 681.4 (0.9 ) $ 680.5 2006 $ 0.9 4.7 % $ 72.4 6.7 % $ 96.1 2005 $ 745.0 5.0 — 1.2 751.2 (0.7 ) $ 750.5 2005 $ 0.4 4.7 % $ 22.5 4.3 % $ 39.2 The average borrowings and weighted average interest rates were determined using month-end borrowings and the interest rates applicable to them. The mortgage note is a 10-year note amortized over a 22-year period with monthly payments of principal and interest of $47,988. The note is collateralized by certain real estate having a net book value of $6.2 million at December 30, 2006. A principal payment of $4.4 million is due to be paid June 1, 2009. 56 Table of Contents The Company entered into a credit agreement on December 5, 2005 (“Term Loan Facility”), in conjunction with closing the Acquisition. The Credit Agreement provided for $775 million of term loans and a $200 million revolving credit facility that expires December 5, 2010 and replaced the Company’s then existing revolving credit facility of the same amount. Proceeds from the term loans were used, largely, to fund the Acquisition, retire existing long-term notes and pay various acquisition fees and expenses. The Term Loan Facility is a floating rate debt instrument but the Company is required to maintain at least 40 percent of total outstanding debt at fixed rates. Quarterly principal payments of $1.9 million each began April 2, 2006; however, the agreement permits the Company to omit these payments if certain prepayments have been made during the previous four quarters. The Company made such optional principal prepayments in 2006 totaling $63.0 million, and therefore the first required quarterly payment is now not due until January 2, 2008. The debt agreement also requires that any proceeds generated by the sale of land be used to pay down the term loan, thus in 2006 additional payments of $12.8 million were made. A final principal payment of $630.5 million is due to be paid on December 5, 2012. The debt is secured by substantially all of the Company’s domestic assets plus a 65 percent stock pledge of its significant foreign subsidiaries. At December 30, 2006, the Company had $307.2 million of unused lines of credit, including $186.2 million under the committed, secured $200 million revolving line of credit and $121.0 million available under various uncommitted lines around the world. The Company satisfies most of its short-term financing needs utilizing its committed, secured revolving line of credit. Interest paid on total debt, excluding credits from interest rate swaps and forward contracts, in 2006, 2005, and 2004 was $53.6 million, $48.9 million and $15.0 million, respectively. The interest paid in 2005 includes “make whole” payments of $21.9 million relating to the early prepayment of the 7.91 percent Notes due 2011. It also includes the pre-funding of $6.0 million of interest due under the terms of the 7.25 percent Notes that had been due in 2006. Both the 2011 and 2006 Notes were retired in connection with the Acquisition. During 2006, the Company renegotiated a line of credit with a financial institution in Australia. One of the terms for this credit facility required the Company to grant to the lender a lien on certain real estate located in Australia. This line of credit totals $4.5 million, and is included in the unused uncommitted lines of credit included above. The real estate used to secure this line of credit had a book value of $6.3 million at the end of 2006. The Credit Agreement contains covenants of a similar nature to those under the previous agreement and customary for similarly rated companies. While the covenants are restrictive and could inhibit the Company’s to borrow, to pay dividends, acquire its own stock or make capital investments in its business, this is not currently expected to occur. The primary financial covenants are a fixed charge coverage ratio, a leverage ratio and an adjusted net worth requirement. The covenant restrictions include adjusted covenant earnings and net worth measures that are non-GAAP measures. The non-GAAP measures may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other entities and exclude unusual, non-recurring gains, certain non-cash charges and changes in accumulated other comprehensive income. Discussion of these measures is presented here to provide an understanding of the Company’s ability to borrow and to pay dividends should certain covenants not be met and caution should be used when comparing this information with that of other companies. The Company’s fixed charge ratio is required to be in excess of 1.05 through September 29, 2007 at which point the requirement becomes more difficult to meet as it increases to 1.20 and then increases annually after the end of each fiscal third quarter until it reaches 1.50 after the end of the third quarter of 2010. The leverage ratio must be below 3.50 through the third quarter of 2007. Beginning with the fourth quarter of 2007 the required ratio declines to 3.25 through the third quarter of 2008 and to 2.75 and 2.50 in the fourth quarters of 2009 and 2010, respectively, and remains at 2.50 for the remaining term of the credit agreement. The fixed charge and leverage ratio covenants are based upon trailing four quarter amounts. The Company’s fixed charge and leverage ratios for the year ended December 30, 2006 were 1.42 and 3.021 respectively. 57 Table of Contents The adjusted net worth requirement was $330.3 million as of December 30, 2006. The requirement increases quarterly by 50 percent of the Company’s consolidated net income. There is no adjustment for losses. The Company’s adjusted consolidated net worth at the end of 2006 was $391.1 million. Adjusted net worth (in millions) Minimum adjusted net worth required Base net worth per financial covenant Plus 50% of net income after December 31, 2005 Plus increases from equity issuances, etc. Adjusted net worth required Company’s adjusted net worth Total shareholders’ equity as of December 30, 2006 Less increases resulting from currency adjustments since year-end 2005 Less increases resulting from cash flow hedges Plus reduction resulting from net equity hedges Plus reduction resulting from adoption of SFAS 158 Adjusted net worth Adjusted covenant earnings Net income Add: Depreciation and amortization Gross interest expense Provision for income taxes Pretax non-cash loss on disposal of an asset Other Deduct: Gain on Orlando land sales & insurance settlement Total adjusted covenant earnings Gross interest expense Less amortization of debt costs Equals cash interest Capital expenditures Less amount excluded per agreement Equals adjusted capital expenditures Fixed charge coverage ratio Adjusted covenant earnings Less: Adjusted capital expenditures Cash taxes paid Subtotal Divided by sum of: Scheduled debt payments Dividend payments Cash interest Subtotal Fixed charge coverage ratio Consolidated total debt Divided by adjusted covenant earnings Leverage ratio 58 As of Dec. 30, 2006 $ $ $ $ 268.4 47.1 14.8 330.3 400.4 (42.5 ) (0.6 ) 21.3 12.5 391.1 12 months ended Dec. 30, 2006 94.2 72.9 55.1 9.6 0.6 6.6 13.5 225.5 55.1 3.2 51.9 51.2 7.3 44.8 225.5 44.8 29.5 151.2 1.2 53.3 51.9 106.4 1.42 681.4 225.5 3.021 Table of Contents Fair Value of Financial Instruments Due to their short maturities or their insignificance, the carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents, accounts and notes receivable, accounts payable, accrued liabilities and short-term borrowings approximated their fair values at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005. The approximate fair value of the Company’s term loans was $669.2 million at December 30, 2006 since the entire issue consists of floating rate debt. The fair value of the remaining long-term debt approximated its book value at the end of 2006 and 2005. Derivative Financial Instruments Following is a listing of the Company’s outstanding derivative financial instruments as of December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005: Forward Contracts (in millions) US Dollars Australian dollars South Korean won Singapore dollars South African rand Danish krona Mexican peso New Zealand dollars Hong Kong dollar Malaysian ringgit Indonesian rupiah Canadian dollars Swiss francs Japanese yen Euro Argentine pesos Philippine pesos Russian ruble Croatian kuna Swedish krona Norwegian krona Czech koruna Indian rupee Other currencies (net) 2006 2005 Buy $ 26.2 19.8 10.8 10.4 9.5 5.2 2.9 2.6 1.4 1.4 1.0 1.0 $ 92.2 Sell $ 38.8 23.0 10.8 4.4 4.3 2.7 2.1 1.5 1.4 1.0 0.6 0.9 $ 91.5 Buy $ 153.8 12.3 9.0 7.5 61.8 1.0 — — $ 245.4 Sell 37.7 0.7 7.2 9.1 $ 77.7 39.4 51.4 2.0 8.1 0.8 2.7 1.7 1.9 — 0.4 3.3 $ 244.1 The Company markets its products in almost 100 countries and is exposed to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates on the earnings, cash flows and financial position of its international operations. Although this currency risk is partially mitigated by the natural hedge arising from the Company’s local manufacturing in many markets, a strengthening U.S. dollar generally has a negative impact on the Company. In response to this fact, the Company uses financial instruments to hedge certain of its exposures and to manage the foreign exchange impact to its financial statements. At its inception, a derivative financial instrument used for hedging is designated as a fair value, cash flow or net equity hedge. Fair value hedges are entered into with financial instruments such as forward contracts with the objective of limiting exposure to certain foreign exchange risks primarily associated with accounts receivable, accounts payable and non-permanent intercompany transactions. In assessing hedge effectiveness, the Company excludes 59 Table of Contents forward points, which are considered by the Company to be components of interest expense. In December 2005 and January 2006, the Company effectively converted $375.0 million of its floating rate borrowings to fixed rate debt through interest rate swaps. The agreements call for the Company to receive a floating rate equal to the 3 month U.S. dollar LIBOR rate and pay a weighted average fixed rate of 4.81 percent. The swap agreements expire in 2009 through 2012. These agreements have been designated as cash flow hedges with interest payments designed to match the interest payments due on the term loans due 2012. The impacts of these agreements are recorded in interest expense. On July 1, 2003, the Company entered into two swap agreements effective September 29, 2003 as a hedge of the fair value of its $150 million 7.91 percent debt due July 2011. Each swap agreement converted a portion of the borrowing from fixed to floating rate interest. The Company received premiums of approximately $0.8 million for both agreements. Changes in the fair value of the swaps resulting from changes in market interest rates were recorded as a component of net income along with the offsetting changes in the fair value of the related debt instrument to the extent that the hedge was effective. Ineffectiveness was insignificant in 2006, 2005 and 2004. The swap agreements both had original maturity dates of July 15, 2011 and notional amounts of $75 million each. Under the terms of the swaps, the Company received semi- annual interest payments coinciding with the interest payments on the underlying debt of 7.91 percent and paid a variable rate based on the 6 month LIBOR rate plus a spread of about 3.7 percentage points. As part of the Acquisition, the Company terminated these swaps and generated a loss of $3.1 million which was originally deferred. Upon closing the Acquisition and retirement of the debt, these deferred losses, along with the remaining previously deferred gains totaling $0.8 million were recorded as a component of interest expense. Effective July 30, 2002, the Company terminated two interest rate swap agreements having notional amounts of $50 million and $75 million and generating gains of approximately $1.7 million and $3.3 million, respectively. These gains were capitalized as a component of debt and were being recognized as a reduction of net interest expense. Additionally, in the fourth quarter of 2001, the Company terminated a swap agreement having a notional amount of $75 million and generating a net gain of $5.4 million. This gain was capitalized as a component of debt and was being recognized as a reduction of net interest expense over the remaining life of the debt. This debt was retired in connection with the Acquisition in December 2005 and the deferred gains on the previously terminated swaps were recognized as a component of interest expense in 2005. The fair value hedging relationships the Company has entered into have been highly effective and the ineffectiveness recognized in other expense for the years 2006, 2005 and 2004 was immaterial. During the first quarter of 2002, the Company entered into an interest rate swap agreement with a notional amount of 6.7 billion Japanese yen that matured on January 24, 2007. The Company paid a fixed rate payment of 0.63 percent semi annually and received a Japanese yen floating rate based on the LIBOR rate. This agreement converted the variable interest rate implicit in the Company’s rolling net equity hedges in Japan to a fixed rate. While the Company believed that this agreement provided a valuable economic hedge against rising interest rates in Japan, it did not qualify for hedge accounting treatment under SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities . Accordingly, changes in the market value of the swap were recorded as a component of interest expense as incurred. Over the life of the swap, any cumulative gains or losses since the inception of the agreement were reduced to zero. As of December 30, 2006, the cumulative loss was $0.4 million, which was fully recognized in 2007. The change in the cumulative loss for 2005 was a net gain of $0.4 million. The Company also uses derivative financial instruments to hedge foreign currency exposures resulting from firm purchase commitments or anticipated transactions, and classifies these as cash flow hedges. The Company generally enters into cash flow hedge contracts for periods ranging from three to twelve months. The effective portion of the gain or loss on the hedging instrument is recorded in other comprehensive loss, and is reclassified into earnings as the transactions being hedged are recorded. As such, the balance at the end of the year in other comprehensive loss will be reclassified into earnings within the next twelve months. The associated asset or liability on the open hedge is recorded in other current assets or accrued liabilities as applicable. As of December 30, 2006, December 31, 2005 and December 25, 2004, the balance in other comprehensive loss (net of 60 Table of Contents tax) resulting from open hedges designated as cash flow hedges was a $0.2 million, $0.8 million and $0.5 million, respectively. The change in the balance in other comprehensive loss was a net gain (loss) of $0.6 million, $(0.3) million and $0.2 million during the years ended December 30, 2006, December 31, 2005 and December 25, 2004, respectively. The ineffective portion in other expense was immaterial. The Company had intended to refinance its $100 million notes that were due in 2006. To protect itself from the risk of higher interest rates, in 2005 the Company entered into an agreement to lock in a fixed treasury rate of approximately 4.70 percent, as compared with a current market rate of approximately 4.35 percent that provided the base interest for the debt originally expected to be issued in the refinancing. This derivative had been designated as a cash flow hedge and was recorded at its fair value on a quarterly basis. Pending the expected issuance of the new debt, any gains or losses, to the extent they represented an effective hedge, were recorded as a component of other comprehensive income. In the third quarter 2005, in anticipation of the Acquisition, when it was no longer probable that the refinancing of this debt would occur, the Company terminated these agreements and recorded a loss of $3.1 million as a component of interest expense. In addition to fair value and cash flow hedges, the Company uses financial instruments such as forward contracts and options to hedge a portion of its net equity investment in international operations, and classifies these as net equity hedges. For the years 2006, 2005 and 2004, the Company recorded pre-tax net gains/(losses) associated with these hedges of $(33.3) million, $25.7 million and $(23.6) million, respectively, in other comprehensive loss. Due to the permanent nature of the investments, the Company does not anticipate reclassifying any portion of this amount to the income statement in the next 12 months. The Company’s derivative financial instruments at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005 consisted solely of the financial instruments summarized above. All of the contracts, with the exception of the interest rate swaps, mature within 18 months. Related to the forward contracts, the “buy” amounts represent the U.S. dollar equivalent of commitments to purchase foreign currencies and the “sell” amounts represent the U.S. dollar equivalent of commitments to sell foreign currencies, all translated at the year-end market exchange rates for the U.S. dollar. All forward contracts are hedging net investments in certain foreign subsidiaries, cross-currency intercompany loans that are not permanent in nature as well as cross currency external payables and receivables, or forecast purchase commitments. The Company’s theoretical credit risk for each derivative instrument is its replacement cost, but management believes that the risk of incurring credit losses is remote and such losses, if any, would not be material. The Company also is exposed to market risk on its derivative instruments due to potential changes in foreign exchange rates; however, such market risk would be substantially offset by changes in the valuation of the underlying items being hedged. For all outstanding derivative instruments, the net accrued losses were $0.2 million, $0.1 million and $0.6 at December 30, 2006, December 31, 2005 and December 25, 2004, respectively, and were recorded either in accrued liabilities or other assets depending upon the net position of the individual contracts. While certain of the Company’s fair value hedges of non- permanent intercompany loans mitigate its exposure to foreign exchange gains or losses, they result in an impact to operating cash flows as the hedges are settled. However, the cash flow impact of certain of these exposures is in turn offset by hedges of net equity and other forward contracts. The notional amounts listed in the table above change based upon the Company’s outstanding exposure to fair value fluctuations. In January 2005, in order to hedge against the impact of a strengthening U.S. dollar, the Company entered into ten euro option agreements. Eight of the options were to hedge a portion of its net equity investments denominated in euros, and the other two were deemed speculative because they did not meet the requirements for hedge accounting. The options’ strike prices were approximately 1.256 U.S. dollars to the euro as compared with a market rate of 1.326 U.S. dollars to the euro when the options were purchased. The effect of these options was to protect the value of the Company’s euro net equity and cash flows with a floor of 1.256 U.S. dollars to the euro by giving the Company the option to sell euros at that value. The hedge options had an original combined notional value of 49.4 million euro and expiration dates at various points during 2005. The speculative options 61 Table of Contents had an original combined notional value of 20.5 million euro, with one of the options with a notional value of 6.3 million euro having an expiration date of September 2005 and the other with a notional value of 14.2 million euro having an expiration date of October 2005. When the exchange rates were above the strike price of the option immediately prior to their expiration, the Company allowed the options to expire unexercised. Conversely, when the U.S. dollar was at a rate below 1.256 U.S. dollars to the euro immediately prior to the expiration of the option contracts, they were exercised. At the end of each quarter, the Company revalued the open options and recorded any change in fair value as a component of other comprehensive income for equity hedge options and as a component of other income or expense for the speculative options. For the year ended December 31, 2005, the Company exercised 6 options with an aggregate notional amount of 45.5 million euros and allowed 4 with an aggregate notional amount of 24.4 million euros to expire unexercised. The Company recorded a net pre-tax gain of $1.0 million associated with the settlement of these options and had a gain of $1.7 million associated with exercised hedge options that was recorded in equity. The Company entered into similar option agreements in 2004, all of which were accounted for as hedges, and all of which expired unexercised during the year. In 2006 the Company did not purchase or sell currency options while in 2005 and 2004 the Company recorded a net pretax loss of $1.1 million and $1.7 million, respectively, for the cost of the options. During the first quarter of 2007, in order to protect the value of a portion of the Company’s euro-based cash flows expected during 2007, the Company purchased a series of put options, giving the Company the right, but not the obligation, to sell approximately 34.0 million euros in exchange for US dollars. The put options expire on various dates throughout 2007, and they have a weighted average strike price of about 1.28 dollars per euro. The Company paid premiums for these put options totaling about $0.5 million. Although the Company considers these put options to be a hedge of its exposure to changes in the value of the euro, they do not qualify for hedge accounting under SFAS 133. Accordingly, the value of the options will be marked to market at the end of each quarter of 2007, with any change in value recorded as a component of other income or expense, applicable. The maximum net expense that will be recognized is the $0.5 million premium already paid., and these premiums will be recorded as other expense during 2007. Additionally, changes in the market value of the options will also be recorded as other income or expense each quarter in 2007. During the first quarter of 2007, the Company will begin hedging $50 million worth of its yen net equity and $300 million of its euro net equity through a series of new forward contracts. This will significantly reduce interest expense in the future with an approximate $5.0 million impact in 2007. The initial forward contracts will mature in 2007 and 2008 and will be settled in cash such that the Company will be exposed to fluctuations in the value of the yen and euro versus the U.S. dollar. Over time, this exposure is expected to be offset by changes in the value of operating cash flows generated in the yen and the euro. Note 8: Subscriptions Receivable In October 2000, a subsidiary of the Company adopted a Management Stock Purchase Plan (the MSPP), which provided for eligible executives to purchase Company stock using full recourse loans provided by the subsidiary. Under the MSPP, the Company loaned $13.6 million to 33 senior executives to purchase 847,000 common shares from treasury stock. In 2001 and 2002, an additional nine senior executives purchased 74,500 shares of common stock from treasury stock utilizing loans totaling $1.7 million. The loans have annual interest rates of 5.21 percent to 5.96 percent, and all dividends, while the loans are outstanding, are applied toward interest due. Each of the loans has scheduled repayment dates of 25 percent on the fifth and sixth anniversaries of the loan issuance, with the balance due on the eighth anniversary. During 2006, thirteen participants surrendered a total of 99,388 shares of the Company’s common stock to the Company at current market prices to satisfy loans totaling $2.1 million. In addition, five participants made cash payments to satisfy loan payment obligations totaling $0.2 million. During 2005, eighteen participants surrendered a total of 254,441 shares of the Company’s common stock back to the Company at current market prices to satisfy loans totaling $5.6 million. In addition, four participants made cash payments to satisfy loan payment obligations totaling $0.6 million. During 2004, two 62 Table of Contents participants left the Company and surrendered, at the current market price, 36,882 shares to the Company to satisfy loans totaling $0.7 million. Also during 2004, a participant left the Company and made a $0.7 million cash payment to satisfy the loan obligation and another participant elected to make a voluntary advance loan payment of $0.6 million. Under the terms of the MSPP, if at the scheduled repayment date a loan remains outstanding and the Company’s stock price per share is below the market price when the loan was originated, the Company will make cash bonus payments equal to the amount the value of the stock is below its purchase price, up to 25 percent of the outstanding principal on the loan then due. For each share purchased, an option on two shares was granted under the 2000 Incentive Plan. See Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements. The loans have been recorded as subscriptions receivable and are secured by the shares purchased. Principal amounts are due as follows: $0.2 million in 2007; $2.6 million in 2008 and $0.5 million in 2009. No further loans or sales of stock are being made under this Plan. In 2006 and 2005, the Company returned to income $0.4 million and $0.8 million, respectively, of a provision recorded since the adoption of the MSPP for the potential cash bonus payments described above associated with principal amounts due in 2006 and 2005. This was due to the associated loans being repaid prior to their due dates. The Company will continue to accrue for the cost of potential future cash bonus payments associated with loans that remain outstanding. On November 30, 1998, the Company made a non-recourse, non-interest bearing loan of $7.7 million (the loan) to its chairman and chief executive officer (chairman), the proceeds of which were used by the chairman to buy in the open market 400,000 shares of the Company’s common stock (the shares) at an average price of $19.12 per share. The shares were pledged to secure the repayment of the loan. The loan was recorded as a subscription receivable and was due November 12, 2006, with voluntary prepayments permitted commencing November 12, 2002, and mandatory prepayments required equal to 10 percent of annual bonus payments. On October 26, 2006 the Company’s chairman and chief executive officer surrendered 330,368 shares of the Company’s common stock at a market price of $21.49 in satisfaction of the $7.1 million outstanding balance, which had previously been reduced through cash payments of $0.6 million. Note 9: Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss (In millions) Foreign currency translation adjustments Net equity hedge gain (loss) Pension and retiree medical Deferred loss on cash flow hedges Total 2006 $ (160.6 ) (6.9 ) (23.1 ) (0.2 ) $ (190.8 ) 2005 $ (203.1 ) 14.4 (10.6 ) (0.8 ) $ (200.1 ) In 2006, there was a $12.5 million (net of tax) pension liability adjustment as a result of the Company’s adoption of SFAS 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R) . Note 10: Income Taxes For income tax purposes, the domestic and foreign components of income (loss) before taxes were as follows: (In millions) Domestic Foreign Total 2006 $ (31.7 ) 135.5 $ 103.8 2005 $ (19.9 ) 84.4 $ 64.5 2004 $ 2.3 99.7 $ 102.0 63 Table of Contents The provision (benefit) for income taxes was as follows: (In millions) Current: Federal Foreign State Deferred: Federal Foreign State Total 2006 2005 2004 $ 20.7 35.4 0.3 56.4 (38.8 ) (11.9 ) 3.9 (46.8 ) $ 9.6 $ (36.0 ) 19.4 — (16.6 ) (2.1 ) (2.4 ) 0.2 (4.3 ) $ (20.9 ) $ 8.4 19.1 1.5 29.0 (20.9 ) 8.7 (1.7 ) (13.9 ) $ 15.1 The differences between the provision for income taxes and income taxes computed using the U.S. federal statutory rate was as follows: (In millions) Amount computed using statutory rate (Reduction) increase in taxes resulting from: Net benefit from repatriating foreign earnings and direct foreign tax credits Foreign income taxes Change in valuation allowance for deferred tax assets Foreign and domestic tax audit adjustments Other Total Deferred tax (liabilities) assets are composed of the following: (In millions) Purchased intangibles Other Gross deferred tax liabilities Credit and net operating loss carry forwards Fixed assets basis differences Employee benefits accruals Postretirement benefits Inventory Accounts receivable Depreciation Other accruals Gross deferred tax assets Valuation allowances Net deferred tax assets 64 2006 $ 36.3 2005 $ 22.6 2004 $ 35.7 (10.2 ) (28.3 ) 7.2 — 4.6 $ 9.6 (0.6 ) (7.4 )) (5.1 (27.1 ) (3.3 ) $ (20.9 ) (1.4 ) (12.7 ) (1.8 ) (2.1 ) (2.6 ) $ 15.1 2006 $ (60.9 ) (12.2 ) (73.1 ) 213.7 23.2 25.4 17.9 11.7 11.6 3.5 36.5 343.4 (47.0 ) $ 223.3 2005 $ (71.3 ) (2.0 ) (73.3 ) 157.7 30.0 19.8 15.7 14.0 11.3 1.3 39.5 289.3 (39.8 ) $ 176.2 Table of Contents At December 30, 2006, the Company had domestic federal and state net operating loss carry forwards of $89.2 million, separate state net operating loss carry forwards of $77.0 million, and foreign net operating loss carry forwards of $355.9 million. Of the total foreign and domestic net operating loss carry forwards, $321.0 million expire at various dates from 2007 to 2026, while the remainder have unlimited lives. During 2006, the Company realized net cash benefits of $5.8 million related to foreign net operating loss carry forwards. At December 31, 2006, the Company had estimated foreign tax credit carry forwards of $50.2 million, most of which expire beginning in 2014 if not utilized. These valuation allowances relate to tax assets in jurisdictions where it is management’s best estimate that there is not a greater than 50 percent probability that the benefit of the assets will be realized in the associated tax returns. The likelihood of realizing the benefit of deferred tax assets is assessed on an ongoing basis. Consequently, future material changes in the valuation allowance are possible. The Company paid (received refunds) income taxes, net, in 2006, 2005 and 2004 of $29.5 million, $(34.7) million and $45.8 million, respectively. The Company has foreign subsidiaries which receive tax holidays that will expire in 2007 and 2009 if not renewed or extended. There are various factors which may impact the amount of the annual benefit derived from the tax holiday. The net benefit of the tax holidays in 2006 and 2005 was $6.4 million and $4.0 million, respectively. In July 2006, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (FIN 48). FIN 48 clarifies the accounting for income taxes by prescribing a minimum probability threshold that a tax position must meet before a financial statement benefit is recognized. The minimum threshold is defined in FIN 48 as a tax position that is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by the applicable taxing authority, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefit to be recognized is measured as the largest amount of benefit that is greater than 50 percent likely of being realized upon ultimate settlement. FIN 48 must be applied to all existing tax positions upon initial adoption. The cumulative effect of applying FIN 48 at adoption, if any, is to be reported as an adjustment to opening retained earnings for the year of adoption. FIN 48 is effective for the Company’s 2007 fiscal year. The Company is currently assessing the potential effect of FIN 48 on its financial statements. On December 21, 2004, the FASB issued two FSPs which address issues related to recently enacted tax legislation. FSP 109-1, Application of FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes, for the Tax Deduction Provided to U.S.-Based Manufacturers by the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004 , clarifies that the tax deduction for domestic manufacturers under the American Jobs Creation Act should be accounted for as a special deduction as opposed to a rate reduction. The benefit of this provision is insignificant. FSP 109-2, Accounting and Disclosure Guidance for the Foreign Earnings Repatriation Provision within the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004 , provides accounting and disclosure guidance for the special one-time dividends received deduction allowed by the act on the repatriation of certain foreign earnings to a U.S. taxpayer. The Company elected not avail itself of this deduction. The Company has $546.2 million of undistributed earnings of international subsidiaries. The Company has not provided for U.S. deferred income taxes on these undistributed earnings because of its intention to indefinitely reinvest these earnings. Effective January 1, 2006 the Company adopted the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R), Share-Based Payment, and related interpretations, or SFAS 123(R), to account for stock-based compensation using the modified prospective transition method and therefore will not restate prior period results. SFAS123(R), requires that recognition of tax windfall benefits related to the exercise of employee stock-based compensation be delayed until the period that the reduction will reduce income taxes payable. Due to current year domestic net operating losses of $54.3 million, the Company did not recognize $0.5 million of benefits for deductions associated with the exercise of employee stock options in 2006. The Company recognized $2.0 million and $0.2 million, respectively, of benefits for deductions associated with the exercise of employee stock options in 2005 and 2004, respectively. These benefits were added directly to paid-in capital, and were not reflected in the provision for income taxes. 65 Table of Contents Note 11: Retirement Benefit Plans Pension Plans. The Company has various defined benefit pension plans covering substantially all domestic employees, employed as of June 30, 2005, except those employed by BeautiControl, and certain employees in other countries. In addition to providing pension benefits, the Company provides certain postretirement healthcare and life insurance benefits for selected U.S. and Canadian employees. Most employees and retirees outside the United States are covered by government healthcare programs. Employees may become eligible for these benefits if they reach normal retirement age while working for the Company and satisfy certain years of service requirements. The medical plans are contributory for post-1994 retirees, with retiree contributions adjusted annually, and contain other cost-sharing features, such as deductibles and coinsurance. The medical plans include an allowance for Medicare for post-65 age retirees. In December 2003, the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (the Act) was signed into law. The Act provides new prescription drug benefits under Medicare as well as providing for a federal subsidy to be paid to plans that are at least actuarially equivalent to Medicare in their prescription drug plans. In May 2004, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 106-2, Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003. This FSP provides guidance on accounting for the effects of the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 by employers whose prescription drug benefits are actuarially equivalent to the drug benefit under Medicare Part D. It also contains basic guidance on related income tax accounting and rules for transition allowing prospective or retroactive adoption and was effective for the third quarter of 2004. The Company elected prospective adoption of the FSP guidance and the effect of the subsidy on the net periodic postretirement benefit cost for 2004 was to reduce the interest cost by $0.2 million and the amortization of the actuarial loss by $0.2 million. In the fourth quarter of 2006 the Company amended its domestic retiree medical plan effective April 1, 2007. Prior to the effective date but after January 1, 1995, the Company subsidized the cost of health care for retirees based on age and years of service. For under age 65 retirees, the amendment altered the Company’s contribution from a percent of cost to a fixed amount. For over age 65 retirees, the amendment lowered the fixed subsidy amount. For former associates retired prior to January 1, 1995 and under the age of 80, the amendment introduced a monthly premium charge of $35 per covered adult. The change resulted in a decrease of expense of $0.3 million in 2006 and is expected to decrease the annual cost by approximately $1.8 million in 2007 and thereafter. Effective June 30, 2005, the Company froze the benefits to participants under its U.S. defined benefit pension plans. This action necessitated a re-measurement of its accumulated benefit obligation under the plans and resulted in a pretax increase of $5.1 million ($3.3 million after tax). As part of its re-measurement, the Company decreased its discount rate assumption from 5.75 percent to 5.0 percent. Other assumptions remained consistent with those previously used. The Company also recorded an immaterial curtailment loss in the second quarter of 2005 related to this action. In conjunction with the benefit freeze, the Company increased its basic contribution related to one of its domestic defined contribution plans from 3 percent of eligible employee compensation up to the Social Security Wage Base to 5 percent. Effective December 30, 2006, the Company adopted the recognition and disclosure provisions of SFAS No.158 Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R) . This Statement requires employers to recognize in their balance sheets the overfunded or underfunded status of defined benefit post-retirement plans, measured as the difference between the fair value of plan assets and the benefit obligation (the projected benefit obligation for pension plans and the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation for other post-retirement plans). Employers must recognize the change in the funded status of the plan in the year in which the change occurs through accumulated other comprehensive income. This Statement also requires plan assets and obligations to be measured as of the employers’ balance sheet date. Prior to the adoption of the recognition provisions of SFAS No. 158, the Company accounted for its defined benefit post-retirement plans under SFAS No. 87, Employers Accounting for Pensions and SFAS No. 106, 66 Table of Contents Employers’ Accounting for Postretirement Benefits Other Than Pensions . SFAS No. 87 required that a liability (minimum pension liability) be recorded when the accumulated benefit obligation (ABO) liability exceeded the fair value of plan assets. Any adjustment was recorded as a non-cash charge to accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity. SFAS No. 106 required that the liability recorded should represent the actuarial present value of all future benefits attributable to an employee’s service rendered to date. Under both SFAS No. 87 and No. 106, changes in the funded status were not immediately recognized; rather they were deferred and recognized ratably over future periods. Upon adoption of the recognition provisions of SFAS No. 158, the Company recognized the amounts of prior changes in the funded status of its post-retirement benefit plans through accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). As a result, the Company recognized the following adjustments in individual line items of its Consolidated Balance Sheet as of December 30, 2006: (in millions) Other assets, net Accrued liabilities Accrued postretirement benefit cost Other liabilities Total liabilities Accumulated other comprehensive loss (pre-tax) Prior to Application of SFAS No. 158 5.1 $ 10.2 35.3 72.0 117.5 (16.2 ) 67 Effect of Adopting SFAS No. 158 (4.8 ) $ (3.6 ) 7.0 10.4 13.8 (18.6 ) As Reported at December 30, 2006 $ 0.3 6.6 42.3 82.4 131.3 (34.8 ) Table of Contents The Company uses a fiscal year end measurement date for its plans. The plans of the Acquired Units are included below. The funded status of all of the Company’s plans was as follows: (In millions) Change in benefit obligations: Beginning balance Service cost Interest cost Actuarial (gain) loss Benefits paid Impact of exchange rates Amendments Settlements Curtailment Acquisition Ending balance Change in plan assets at fair value: Beginning balance Actual return on plan assets Company contributions Plan participant contributions Benefits and expenses paid Impact of exchange rates Settlements Acquisition Ending balance Funded status of the plan Unrecognized actuarial loss Unrecognized prior service cost/(benefit) Unrecognized net transition liability Net amount recognized Weighted average assumptions: Discount rate Return on plan assets Salary growth rate Pension benefits Postretirement benefits U.S. plans Foreign plans Pension benefits 2006 2005 2006 2005 2006 2005 $ 45.3 0.8 2.5 (0.8 ) (2.3 ) — — — — — $ 45.5 $ 28.3 3.3 — — (2.4 ) — — — $ 29.2 $ (16.3 ) 7.7 0.9 — $ (7.7 ) $ 48.5 1.4 2.5 3.5 (0.8 ) — (5.1 ) (4.7 ) — — $ 45.3 $ 24.9 1.6 7.5 — (1.1 ) — (4.6 ) — $ 28.3 $ (17.0 ) 10.3 1.2 — $ (5.5 ) $ 69.3 0.5 3.1 (10.5 ) (5.1 ) — (9.6 ) — (1.4 ) — $ 46.3 $ — — 5.1 — (5.1 ) — — — $ — $ (46.3 ) 16.5 (9.9 ) — $ (39.7 ) $ 64.5 0.9 3.8 5.7 (5.6 ) — — — — — $ 69.3 $ — — 5.6 — (5.6 ) — — — $ — $ (69.3 ) 29.4 (0.8 ) — $ (40.7 ) 7.5 6.3 2.2 (5.5 ) 7.5 — (1.8 ) (0.1 ) (3.9 ) $ 123.6 $ 95.7 4.6 3.9 7.5 (4.7 ) (7.9 ) — — — 24.5 $ 135.8 $ 123.6 $ 56.4 $ 46.8 6.5 3.8 6.7 8.1 0.8 0.7 (4.9 ) (4.6 ) (3.0 ) 4.1 — (1.4 ) — 3.5 $ 67.1 $ 56.4 $ (68.7 ) $ (67.2 ) 12.7 17.7 1.6 1.7 0.8 0.2 $ (49.1 ) $ (53.2 ) 5.8 % 8.5 — 5.5 % 8.5 4.8 5.8 % n/a n/a 5.5 % n/a n/a 4.3 % 5.0 3.0 5.0 % 4.2 3.2 68 Table of Contents Amounts recognized in the balance sheet consisted of: (in millions) Accrued benefit liability Accumulated other comprehensive loss (pre-tax) Net amount recognized December 30, 2006 (131.3 ) $ 34.8 (96.5 ) $ December 31, 2005 (115.2 ) $ 13.9 (101.3 ) $ Items not yet recognized as a component of pension expense as of December 30, 2006 consisted of: (in millions) Transition liability Prior service cost/ (benefit) Net actuarial loss Accumulated other comprehensive loss (pre-tax) $ 0.2 (7.3 ) 41.9 $ 34.8 In 2007, the Company expects to recognize approximately $0.1 million of the prior service benefit and $2.2 million of the net actuarial loss as a component of pension expense. The accumulated benefit obligation for all defined benefit pension plans at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005 was $163.5 million and $127.9 million, respectively. At December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, the accumulated benefit obligations of certain pension plans exceeded those plans’ assets. For those plans, the accumulated benefit obligations were $123.8 million and $107.3 million, and the fair value of their assets was $52.2 million and $42.5 million as of December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, respectively. The accrued benefit cost for the pension plans is reported in accrued liabilities and other long-term liabilities. The costs associated with all of the Company’s plans were as follows: (In millions) Components of net periodic benefit cost: Service cost and expenses Interest cost Return on plan assets Curtailment Recognized net actuarial loss Net deferral Net periodic benefit cost Weighted average assumptions: U.S. plans Foreign plans Discount rate Return on plan assets Salary growth rate Discount rate Return on plan assets Salary growth rate Pension benefits 2005 2006 2004 Postretirement benefits 2005 2006 2004 $ 8.2 8.8 (2.9 ) — 0.4 (1.0 ) $ 13.5 $ 5.7 6.5 (1.0 ) — 0.6 (1.5 ) $ 10.3 $ 5.0 5.5 (2.6 ) — — (1.1 ) $ 6.8 $ 0.5 3.2 — (0.3 ) 1.0 (0.2 ) $ 4.2 $ 0.9 3.8 — — 1.5 (0.1 ) $ 6.1 $ 0.8 3.6 1.0 — — (0.1 ) $ 5.3 5.5 % 8.5 — 5.4 % 8.5 4.8 6.0 % 8.5 4.8 5.5 % n/a n/a 5.8 % n/a n/a 6.0 % n/a n/a 4.3 5.0 3.0 4.5 % 3.9 3.0 4.5 % 5.1 2.9 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a The overall long-term rates-of-return-on-assets for the U.S. pension plans were chosen from the range of likely results of compound average annual returns over a 20-year time horizon. The range was calculated by modeling a probable rate-of-return based on historical data for the period 1926-2002 for stocks, bonds and cash 69 Table of Contents and was applied to the Company’s current target asset mix for the plan. The long-term rate-of-return for foreign pension plans was also selected from probable returns based on historical data as calculated by the actuaries as well as comparisons to trends in other companies. The Company utilizes a published rating index of a portfolio of high quality, fixed-income debt instruments as a benchmark for the discount rates used to determine the benefit obligations of its plans. For the U.S. plans, the discount rate was based on the rate of return for a portfolio of Moody’s AA rated high quality bonds with maturities that are consistent with the projected future benefit payment obligations of the plans. The weighted average discount rate for the U.S. and foreign plans for 2006 were 5.8 percent and 4.4 percent, respectively and 5.5 percent and 5.0 percent, respectively for 2005. The assumed healthcare cost trend rate for 2006 was 8.0 percent for both post-65 age participants and pre-65 age participants, decreasing to 5.0 percent in 2010. The healthcare cost trend rate assumption has a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one percentage point change in the assumed healthcare cost trend rates would have the following effects: (In millions) Effect on total of service and interest cost components Effect on post-retirement benefit obligation One percentage point Increase $ 0.3 3.2 Decrease (0.3 ) $ (3.0 ) The Company’s weighted-average asset allocations at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005 by asset category were as follows: Asset Category Equity securities Debt securities Real estate Cash and money market investments Total 2006 2005 U.S. plans Foreign plans U.S. plans Foreign plans 63 % 37 — — 100 % 64 % 20 2 14 100 % 62 % 37 — 1 100 % 61 % 19 — 20 100 % The Company’s specific return objective on its U.S. pension plan is to achieve each year a return greater than or equal to the return that would have been earned by a portfolio invested approximately 60 percent in equity securities and 40 percent in fixed income securities. The Company has adopted the following asset class allocations for its U.S. pension plan: 62 percent in equity securities (32 percent large U.S. stocks, 20 percent small U.S. stocks, and 10 percent international stocks) and 38 percent fixed income securities (36 percent bonds and 1 percent U.S. cash equivalents). At each quarter end, the asset classes may be rebalanced to obtain the target asset mix if the percentages fall outside of acceptable range variances. The investment policy is reviewed from time to time to ensure consistency with the long-term objective of funding at least 90 percent of the plan’s liabilities. Options, derivatives, forwards, futures contracts, short positions, or margined positions may be held in reasonable amounts as deemed prudent. Transactions that would jeopardize the tax-exempt status of the plan are not allowed. Lending of securities may be permitted in cases in which an appropriate gain can be realized. The Company does not invest in any of its own stock; however, this restriction does not prevent investment in insurance company accounts, other commingled or mutual funds, or any index funds which may hold securities of the Company. Additional guidelines for investment managers selected by the Company to manage equity securities prohibit the securities of one company or affiliated group, other than U.S. government securities, to exceed 5 percent of the portfolio and that no more than 25 percent of a separately managed portfolio be invested in any one industry, unless that industry represents greater than 20 percent of the benchmark market index. International equity investments shall be diversified by country and by industry and primarily include securities 70 Table of Contents listed on significant exchanges. Equity portfolios may include a small portion of convertible bonds and preferred stock but these securities do not substitute as bonds within the portfolios. Investment managers selected by the Company to manage the fixed income investments are also prohibited from holding more than 5 percent in any one company or affiliated group of companies, other than U.S. government securities, and from holding more than 25 percent of investments in any one industry. In addition, no more than 25 percent of the fixed income portfolio may be invested in foreign securities and no more than 25 percent of the portfolio may be invested in below investment grade securities. The Company’s return objective for its foreign plans is to achieve a return of approximately 6.3 percent to 6.5 percent. To achieve this return, the foreign plans weighted average target allocations for its investments are 60 percent equity securities and 40 percent fixed income, cash and money market investments. The Company expects to contribute $8.6 million to its U.S. and foreign pension plans and $4.4 million to its other U.S. postretirement benefit plan in 2007. The Company also has several savings, thrift and profit-sharing plans. Its contributions to these plans are in part based upon various levels of employee participation. The total cost of these plans was $5.5 million in 2006, $4.1 million in 2005 and $2.3 million in 2004. The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid for the Company’s foreign and U.S. plans: Years 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 – 2016 Pension benefits 8.6 $ 8.7 9.8 9.8 21.0 72.6 $ Postretirement benefits 5.0 $ 5.0 5.0 5.0 4.9 22.2 $ Subsidy Receipts 0.6 $ 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.7 3.5 $ Total $ 13.0 13.1 14.2 14.2 25.2 $ 91.3 Included in the postretirement benefits in the table above are expected payments for prescription drug benefits. As a result of the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 discussed above, the Company expects subsidy receipts of $6.6 million from 2007 through 2016 related to these prescription drug benefits. Note 12: Incentive Compensation Plans Incentive Plans. On May 17, 2006 the shareholders of the Company approved the adoption of the Tupperware Brands Corporation 2006 Incentive Plan (the “2006 Incentive Plan”). The 2006 Incentive Plan provides for the issuance of cash and stock-based incentive awards to employees and certain non-employee participants. Stock-based awards may be in the form of performance awards, stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards and restricted stock unit awards. The total number of shares available for grant under the 2006 Incentive Plan as of December 30, 2006, was 3,862,912 of which 1,092,344 could be issued in the form of restricted stock. Other than for options on 157,118 shares exchanged for certain BeautiControl options in connection with the 2000 acquisition, all options’ exercise prices are equal to the underlying shares’ grant-date market values. Outstanding unvested options generally vest in one-third increments on the anniversary of the grant date in each of the following three years; however, certain options granted in 2000 and 2001 vest seven years after the date of grant. The vesting of these options may be accelerated if certain stock price appreciation goals are attained. No such acceleration occurred in 2006 and 535,718 shares were vested prior to 2006. At December 30, 2006, options of this type to purchase 1,009,306 shares were outstanding. The unvested options will vest in November 2008, or earlier. 71 Table of Contents All outstanding options have exercise periods that are 10 years from the date of grant and outstanding restricted shares have initial vesting periods ranging from one to three years. Under the plan, awards that are canceled or expire are added back to the pool of available shares. Director Plan. On May 17, 2006 the Company’s shareholders also approved amendments to the Tupperware Brands Corporation Director Stock Plan (“Director Stock Plan”). The amendments expand the types of awards that may be issued under the Director Stock Plan to include restricted stock and restricted stock unit awards and authorize the Compensation and Management Development Committee of the Board of Directors to grant equity-based awards in amounts and with terms and conditions that permit the Company to attract and retain qualified directors. Under the Director Stock Plan, non-employee directors are obligated to receive one-half of their annual retainers in the form of stock and may elect to receive the balance of their annual retainers in the form of stock or cash. In addition, each non-employee director on the date of the Company’s annual meeting of shareholders receives a stock grant in such form and amount as may be determined by the Compensation and Management Development Committee of the Board of Directors. The number of shares authorized for grant under the Director Stock Plan and the number of shares available for grant as of December 30, 2006, were 600,000 and 282,024, respectively. Through 2002, the Company accounted for its stock-based compensation under the intrinsic value recognition and measurement principles of Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees , and related Interpretations. Effective with fiscal 2003, the Company began accounting for those plans using the fair-value-based method of accounting for stock options under the provisions of SFAS 123 prospectively to all employee awards granted, modified, or settled after December 28, 2002 as permitted under the transition guidance of SFAS 148, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation—Transition and Disclosure—an amendment of FAS 123 . Compensation cost for options that vest on a graduated schedule is recorded over that time period. Therefore, the cost related to the stock-based employee compensation included in the determination of net income for 2005 and 2004 is less than that which would have been recognized if the fair-value-based method had been applied to all awards since the original effective date of SFAS 123. Compensation expense associated with time-based restricted stock grants is equal to the market value of the shares on the date of grant and is recorded pro rata over the required holding period. In 2006, the Company awarded performance restricted shares and for these the expense is recorded based on an assessment of achieving a defined level of sales and net income growth within the next three years. Compensation expense associated with restricted stock grants was $2.5 million, $1.4 million and $0.6 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Earned cash performance awards of $15.7 million, $9.3 million and $12.2 million were included in the consolidated statement of income for 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. 72 Table of Contents Stock option and restricted stock activity for 2006, 2005 and 2004 for all of the Company’s Incentive Plans including the Director Stock Plan are summarized in the following tables. Stock options Balance at December 27, 2003 Granted Expired / Forfeited Exercised Balance at December 25, 2004 Granted Expired / Forfeited Exercised Balance at December 31, 2005 Granted Expired / Forfeited Exercised Balance at December 30, 2006 Shares subject to option 10,541,377 588,100 (383,395 ) (252,092 ) 10,493,990 727,800 (588,804 ) (1,641,785 ) 8,991,201 652,300 (488,798 ) (419,488 ) 8,735,215 Weighted average option Options exercisable at Weighted average exercise price per share 19.87 $ 18.16 26.53 16.43 19.61 23.41 26.57 18.33 19.76 20.83 40.64 17.60 18.87 $ year end 6,087,914 price per share 21.70 $ 7,572,413 20.78 6,770,383 20.10 6,459,389 $ 18.76 Restricted stock Balance at December 27, 2003 Awarded Vested Balance at December 25, 2004 Awarded Vested Forfeited Balance at December 31, 2005 Granted 2006 Incentive Plan Vested Forfeited Balance at December 30, 2006 Stock Options Outstanding As of December 30, 2006 Exercise price range $ 4.23 – $12.68 $12.69 – $16.90 $16.91 – $21.13 $21.14 – $29.58 Shares outstanding 122,000 112,000 (9,000 ) 225,000 220,000 (5,000 ) (8,000 ) 432,000 132,000 18,000 (104,000 ) (4,000 ) 474,000 Shares available for issuance 346,844 (112,000 ) — 234,844 (220,000 ) — 8,000 22,844 (132,000 ) 1,197,500 — 4,000 1,092,344 Exercisable Outstanding Average remaining life 3.3 4.7 4.6 5.8 4.8 Average exercise price $ 9.75 15.78 19.41 23.77 $ 18.87 Shares 55,850 2,585,537 4,892,036 1,201,792 8,735,215 Average exercise price $ 9.75 15.69 19.21 23.94 $ 18.76 Shares 55,850 1,643,455 4,036,770 723,314 6,459,389 The estimated weighted average fair value of 2006 grants was $4.26 per share under option. See Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements for pro forma presentation had fair value estimates been used to record compensation expense in the consolidated statements of income for grants prior to 2003. 73 Table of Contents Note 13: Segment Information The Company manufactures and distributes a broad portfolio of products primarily through independent direct sales consultants. Certain international operating segments have been aggregated based upon consistency of economic substance, products, production process, class of customers and distribution method. As a result of changes in the Company’s management structure as well as a re-evaluation of the Company’s operating segment definitions, the Company reorganized its previously reported segments as follows: • • • • • • • There have been no changes to the Company’s BeautiControl North America segment. International BeautiControl operations are reported in the segments in which the business component geographically resides. The International Beauty reportable segment included the acquired businesses operated primarily under the brand names noted above, as well as the Company’s Tupperware operations in Central and South America and the Philippines which were included in the Company’s Latin America and Asia Pacific reportable segments prior to 2006, respectively. The Company’s Tupperware and BeautiControl operations in Mexico are included in the North America segment; they were included in the Latin America reportable segment prior to 2006. With the movement of Central and South America as well as Mexico, the Company no longer has a Latin America reportable segment. The Company’s NaturCare ® brand business operating in Japan is included in the Asia Pacific segment; it was previously included in the International Beauty reportable segment. This change includes the transfer of intangible assets and goodwill of $30.2 million and $24.3 million, respectively. The Company’s Avroy Shlain ® and Swissgarde ® brand businesses are now included in the Europe segment; they were previously included in the International Beauty reportable segment. This change includes the transfer of intangible assets and goodwill of $16.6 million and $16.3 million, respectively. Prior period data has been reclassified to reflect these changes. The Company’s reportable segments include the following businesses: Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl North America International Beauty Primarily food storage, preparation and serving containers, professional kitchen tools, microwave cookware and educational toys marketed under the Tupperware ® brand worldwide. Europe includes Avroy Shlain ® and Swissgarde ® , the beauty and personal care units in Southern Africa. Asia Pacific includes NaturCare ® , the beauty and personal care unit in Japan. Premium cosmetics and skin care products marketed under the BeautiControl ® brand in the United States and Canada. Primarily beauty and personal care products in Latin and South America, Asia Pacific and Europe under the brand names House of Fuller ® , Nutrimetics ® and Nuvo Cosmeticos ® . Also includes the Tupperware units in the Philippines and Central and South America. 74 Table of Contents Worldwide sales of beauty and personal care products totaled $663.3 million, $199.3 million and $128.9 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The Acquired Units operations are included from the date of acquisition. (In millions) Net sales: Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl North America International Beauty Total net sales Segment profit (loss): Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl North America International Beauty Total profit Unallocated expenses Other, net Re-engineering and impairment charges Interest expense, net Income before income taxes Depreciation and amortization: Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl North America International Beauty Corporate Total depreciation and amortization Capital expenditures: Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl North America International Beauty Corporate Total capital expenditures Identifiable assets: Europe Asia Pacific North America BeautiControl North America International Beauty Corporate Total identifiable assets 75 2006 2005 2004 $ 615.9 239.7 255.5 150.0 482.6 $ 1,743.7 $ 94.4 33.8 8.7 14.6 30.8 $ 182.3 (36.3 ) 12.5 (7.6 ) (47.0 ) $ 103.9 $ $ $ $ 21.3 17.5 10.8 1.8 18.1 3.5 72.9 19.5 9.0 6.8 5.1 7.0 4.8 52.1 $ 602.5 204.5 253.6 146.7 72.0 $ 1,279.3 $ 116.2 20.2 0.5 14.0 0.9 $ 151.8 (28.3 ) 4.0 (16.7 ) (45.1 ) 65.7 $ $ $ $ $ 18.4 10.9 13.8 1.5 0.2 6.0 50.8 20.5 9.5 7.8 2.1 4.7 7.3 52.0 $ 597.0 194.8 278.7 118.0 35.7 $ 1,224.3 $ 133.4 20.5 (22.3 ) 8.0 1.6 $ 141.2 (32.7 ) 13.1 (7.0 ) (13.0 ) $ 102.0 $ $ $ $ 19.0 9.1 15.9 1.3 1.1 4.4 50.8 19.4 8.4 8.9 1.9 0.7 4.7 44.1 $ 329.9 173.2 198.5 76.4 658.6 252.8 $ 1,689.4 $ 290.8 165.1 210.4 73.6 646.3 347.9 $ 1,734.1 $ 286.5 117.9 236.7 68.4 38.8 228.0 $ 976.3 Table of Contents a. b. In 2002, the Company began to sell land held for development near its Orlando, Florida headquarters. During 2006, 2005 and 2004, pretax gains from these sales were $9.3 million, $4.0 million and $11.6 million, respectively, and were recorded in other, net in the table above. Internal costs for management incentives directly related to these sales were $0.2 million, $0.1 million and $0.3 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, and were recorded in unallocated expenses. The re-engineering and impairment charges line provides for severance and other exit costs. Total after-tax impact of these costs was $5.8 million, $10.5 million and $4.3 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. c. During 2006 and 2004, the Company recorded pretax gains of $4.4 million and $1.5 million, respectively, as a result of the insurance settlement from hurricane damage suffered at the Company’s headquarters location in Orlando, Florida. Additionally, in 2006 the Company recorded expense of $1.2 million related to a loss arising from a fire at its former manufacturing facility in Tennessee. These gains and impairment are included in other, net in the table above. Sales and segment profit in the preceding table are from transactions with customers. Inter-segment transfers of inventory are accounted for at cost. Sales generated by product line, except beauty and personal care versus Tupperware ® , are not captured in the financial statements and disclosure of the information is impractical. Sales to a single customer did not exceed 10 percent of total sales in any segment. Export sales were insignificant. Sales to customers in Germany were $198.0 million, $231.0 million and $252.6 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Sales of Tupperware and beauty products to customers in Mexico were $370.4 million, $115.2 million and $83.7 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. There was no other foreign country in which sales were material to the Company’s total sales. Sales of Tupperware and BeautiControl products to customers in the United States were $284.9 million, $287.6 million and $296.6 million in 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Unallocated expenses are corporate expenses and other items not directly related to the operations of any particular segment. Corporate assets consist of cash, buildings and assets maintained for general corporate purposes. As of the end of 2006, 2005 and 2004, respectively, long-lived assets in the United States were $90.1 million, $106.3 million and $98.1 million. As of December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005 the Company’s net investment in international operations was $891.6 million and $852.2 million, respectively. The Company is subject to the usual economic risks associated with international operations; however, these risks are partially mitigated by the broad geographic dispersion of the Company’s operations. Included in the cash balance of $102.2 million reported at the end of 2006, was a cash balance of $10.3 million denominated in Venezuelan bolivars. The balance is primarily a result of favorable operating cash flows in the market. Due to Venezuelan government restrictions on transfers of cash out of the country and control of exchange rates, the Company can not immediately repatriate this cash at the exchange rate used to translate the Venezuelan bolivars into U.S. dollars for inclusion on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. It will apply for, and expects to receive, authorization in 2007 to transfer approximately half of such amount out of the country. It has also implemented other strategies in an effort to eventually repatriate the current cash balance. The Company believes it could immediately repatriate the cash from Venezuela, but it would only be able to do so at a significantly less favorable exchange rate. This would result in the Company having fewer U.S. dollars than currently reported as a component of cash and cash equivalents on its consolidated balance sheet with the difference recorded as a foreign exchange loss in its consolidated income statement. Note 14: Commitments and Contingencies The Company and certain subsidiaries are involved in litigation and various legal matters that are being defended and handled in the ordinary course of business. Included among these matters are environmental issues. 76 Table of Contents The Company does not include estimated future legal costs in any necessary accruals. The Company believes that it is remote that the Company’s contingencies will have a material adverse effect on its financial position, results of operations or cash flow. In 2006 the Company recorded a pretax loss of $1.2 million as a result of a fire at its former manufacturing facility in Halls, Tennessee. The amount recorded is based on its current best estimate. As more information becomes available related to this event, adjustments may be necessary. Kraft Foods, Inc., which was formerly affiliated with Premark International, Inc., the Company’s former parent and Tupperware, has assumed any liabilities arising out of certain divested or discontinued businesses. The liabilities assumed include matters alleging product liability, environmental liability and infringement of patents. As part of the Acquisition, Sara Lee Corporation indemnified the Registrant for any liabilities arising out of any existing litigation at the time of the Acquisition and for certain legal matters arising out of circumstances which might relate to periods before or after the date of the acquisition. Leases. Rental expense for operating leases totaled $26.7 million in 2006, $27.5 million in 2005 and $28.9 million in 2004. Approximate minimum rental commitments under non-cancelable operating leases in effect at December 30, 2006, were: 2007—$24.7 million; 2008—$16.2 million; 2009—$9.7 million; 2010—$6.6 million, 2011—$3.7 million and after 2011—$8.8 million. Leases included in the minimum rental commitments for 2007 and 2008 primarily relate to lease agreements for automobiles which generally have a lease term of 2-3 years. It is common for lease agreements to contain various provisions for items such as step rent or other escalation clauses and lease concessions which may offer a period of no rent payment. These types of items are considered by the Company and are recorded into expense on a straight line basis over the minimum lease terms. The Company has a lease agreement on a warehouse located in Europe which offers a purchase option of about $3.5 million, which is expected to approximate fair market value, at the end of the lease term in 2010. There were no material lease agreements containing renewal options. Certain leases require the Company to pay property taxes, insurance and routine maintenance. In 2006, the Company initiated construction of a new Tupperware manufacturing facility which will replace its existing facility in Belgium. The total cost of the new facility and equipment is estimated at approximately $21 million and is being financed via sales-lease-back transactions. The two new leases will be classified as a capital leases with terms of 15 years for the facility and 10 years for the equipment and should commence in the second half of 2007. Additionally in 2006, the Company’s BeautiControl subsidiary entered into an operating lease for a new manufacturing facility in Texas. The total future commitment under the new lease is approximately $10 million over the next 10 years. 77 Table of Contents Note 15: Quarterly Financial Summary (Unaudited) Following is a summary of the unaudited interim results of operations for each quarter in the years ended December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005. (In millions, except per share amounts) Year ended December 31, 2006: Net sales (a) Gross margin (a) Net income (a),(c) Basic earnings per share: (a),(c) Diluted earning per share: (a),(c) Dividends declared per share Composite stock price range: High Low Close Year ended December 31, 2005: Net sales (a) Gross margin (a) Income before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change Net income (a),(b),(c) Basic earnings per share: (a),(b),(c) Before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change After accounting change Diluted earning per share: (a),(b),(c) Before accounting change Cumulative effect of accounting change After accounting change Dividends declared per share Composite stock price range: High Low Close First quarter Second quarter Third quarter Fourth quarter $ 423.7 275.5 16.0 $ 438.6 286.2 25.2 $ 394.9 254.9 13.1 0.27 0.26 0.41 0.41 0.22 0.22 $ 486.5 312.1 39.9 0.67 0.65 0.22 0.22 0.22 0.22 23.60 20.00 20.59 22.89 19.01 19.69 20.17 17.06 19.46 22.63 19.30 22.61 $ 326.4 211.9 23.9 — 23.9 $ 320.4 210.7 27.7 — 27.7 $ 270.7 170.2 2.6 — 2.6 $ 361.8 230.3 32.0 (0.8 ) 31.2 0.41 — 0.41 0.46 — 0.46 0.04 — 0.04 0.55 (0.01 ) 0.54 0.40 — 0.40 0.46 — 0.46 0.04 — 0.04 0.51 (0.01 ) 0.50 0.22 0.22 0.22 0.22 21.42 19.46 20.08 23.90 19.49 23.39 24.68 19.85 22.78 24.00 20.58 22.40 a. b. c. Includes the results of operations of the Acquired Units after December 5, 2005. Includes a net benefit of approximately $25 million for the settlement of a pre June 1996 income tax settlement with the Company’s former parent company. Includes pretax re-engineering and impairment costs of $2.1 million ($1.6 million after-tax), $0.6 million ($0.5 million after-tax), $2.1 million ($1.6 million after-tax) and $2.8 million ($2.1 million after-tax) in the first through fourth quarters of 2006, respectively, and $6.4 million ($4.1 million after-tax), $1.2 million ($0.8 million after-tax), and $0.6 million ($0.4 million after-tax) in the second, third and fourth quarters, respectively of 2005. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. 78 Table of Contents REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED CERTIFIED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Tupperware Brands Corporation: We have completed an integrated audit of Tupperware Brands Corporation’s consolidated financial statements and of its internal control over financial reporting as of December 30, 2006 in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Our opinions, based on our audits, are presented below. Consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of income, of shareholders’ equity and comprehensive income and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Tupperware Brands Corporation and its subsidiaries at December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 30, 2006 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. In addition, in our opinion, the financial statement schedule listed in the index appearing under Item 15(a) (2) presents fairly in all material respects, the information set forth therein and when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements. These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit of financial statements includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. As discussed in Note 11 to the financial statements, the Company changed the manner in which it accounts for retirement obligations in fiscal 2006. Internal control over financial reporting Also, in our opinion, management’s assessment, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting appearing in Item 9A, that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 30, 2006 based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), is fairly stated, in all material respects, based on those criteria. Furthermore, in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 30, 2006, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the COSO. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on management’s assessment and on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. An audit of internal control over financial reporting includes obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, evaluating management’s assessment, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control, and performing such other procedures as we consider necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinions. A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in 79 Table of Contents accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP Orlando, Florida February 26, 2007 80 Table of Contents Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure None. Item 9A. Controls and Procedures Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures The Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15(d)-15(e) ) that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the Company’s reports filed or submitted under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. In designing and evaluating the disclosure controls and procedures, management recognized that controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving the desired control objectives. As of the end of the period covered by this report, management, under the supervision of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures. Based upon that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the design and operation of the disclosure controls and procedures were effective. Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting The Company’s management is also responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f). As of the end of the period covered by this report, management, under the supervision of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on the framework in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organization of the Treadway Commission. Based upon that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report. The Company’s assessment of the internal control over financial reporting as of December 30, 2006, has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report which is included herein. Changes in Internal Controls There have been no significant changes; except as noted below, in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the Company’s fourth quarter that have materially affected or are reasonably likely to materially affect its internal control over financial reporting as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. During October 2006, the Company implemented an upgrade to its accounting system for the Tupperware United States and Canada units. The implementation involved changes in systems that included internal controls, and accordingly, these changes have required changes to our system of internal controls. The Company has reviewed the controls affected by the implementation of the upgrade and made appropriate changes to affected internal controls. The Company believes that the controls as modified are appropriate and functioning effectively to provide reasonable assurance on its internal controls over financial reporting. Item 9B. Other Information None 81 Table of Contents Item 10. Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant PART III The information as to the Directors of the Registrant set forth under the sub-caption “Board of Directors” appearing under the caption “Election of Directors” in the Proxy Statement relating to the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 16, 2007, as well as the information under the caption “Corporate Governance” in such proxy statement, and the information set forth under the caption “Section 16(A) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in such proxy statement, is incorporated by reference into this Report. The information as to the Executive Officers of the Registrant is included in Part I hereof under the caption “Executive Officers of the Registrant” in reliance upon General Instruction G to Form 10-K and Instruction 3 to Item 401(b) of Regulation S-K. Item 11. Executive Compensation The information set forth under the caption “Compensation of Directors” of the Proxy Statement relating to the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 16, 2007, and the information in such Proxy Statement relating to executive officers’ compensation is incorporated by reference into this Report. Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters The information set forth under the captions “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners”, “Security Ownership of Management” and “Equity Compensation Plan Information” in the Proxy Statement relating to the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 16, 2007, is incorporated by reference into this Report. Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions The information set forth under the captions “Indebtedness of Management” and “Transactions with Related Persons” in the Proxy Statement relating to the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 16, 2007, is incorporated by reference into this Report. Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services The information set fourth under the captions “Audit Fees,” “Audit-Related Fees,” “Tax Fees,” “All Other Fees,” and “Approval of Audit Services” in the Proxy Statement related to the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 16, 2007, is incorporated by reference into this report. Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules (a) (1) List of Financial Statements PART IV The following Consolidated Financial Statements of Tupperware Brands Corporation and Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm are included in this Report under Item 8: Consolidated Statements of Income, Shareholders’ Equity and Comprehensive Income and Cash Flows—Years ended December 30, 2006, December 31, 2005 and December 25, 2004; Consolidated Balance Sheets—December 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005; Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements; and Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm. 82 Table of Contents (a) (2) List of Financial Statement Schedules The following consolidated financial statement schedules (numbered in accordance with Regulation S-X) of Tupperware Brands Corporation are included in this Report: Schedule II—Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for each of the three years ended December 30, 2006. All other schedules for which provision is made in the applicable accounting regulations of the SEC are not required under the related instructions, are inapplicable or the information called for therein is included elsewhere in the financial statements or related notes contained or incorporated by reference herein. (a) (3) List of Exhibits: (numbered in accordance with Item 601 of Regulation S-K) Exhibit Number *3.1 *3.2 10.1 10.2 10.3 *10.4 *10.6 10.7 *10.8 *10.9 *10.10 Description Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant (Attached as Exhibit 3.01 to Form 8-K, filed with the Commission on February 13, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference). Amended and Restated By-laws of the Registrant as amended December 5, 2005 (Attached as Exhibit 3.2 to Form 10-K, filed with the SEC on March 16, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference). 1996 Incentive Plan as amended through December 14, 2006. Directors’ Stock Plan as amended through November 2, 2006. Form of Change of Control Employment Agreement. Credit Agreement dated December 5, 2005, (Attached as Exhibit 10.01 to Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference). Securities and Asset Purchase Agreement between the Registrant and Sara Lee Corporation dated as of August 10, 2005 (Attached as Exhibit 10.01 to Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on August 15, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference). Forms of stock option and restricted stock agreements utilized with the Registrant’s officers and directors under certain stock- based incentive plans. Management Stock Purchase Plan (Attached to Form S-8 (No. 333-48650) as Exhibit 4.3 filed with the SEC on October 26, 2000, and incorporated SEC on October 26, 2000 and incorporated herein by reference). Form of Promissory Note between a subsidiary of the Registrant and various executives (Attached as Exhibit 10.11 to Form 10- K filed with the SEC on March 20, 2001, and incorporated herein by reference). Form of Stock Pledge Agreement between a subsidiary of the Registrant and various executives (Attached as Exhibit 10.12 to Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 20, 2001, and incorporated herein by reference). 10.11 2000 Incentive Plan as amended through December 28, 2005. *10.12 *10.13 Chief Executive Officer Severance Agreement between the Registrant and E.V. Goings dated June 1, 2003. (Attached as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 12, 2003, and incorporated herein by reference). Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan dated June 1, 2003 (Attached as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 12, 2003, and incorporated herein by reference). 10.14 2002 Incentive Plan, as amended through December 14, 2006. 83 Table of Contents Exhibit Number *10.15 Description Amendment Number One to the Tupperware Brands Corporation Supplemental Plan, effective as of July 1, 2005 (Attached as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on August 29, 2005) 10.16 2006 Incentive Plan as amended through December 14, 2006. 21 23 24 31.1 31.2 32.1 32.2 Subsidiaries of Tupperware Brands Corporation as of February 26, 2007. Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm. Powers of Attorney. Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of the Chief Executive Officer. Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of the Chief Financial Officer. Certification Pursuant to Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code by the Chief Executive Officer. Certification Pursuant to Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code by the Chief Financial Officer. * Document has heretofore been filed with the SEC and is incorporated by reference and made a part hereof. The Registrant agrees to furnish, upon request of the SEC, a copy of all constituent instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of the Registrant and its consolidated subsidiaries. 84 Table of Contents TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION SCHEDULE II—VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS FOR THE THREE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 30, 2006 (In millions) Col. A Allowance for doubtful accounts, current and long term: Year ended December 30, 2006 Col. B. Balance at Beginning of Period Col. C. Additions Charged to Other Accounts Charged to Costs and Expenses Col. D. Deductions $ 37.0 $ 8.3 Col. E Balance at End of Period $ 42.4 $ 37.0 $ $ $ — — — $ $ (5.5) / F1 2.6 / F2 (9.3) / F1 (1.5)/ F2 (19.1) / F1 $ Year ended December 31, 2005 $ 42.4 $ 5.4 Year ended December 25, 2004 $ 53.6 $ 5.5 Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets: Year ended December 30, 2006 $ 39.8 $ 8.0 $ — Year ended December 31, 2005 $ 23.1 $ (5.1) $ 26.3 / F4 Year ended December 25, 2004 $ 32.4 $ (1.8) $ — Allowance for Inventory Obsolescence: Year ended December 30, 2006 $ 22.7 $ 6.9 Year ended December 31, 2005 $ 26.3 $ 2.9 Year ended December 25, 2004 $ 20.9 $ 9.9 $ $ $ — — — F1 Represents write-offs less recoveries. F2 Foreign currency translation adjustment. F3 Represents write-offs less inventory sold. F4 Represents allowance established with respect to gross deferred assets recognized with the Acquisition. 85 2.4 / F2 $ 42.4 $ $ $ $ $ $ (2.0) /F1 1.2 /F2 (3.0) /F1 (1.5) / F2 (8.1) /F1 0.6 /F2 1.1 /F2 (10.9) /F3 (1.0) /F2 (5.5) /F3 1.0 /F2 (5.5) /F3 $ 47.0 $ 39.8 $ 23.1 $ 19.8 $ 22.7 $ 26.3 Table of Contents SIGNATURES Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION (Registrant) By: / S / E.V. G OINGS E.V. Goings Chairman and Chief Executive Officer February 28, 2007 Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the date indicated. Signature / S / E.V. G OINGS E.V. Goings / S / M ICHAEL S. P OTESHMAN Michael S. Poteshman / S / T IMOTHY A. K ULHANEK Timothy A. Kulhanek Title Chairman and Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer) Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer) Vice President and Controler (Principal Accounting Officer) * Catherine A. Bertini * Rita Bornstein, Ph.D. * Kriss Cloninger III * Clifford J. Grum * Joe R. Lee * Bob Marbut * Angel R. Martinez * Robert J. Murray * David R. Parker * Joyce M. Roché Director Director Director Director Director Director Director Director Director Director 86 Table of Contents Signature * J. Patrick Spainhour * M. Anne Szostak By / S / T HOMAS M. R OEHLK Thomas M. Roehlk Attorney-in-fact February 28, 2007 Title Director Director 87 Exhibit 10.1 TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION 1996 INCENTIVE PLAN (As amended August 18, 1999, August 10, 2000, December 28, 2005 and November 2, 2006) Article 1. Establishment, Purpose, and Duration 1.1 Establishment of the Plan . Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation (hereinafter referred to as the “Company”), hereby establishes an incentive compensation plan to be known as the “Tupperware Brands Corporation 1996 Incentive Plan” (hereinafter referred to as the “Plan”), as set forth in this document. The Plan permits the grant of Nonqualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, Stock Appreciation Rights, Restricted Stock, and Performance Awards. The Plan shall become effective as of the Effective Date, and shall remain in effect as provided in Section 1.3 herein. 1.2 Purpose of the Plan . The purpose of the Plan is to promote the success and enhance the value of the Company by linking the personal interests of Participants to those of the Company’s stockholders, and by providing Participants with an incentive for outstanding performance. The Plan is further intended to provide flexibility to the Company in its ability to motivate, attract, and retain the services of Participants upon whose judgment, interest, and special efforts the successful conduct of its operations largely is dependent. 1.3 Duration of the Plan . The Plan shall commence on the Effective Date and shall remain in effect, subject to the right of the Board of Directors to terminate, amend or modify the Plan at any time pursuant to Article 14 herein, until all Shares subject to it shall have been purchased or acquired according to the Plan’s provisions. However, in no event may an Award be granted under the Plan on or after May 1, 2006. Article 2. Definitions Whenever used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below and, when the meaning is intended, the initial letter of the word is capitalized: (a) “Award” means, individually or collectively, a grant under this Plan of Nonqualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock, or Performance Awards. (b) “Award Agreement” means an agreement entered into by each Participant and the Company, setting forth the terms and provisions applicable to Awards granted to Participants under this Plan. (c) “Beneficial Owner” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Rule 13d-3 of the General Rules and Regulations under the Exchange Act. (d) “Beneficiary” means a person who may be designated by a Participant pursuant to Article 10 and to whom any benefit under the Plan is to be paid in case of the Participant’s death or physical or mental incapacity, as determined by the Committee, before he or she receives any or all of such benefit. (e) “Board” or “Board of Directors” means the Board of Directors of the Company. (f) “Cause” means (i) conviction of a Participant for committing a felony under federal law or the law of the state in which such action occurred, (ii) dishonesty in the course of fulfilling a Participant’s employment duties or (iii) willful and deliberate failure on the part of a Participant to perform his employment duties in any material respect, or such other events as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee shall have the sole discretion to determine whether “Cause” exists, and its determination shall be final. (g) “Change of Control” of the Company means: i. An acquisition by any Person of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 20% or more of either (1) the then outstanding Shares (the “Outstanding Company Common Stock”) or (2) the combined voting power of the then outstanding Shares entitled to vote generally in the election of directors (the “Outstanding Company Voting Securities”); excluding, however, the following: (1) any acquisition directly from the Company, other than an acquisition by virtue of the exercise of a conversion privilege unless the security being so converted was itself acquired from the Company, (2) any acquisition by the Company, (3) any acquisition by any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or (4) any acquisition by any Person pursuant to a transaction which complies with clauses (1), (2) and (3) of subsection (iii) of this definition; or -1- ii. A change in the composition of the Board such that the individuals who, as of the effective date of the Plan, constitute the Board (such Board shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Incumbent Board”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board; provided, however, for purposes of this definition, that any individual who becomes a member of the Board subsequent to such effective date, whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of those individuals who are members of the Board and who were also members of the Incumbent Board (or deemed to be such pursuant to this proviso) shall be considered as though such individual were a member of the Incumbent Board; but, provided further, that any such individual whose initial assumption of office occurs as a result of either an actual or threatened election contest (as such terms are used in Rule 14a-11 of Regulation 14A promulgated under the Exchange Act) or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a person or legal entity other than the Board shall not be so considered as a member of the Incumbent Board; or iii. The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a reorganization, merger or consolidation or sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company or the acquisition of assets of another corporation (“Corporate Transaction”) or, if consummation of such Corporate Transaction is subject, at the time of such approval by stockholders, to the consent of any government or governmental agency, the obtaining of such consent (either explicitly or implicitly by consummation); excluding, however, such a Corporate Transaction pursuant to which (1) all or substantially all of the individuals and entities who are the Beneficial Owners, respectively, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction will beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than 60% of, respectively, the outstanding Shares, and the combined voting power of the then outstanding Shares entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, as the case may be, of the Company resulting from such Corporate Transaction (including, without limitation, a corporation which as a result of such transaction owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) in substantially the same proportions as their ownership, immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities, as the case may be, (2) no Person (other than the Company, any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or such corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction) will beneficially own, directly or indirectly, 20% or more of, respectively, the outstanding shares of common stock of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction or the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of such corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of directors except to the extent that such ownership existed with respect to the Company prior to the Corporate Transaction and (3) individuals who were members of the Incumbent Board will constitute at least a majority of the board of directors of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction; or iv. The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company. (h) “Change of Control Price” means the higher of (i) the highest reported sales price, regular way, of a share of Common Stock in any transaction reported on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or other national exchange on which such shares are listed or on NASDAQ during the 60-day period prior to and including the date of a Change of Control or (ii) if the Change of Control is the result of a tender or exchange offer or a Corporate Transaction, the highest price per -2- share of Common Stock paid in such tender or exchange offer or Corporate Transaction; provided, however, that (x) in the case of a Stock Option which (A) is held by an optionee who is an officer or director of the Corporation and is subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act and (B) was granted within 240 days of the Change of Control, then the Change of Control Price for such Stock Option shall be the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock on the date such Stock Option is exercised or deemed exercised and (y) in the case of Incentive Stock Options and Stock Appreciation Rights relating to Incentive Stock Options, the Change of Control Price shall be in all cases the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock on the date such Incentive Stock Option or Stock Appreciation Right is exercised. To the extent that the consideration paid in any such transaction described above consists all or in part of securities or other noncash consideration, the value of such securities or other noncash consideration shall be determined in the sole discretion of the Board. (i) “Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time. (j) “Commission” means the Securities and Exchange Commission or any successor agency. (k) “Committee” means the committee described in Article 3 or (unless otherwise stated) its designee pursuant to a delegation by the Committee as contemplated by Section 3.3. (l) “Company” means Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation, or any successor thereto as provided in Article 16 herein. (m) “Covered Employee” has the meaning ascribed thereto in Section 162(m) of the Code and the regulations thereunder. (n) “Director” means any individual who is a member of the Board of Directors of the Company. (o) “Disinterested Person” means a member of the Board who qualifies as a disinterested person as defined in Rule 16b-3(c)(2), as promulgated by the Commission under the Exchange Act, or any successor definition adopted by the Commission. (p) “Effective Date” means May 20, 1996. (q) “Employee” means any nonunion employee of the Company or of the Company’s Subsidiaries. Directors who are not otherwise employed by the Company shall not be considered Employees under this Plan. (r) “Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time, or any successor Act thereto. (s) “Fair Market Value” means, except as expressly provided otherwise, as of any given date, the closing sales price of the Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or, if not listed on such exchange, on any other national securities exchange on which the Common Stock is listed or on NASDAQ. If there is no regular public trading market for such Common Stock, the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock shall be determined by the Committee in good faith. (t) “Freestanding SAR” means a SAR that is granted independently of any Options pursuant to Section 7.1 herein. (u) “Incentive Stock Option” or “ISO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is designated as an Incentive Stock Option and is intended to meet the requirements of Section 422 of the Code. (v) “Insider” shall mean an Employee who is, on the relevant date, an officer, director, or ten percent (10%) beneficial owner of the Company, as defined under Section 16 of the Exchange Act. -3- (w) “Nonqualified Stock Option” or “NQSO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is not intended to be an Incentive Stock Option. (x) “Option” means an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-qualified Stock Option. (y) “Option Price” means the price at which a Share may be purchased by a Participant pursuant to an Option, as determined by the Committee. (z) “Participant” means an Employee of the Company who has been granted an Award under the Plan. (aa) “Performance Award” means an Award granted to an Employee, as described in Article 9 herein, including Performance Units and Performance Shares. (ab) “Performance Goals” means the performance goals established by the Committee prior to the grant of Performance Awards that are based on the attainment of one or any combination of the following: specified levels of earnings per share from continuing operations, operating income, revenues, return on operating assets, return on equity, stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation) and/or total stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation and/or dividend growth), achievement of cost control, working capital turns, cash flow, net income, economic value added, segment profit, sales force growth, or stock price of the Company or such subsidiary, division or department of the Company for or within which the Participant is primarily employed and that are intended to qualify under Section 162(m) (4) (c) of the Code. Such Performance Goals also may be based upon the attaining of specified levels of Company performance under one or more of the measures described above relative to the performance of other corporations. Such Performance Goals shall be set by the Committee within the time period prescribed by Section 162(m) of the Code and related regulations. (ac) “Performance Period” means a time period during which Performance Goals established in connection with Performance Awards must be met. (ad) “Performance Unit” means an Award granted to an Employee, as described in Article 9 herein. (ae) “Performance Share” means an Award granted to an Employee, as described in Article 9 herein. (af) “Restriction Period” or “Period” means the period or periods during which the transfer of Shares of Restricted Stock is limited based on the passage of time and the continuation of service with the Company, and the Shares are subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture, as provided in Article 8 herein. (ag) “Person” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 3(a) (9) of the Exchange Act and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof, including a “group” as defined in Section 13(d). (ah) “Restricted Stock” means an Award granted to a Participant pursuant to Article 8 herein. (ai) “Share” means a share of common stock of the Company. (aj) “Subsidiary” or “Subsidiaries” means any corporation or corporations in which the Company owns directly, or indirectly through subsidiaries, at least fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock, or any other entity (including, but not limited to, partnerships and joint ventures) in which the Company owns at least fifty percent (50%) of the combined equity thereof. (ak) “Stock Appreciation Right” or “SAR” means an Award, granted alone (Freestanding SAR) or in connection with a related Option (Tandem SAR), designated as a SAR, pursuant to the terms of Article 7 herein. (al) “Tandem SAR” means an SAR that is granted in connection with a related Option pursuant to Section 7.1 herein, the exercise of which shall require forfeiture of the right to purchase a Share under the related Option (and when a Share is purchased under the Option, the Tandem SAR shall similarly be cancelled). -4- Article 3. Administration 3.1 The Committee. The Plan shall be administered by the Compensation and Directors Committee or such other committee of the Board as the Board may from time to time designate (the “Committee”), which shall be composed of not less than two Disinterested Persons each of whom shall be an “outside director” for purposes of Section 162(m)(4) of the Code, and shall be appointed by and serve at the pleasure of the Board. 3.2 Authority of the Committee. The Committee shall have plenary authority to grant Awards pursuant to the terms of the Plan to officers and employees of the Company and its subsidiaries and Affiliates. Among other things, the Committee shall have the authority, subject to the terms of the Plan: (a) To select the officers and employees to whom Awards may from time to time be granted; (b) To determine whether and to what extent Incentive Stock Options, NonQualified Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock and Performance Awards or any combination thereof are to be granted hereunder; (c) To determine the number of Shares to be covered by each Award granted hereunder; (d) To determine the terms and conditions of any Award granted hereunder (including, but not limited to, the option price (subject to Section 6.4 (a)), any vesting condition, restriction or limitation (which may be related to the performance of the Participant, the Company or any subsidiary or Affiliate) and any vesting acceleration or forfeiture waiver regarding any Award and the Shares relating thereto, based on such factors as the Committee shall determine; (e) To modify, amend or adjust the terms and conditions of any Award, at any time or from time to time, including but not limited to Performance Goals, unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments; and (f) To determine to what extent and under what circumstances Shares and other amounts payable with respect to an Award shall be deferred. The Committee shall have the authority to adopt, alter and repeal such administrative rules, guidelines and practices governing the Plan as it shall from time to time deem advisable, to interpret the terms and provisions of the Plan and any Award issued under the Plan (and any agreement relating thereto) and to otherwise supervise the administration of the Plan. 3.3 Action of the Committee. The Committee may act only by a majority of its members then in office, except that the members thereof may (i) delegate to an officer of the Company the authority to make decisions pursuant to Section 6.4, provided that no such delegation may be made that would cause Awards or other transactions under the Plan to cease either to be exempt from Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act or to qualify as “qualified performance-based compensation” as such term is defined in the regulations promulgated under Section 162(m) of the Code, and (ii) authorize any one or more of their number or any officer of the Company to execute and deliver documents on behalf of the Committee. 3.4 Decisions Binding. Any determination made by the Committee or pursuant to delegated authority pursuant to the provisions of the Plan with respect to any Award shall be made in the sole discretion of the Committee or such delegate at the time of the grant of the Award or, unless in contravention of any express term of the Plan, at any time thereafter. All decisions made by the Committee or any appropriately delegated officer pursuant to the provisions of the Plan shall be final and binding on all persons, including the Company and Plan Participants. Article 4. Shares Subject to the Plan 4.1 Number of Shares. Subject to adjustment as provided in Section 4.3 herein, the total number of Shares available for grant under the Plan shall be six million one hundred thousand (6,100,000); provided, however, that if during the term of the Plan the Company -5- repurchases Shares, additional Options may be granted equal to the number of Shares so repurchased, except that no more than one million five hundred thousand (1,500,000) additional Shares shall be authorized for Options under this proviso; and provided further that the total number of available Shares that may be used for Restricted Stock Awards under the Plan shall be limited to three hundred thousand (300,000). No Participant may be granted Awards covering in excess of 10% of the Shares available for issuance over the life of the Plan. Shares subject to an Award under the Plan may be authorized and unissued shares or may be treasury shares. The following rules will apply for purposes of the determination of the number of Shares available for grant under the Plan: (a) While an Award is outstanding, it shall be counted against the authorized pool of Shares, regardless of its vested status. (b) The grant of an Option or Restricted Stock shall reduce the Shares available for grant under the Plan by the number of Shares subject to such Award. (c) The grant of a Tandem SAR shall not reduce the number of Shares available for grant by the number of Shares subject to the related Option (i.e., there is no double counting of Options and their related Tandem SARs). (d) The grant of a Freestanding SAR shall reduce the number of Shares available for grant by the number of Freestanding SARs granted. (e) The Committee shall reduce the appropriate number of Shares from the authorized pool where a Performance Award is payable in Shares. 4.2 Lapsed Awards. If any Award granted under this Plan is cancelled, forfeited, terminates, expires, or lapses for any reason (with the exception of the termination of a Tandem SAR upon exercise of the related Option or the termination of a related Option upon exercise of the corresponding Tandem SAR), any Shares subject to such Award again shall be available for the grant of an Award under the Plan. However, in the event that prior to the Award’s cancellation, forfeiture, termination, expiration, or lapse, the holder of the Award at any time received one or more “benefits of ownership” pursuant to such Award (as defined by the Commission, pursuant to any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 or any successor rule of the Exchange Act), the Shares subject to such Award shall not be made available for regrant under the Plan to Insiders, but shall be available for regrants under the Plan to Participants who are not Insiders. 4.3 Adjustments in Authorized Shares and Prices. In the event of any change in corporate capitalization, such as a stock split or a corporate transaction, such as any merger, consolidation, separation, including a spin-off, or other distribution of stock or property of the Company, any reorganization (whether or not such reorganization comes within the definition of such term in Section 368 of the Code) or any partial or complete liquidation of the Company, the Committee or Board may make such substitution or adjustments in the aggregate number and class of shares reserved for issuance under the Plan, in the number, kind and option price of shares subject to outstanding Stock Options or SARs, in the number and kind of shares subject to other outstanding Awards granted under the Plan and/or such other equitable substitution or adjustments as it may determine to be appropriate in its sole discretion; provided, however, that the number of shares subject to any Award shall always be a whole number; and provided further, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of a change in capitalization that is the result of an equity restructuring which is not the consequence of a corporate transaction with a third-party, such substitutions or adjustments shall be required to be made. Such adjusted option price shall also be used to determine the amount payable by the Company upon the exercise of any Tandem SAR. -6- Article 5. Eligibility and Participation 5.1 Eligibility. Persons eligible to be granted Awards under this Plan include all Employees of the Company and its Subsidiaries, as determined by the Committee, including Employees who are members of the Board, but excluding Directors who are not Employees. 5.2 Actual Participation. Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Committee may, from time to time, select from all eligible Employees, those to whom Awards shall be granted and shall determine the nature and amount of each Award. Article 6. Stock Options 6.1 Grant of Options. Stock Options may be granted alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan and may be of two types: Incentive Stock Options and Nonqualified Stock Options. Any Stock Option granted under the Plan shall be in such form as the Committee may from time to time approve. The Committee shall have the authority to grant any optionee Incentive Stock Options, Nonqualified Stock Options or both types of Stock Options (in each case with or without Stock Appreciation Rights); provided, however, that grants hereunder are subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4. Incentive Stock Options may be granted only to employees of the Company and any “subsidiary corporation” (as such term is defined in Section 424(f) of the Code). To the extent that any Stock Option is not designated as an Incentive Stock Option or even if so designated does not qualify as an Incentive Stock Option, it shall constitute a Nonqualified Stock Option. 6.2 Award Agreement. Stock Options shall be evidenced by option agreements, the terms and provisions of which may differ. An option agreement shall indicate on its face whether it is intended to be an agreement for an Incentive Stock Option or a Nonqualified Stock Option. The grant of a Stock Option shall occur on the date the Committee by resolution selects an individual to be a Participant in any grant of a Stock Option, determines the number of Shares to be subject to such Stock Option to be granted to such individual and specifies the terms and provisions of the Stock Option, or such later date as the Committee designates. The Company shall notify a Participant of any grant of a Stock Option, and a written option agreement or agreements shall be duly executed and delivered by the Company to the Participant. Such agreement or agreements shall become effective upon execution by the Company and the Participant. 6.3 Incentive Stock Options. Anything in the Plan to the contrary notwithstanding, no term of the Plan relating to Incentive Stock Options shall be interpreted, amended or altered nor shall any discretion or authority granted under the Plan be exercised so as to disqualify the Plan under Section 422 of the Code or, without the consent of the optionee affected, to disqualify any Incentive Stock Option under such Section 422. 6.4 Terms and Conditions. Stock Options granted under the Plan shall be subject to the following terms and conditions and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (a) Option Price. The option price per Share purchasable under a Stock Option shall be determined by the Committee and set forth in the option agreement, and shall not be less than the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Stock Option on the date of grant. Options may not be repriced without shareholder approval. (b) Option Term. The term of each Stock Option shall be fixed by the Committee, but no Incentive Stock Option shall be exercisable more than 10 years after the date the Stock Option is granted. (c) Exercisability. Except as otherwise provided herein, Stock Options shall be exercisable at such time or times and subject to such terms and conditions as shall be determined by the Committee. If the Committee provides that any Stock Option is exercisable only in installments, the Committee may at any time waive such installment exercise provisions, in whole or in part, based on such factors as the Committee may determine. In addition, the Committee may at any time accelerate the exercisability of any Stock Option. (d) Method of Exercise. Subject to the provisions of this Article 6, Stock Options may be exercised, in whole or in part, at any time during the option term by giving written notice of exercise to the Company specifying the number of Shares subject to the Stock Option to be purchased. Such notice shall be accompanied by payment in full of the purchase price by certified or bank check or such other instrument as the Company may accept. If approved by the Committee, payment, in full or in part, may also be made in the form of delivery of -7- unrestricted Shares already owned by the optionee of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option (based on the Fair Market Value of the shares on the date the Stock Option is exercised), or by certifying ownership of such Shares by the Participant to the satisfaction of the Company for later delivery to the Company as specified by the Committee; provided, however, that, in the case of an Incentive Stock Option the right to make a payment in the form of already owned Shares of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option may be authorized only at the time the Stock Option is granted. In the discretion of the Committee, payment for any Shares subject to a Stock Option may also be made pursuant to a “cashless exercise” by delivering a properly executed exercise notice to the Company, together with a copy of irrevocable instructions to a broker to deliver promptly to the Company the amount of sale or loan proceeds to pay the purchase price, and, if requested, the amount of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding taxes. To facilitate the foregoing, the Company may enter into agreements for coordinated procedures with one or more brokerage firms. No shares shall be issued until full payment therefor has been made. An optionee shall have all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is subject to such Stock Option (including, if applicable, the right to vote the shares and the right to receive dividends), when the optionee has given written notice of exercise and has paid in full for such Shares. (e) Restrictions on Share Transferability. The Committee may impose such restrictions on any Shares acquired pursuant to the exercise of an Option under the Plan as it may deem advisable, including, without limitation, restrictions under applicable Federal securities laws, under the requirements of any stock exchange or market upon which such Shares are then listed and/or traded, and under any blue sky or state securities laws applicable to such Shares. (f) Nontransferability of Stock Options. No Stock Option shall be transferable by the optionee other than (i) by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution; or (ii) in the case of a Nonqualified Stock Option, pursuant to (a) a domestic relations order issued by a tribunal of competent jurisdiction or (b) a gift to members of such optionee’s immediate family, whether directly or indirectly or by means of a trust or partnership or otherwise, if expressly permitted under the applicable option agreement. All Stock Options shall be exercisable, subject to the terms of this Plan, during the optionee’s lifetime, only by the optionee or by the guardian or legal representative of the optionee or, in the case of a Nonqualified Stock Option, its alternative payee pursuant to such domestic relations order, it being understood that the term “holder” and “optionee” include the guardian and legal representative of the optionee named in the option agreement and any person to whom an option is transferred by will or the laws of descent and distribution or, in the case of a Nonqualified Stock Option, pursuant to a domestic relations order or a gift permitted under the applicable option agreement. (g) Death. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee’s employment terminates by reason of death, any Stock Option held by such optionee shall become immediately and fully exercisable and (unless another period is specified by the Committee in the option agreement) may thereafter be exercised by the estate of the optionee for a period of three years from the date of such death; provided, however, that if the optionee is at least sixty years of age at the time of death and has fifteen years service with the Company, such Stock Option may thereafter be exercised by the estate of the optionee for a period of six years from the date of such death. In no event, however, may a Stock Option be exercisable beyond the stated expiration date of such Stock Option. Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee dies after termination of the optionee’s employment, any Stock Option held by such optionee may thereafter be exercised, to the extent such Stock Option was exercisable as of the date of such death, for a period that expires on the earliest of (i) the first anniversary of the date of such death, (ii) the last date on which the optionee would have been entitled to exercise such Stock Option had the optionee not died or (iii) the date on which the stated term of such Stock Option expires; provided, however, that if such optionee had retired from the Company prior to the date of death, the estate of the optionee shall continue to have the benefit of the vesting and exercisability benefits specified by Section 6.4(i). (h) Termination by Reason of Disability. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee’s employment terminates by reason of Disability, any Stock Option held by such optionee, if not fully vested and exercisable as of the date of such termination, shall continue to vest according to such Stock Option’s stated vesting schedule and may thereafter be exercised by the optionee, to the extent it was exercisable at the time of termination or thereafter becomes exercisable, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee -8- may determine, for a period of three years (or such shorter period as the Committee may specify in the option agreement) from the date of such termination of employment or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shorter; provided, however, that if the optionee dies within such period, any unexercised Stock Option held by such optionee shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shortest. In the event of termination of employment by reason of Disability, if an Incentive Stock Option is exercised after the expiration of the exercise periods that apply for purposes of Section 422 of the Code, such Stock Option will thereafter be treated as a Nonqualified Stock Option. (i) Termination by Reason of Retirement. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee’s employment terminates by reason of retirement, the following vesting and exercisability terms will apply. For purposes of this Plan, an optionee shall be deemed to have terminated employment by reason of retirement if such optionee is age 55 years or older with 10 or more years of service with the Company, has given due notice (as determined by the Committee), and has entered into an agreement, the form and content of which shall be specified by the Committee, not to compete with the Company and its Affiliates for a period of one year following such retirement. Age at Retirement 55-59 60-64 65 or more Years of Continued Vesting Following Retirement 1 2 3 Years of Continued Exercisability Following Retirement 2 3 3 With respect to any grants of a Stock Option occurring after August 18, 1999, and notwithstanding any inconsistent provision contained in the first paragraph of this Section 6.4(i), the following vesting and exercisability terms shall apply. Any optionee who has attained the age of 60 years or older with 15 or more years of service with the company, and who meets the other conditions specified by the second sentence of the first paragraph of the Section 6.4(i), shall have 6 years of continued vesting and exercisability following retirement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the optionee dies within such period of continued exercisability, any unexercised Stock Option held by such optionee shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shortest. In the event of termination of employment by reason of retirement, if an Incentive Stock Option is exercised after the expiration of the exercise periods that apply for purposes of Section 422 of the Code, such Stock Option will thereafter be treated as a Nonqualified Stock Option. (j) Other Termination. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee: (A) if an optionee incurs a voluntary termination of Employment, any Stock Option held by such optionee, to the extent then exercisable, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, may be exercised for the lesser of thirty days from the date of such termination of Employment or the balance of such Stock Option’s term; and (B) if an optionee incurs a termination of Employment because such optionee’s Employment is terminated by the Company or an Affiliate, other than by reason of retirement or Disability or for Cause, any Stock Option held by such optionee, to the extent then exercisable, or becomes exercisable during the one-year period following termination of employment by the Company or an Affiliate, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, may be exercised for the lesser of one year from the date of such termination of Employment or the balance of such Stock Option’s term; provided, however, that if the optionee dies within such thirty-day or one-year period, as the case may be, any unexercised Stock Option held by such optionee shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shortest. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an optionee incurs a Termination of Employment at or after a Change of Control, other than by reason of death, Disability or Retirement, any Stock Option held by such optionee shall be exercisable for the lesser of (1) six months and one day from the date of such termination of Employment, and (2) the balance of such Stock Option’s term. In the event of termination of Employment, if an Incentive Stock Option is exercised after the expiration of the exercise periods that apply for purposes of Section 422 of the Code, such Stock Option will thereafter be treated as a Nonqualified Stock Option. -9- (k) Termination for Cause. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee incurs a Termination of Employment for Cause, all Stock Options held by such optionee shall thereupon terminate. Article 7. Stock Appreciation Rights 7.1 Grant of SARs. Subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan, a SAR may be granted to an Employee at any time and from time to time as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee may grant Freestanding SARs, Tandem SARs, or any combination of these forms of SAR. In the case of a Nonqualified Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted either at or after the time of grant of such Stock Option. In the case of an Incentive Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted only at the time of grant of such Stock Option. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number of SARs granted to each Participant (subject to Article 4 herein) and, consistent with the provisions of the Plan, in determining the terms and conditions pertaining to such SARs. However, the grant price of a Freestanding SAR shall be at least equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant of the SAR. The grant price of Tandem SARs shall equal the Option Price of the related Option. In no event shall any SAR granted hereunder become exercisable within the first six (6) months of its grant. SARs may not be repriced without stockholder approval. 7.2 Exercise of Tandem SARs. Tandem SARs may be exercised for all or part of the Shares subject to the related Option upon the surrender of the right to exercise the equivalent portion of the related Option. A Tandem SAR shall terminate and no longer be exercisable upon the termination or exercise of the related Stock Option. A Tandem SAR may be exercised only with respect to the Shares for which its related Option is then exercisable. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, with respect to a Tandem SAR granted in connection with an ISO; (i) the Tandem SAR will expire no later than the expiration of the underlying ISO; (ii) the value of the payout with respect to the Tandem SAR may be for no more than one hundred percent (100%) of the difference between the Option Price of the underlying ISO and the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the underlying ISO at the time the Tandem SAR is exercised; and (iii) the Tandem SAR may be exercised only when the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the ISO exceeds the Option Price of the ISO. 7.3 Exercise of Freestanding SARs. Subject to the other provisions of this Article 7, Freestanding SARs may be exercised upon whatever terms and conditions the Committee, at its sole discretion, imposes upon them. 7.4 SAR Agreement. Each SAR grant shall be evidenced by an Award Agreement that shall specify the grant price, the term of the SAR, and such other provisions as the Committee shall determine. 7.5 Term of SARs. The term of a SAR granted under the Plan shall be determined by the Committee, at its sole discretion; provided, however, that such term shall not exceed ten (10) years. 7.6 Payment of SAR Amount. Upon exercise of a SAR, a Participant shall be entitled to receive payment from the Company in an amount determined by multiplying: (a) The excess of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of exercise over the grant price of the SAR; by (b) The number of Shares with respect to which the SAR is exercised. At the discretion of the Committee, the payment upon SAR exercise may be in cash, in Shares of equivalent value, or in some combination thereof. 7.7 Rule 16b-3 Requirements. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, the Committee may impose such conditions on exercise of a SAR (including, without limitation, the right of the Committee to limit the time of exercise to specified periods) as may be required to satisfy the requirements of any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 (or any successor rule) of the Act. -10- 7.8 Nontransferability of SARs. No SAR granted under the Plan may be sold, transferred, pledged, assigned, or otherwise alienated or hypothecated, other than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution. Further, all SARs granted to a Participant under the Plan shall be exercisable during his or her lifetime only by such Participant. Notwithstanding the foregoing, at the discretion of the Committee, an Award Agreement may permit the transferability of a SAR by a Participant solely to members of the Participant’s immediate family or trusts for the benefit of such persons. Article 8. Restricted Stock 8.1 Administration. Shares of Restricted Stock may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall determine the officers and employees to whom and the time or times at which grants of Restricted Stock will be awarded, the number of shares to be awarded to any Participant (subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4), the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards, in addition to those contained in Section 8.3. The Committee may, prior to grant, condition the vesting of Restricted Stock upon continued service of the Participant. The provisions of Restricted Stock Awards need not be the same with respect to each recipient. 8.2 Awards and Certificates. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be evidenced in such manner as the Committee may deem appropriate, including book-entry registration or issuance of one or more stock certificates. Any certificate issued in respect of shares of Restricted Stock shall be registered in the name of such Participant and shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the terms, conditions, and restrictions applicable to such Award, substantially in the following form: “The sale or other transfer of the Shares of stock represented by this certificate, whether voluntary, involuntary, or by operation of law, is subject to certain restrictions on transfer as set forth in the Tupperware Corporation 1996 Incentive Plan, and in a Restricted Stock Agreement. A copy of the Plan and such Restricted Stock Agreement may be obtained from Tupperware Corporation.” The Committee may require that the certificates evidencing such Shares be held in custody by the Company until the restrictions thereon shall have lapsed and that, as a condition of any Award of Restricted Stock, the Participant shall have delivered a stock power, endorsed in blank, relating to the Common Stock covered by such Award. 8.3 Terms and Conditions. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be subject to the following terms and conditions: (a) Subject to the provisions of the Plan and the Restricted Stock Agreement referred to in Section 8.3(f), during the Restricted Period, the Participant shall not be permitted to sell, assign, transfer, pledge or otherwise encumber shares of Restricted Stock, except that, if expressly provided in the Restricted Stock Agreement, a Participant may, during the Restriction Period, transfer shares of Restricted Stock to members of the Participant’s immediate family or trusts or partnerships for the benefit of such persons. Within these limits, the Committee may provide for the lapse of restrictions based upon period of service in installments or otherwise and may accelerate or waive, in whole or in part, restrictions based upon period of service. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any Restricted Stock Award granted hereunder shall have a Restriction Period of not less than three years, except that an aggregate amount of Restricted Stock Awards not exceeding one-third of the Shares available for use as Restricted Stock Awards pursuant to Section 4.1 of the Plan may be issued without a minimum Restriction Period. (b) Except as provided in this paragraph (b) and paragraph (a), above, and the Restricted Stock Agreement, the Participant shall have, with respect to the shares of Restricted Stock, all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is the subject of the Restricted Stock, including, if applicable, the right to vote the shares and the right to receive any cash dividends. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee in the applicable Restricted Stock Agreement, dividends payable in Shares shall be paid in the form of Restricted Stock of the same class as the Shares with which such dividend was paid, held subject to the vesting of the underlying Restricted Stock. In the event that any dividend -11- constitutes a “derivative security” or an “equity security” pursuant to Rule 16(a) under the Act, such dividend shall be subject to a vesting period equal to the longer of: (i) the remaining vesting period of the Shares of Restricted Stock with respect to which the dividend is paid; or (ii) six months. The Committee shall establish procedures for the application of this provision. (c) Except to the extent otherwise provided in the applicable Restricted Stock Agreement and paragraphs (a) and (d) of this Section 8.3 and Section 13.1(b), upon a Participant’s Termination of Employment for any reason during the Restriction Period, all Shares still subject to restriction shall be forfeited by the Participant. (d) Except to the extent otherwise provided in Section 13.1(b), in the event that a Participant retires or such Participant’s employment is involuntarily terminated (other than for Cause), the Committee shall have the discretion to waive, in whole or in part, any or all remaining restrictions with respect to any or all of such Participant’s shares of Restricted Stock. (e) If and when any applicable Restriction Period expires without a prior forfeiture of the Restricted Stock, unlegended certificates for such shares shall be delivered to the Participant upon surrender of the legended certificates. (f) Each Award shall be confirmed by, and be subject to, the terms of a Restricted Stock Agreement. Article 9. Performance Awards 9.1 Grant of Performance Awards. Subject to the terms of the Plan, Performance Awards may be granted to eligible Employees at any time and from time to time, as shall be determined by the Committee, and may be granted either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number, amount and timing of Awards granted to each Participant. Such Performance Awards may take the form determined by the Committee, including without limitation, cash, Shares, Performance Units and Performance Shares, or any combination thereof. Performance Awards may be awarded as short-term or long-term incentives. 9.2 Performance Goals. (a) The Committee shall set Performance Goals at its discretion which, depending on the extent to which they are met, will determine the number and/or value of Performance Awards that will be paid out to the Participants, and may attach to such Performance Awards one or more restrictions, including, without limitation, a requirement that Participants pay a stipulated purchase price for each Performance Share, or restrictions which are necessary or desirable as a result of applicable laws or regulations. Each Performance Award may be confirmed by, and be subject to, a Performance Award Agreement. (b) The Committee shall have the authority at any time to make adjustments to Performance Goals for any outstanding Performance Awards which the Committee deems necessary or desirable unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments. (c) Performance Periods shall, in all cases, exceed six (6) months in length. 9.3 Value of Performance Units/Shares. (a) Each Performance Unit shall have an initial value that is established by the Committee at the time of grant. (b) Each Performance Share shall have an initial value equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant. 9.4 Earning of Performance Awards. After the applicable Performance Period has ended, the holder of Performance Awards shall be entitled to receive the payout earned by the Participant over the Performance Period, to be determined as a function of the extent to which the corresponding Performance Goals have been achieved, except as adjusted pursuant to Section 9.2(b) or as deferred pursuant to Article 11. -12- 9.5 Timing of Payment of Performance Awards. Payment of earned Performance Awards shall be made in accordance with terms and conditions prescribed or authorized by the Committee. The Committee may permit the Participants to elect to defer or the Committee may require the deferral of, the receipt of Performance Awards upon such terms as the Committee deems appropriate. 9.6 Nontransferability. Performance Awards may not be sold, transferred, pledged, assigned, or otherwise alienated or hypothecated, other than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution. Further, a Participant’s rights under the Plan shall be exercisable during the Participant’s lifetime only by the Participant or the Participant’s Beneficiary. Notwithstanding the foregoing, at the discretion of the Committee, an Award Agreement may permit the transferability of a Performance Award by a Participant solely to members of the Participant’s immediate family or trusts or partnerships for the benefit of such persons. 9.7 Termination. Performance Awards shall be subject to the following terms and conditions: (a) Except to the extent otherwise provided in the applicable Performance Award Agreement, if any, and Sections 9.7(b) and 13.1 (c), upon a Participant’s Termination of Employment for any reason during the Performance Period or before any applicable Performance Goals are satisfied, the rights to the shares still covered by the Performance Award shall be forfeited by the Participant. (b) Except to the extent otherwise provided in Section 13.1(c), in the event that a Participant’s employment is terminated (other than for Cause), or in the event a Participant retires, the Committee shall have the discretion to waive, in whole or in part, any or all remaining payment limitations (other than, in the case of Performance Awards with respect to which a Participant is a Covered Employee, satisfaction of any applicable Performance Goals unless the Participant’s employment is terminated by reason of death or disability) with respect to any or all of such Participant’s Performance Awards. Article 10. Beneficiary 10.1 Designation. Each Participant under the Plan may, from time to time, name any Beneficiary or Beneficiaries (who may be named contingently or successively). Each such designation shall revoke all prior designations by the same Participant, shall be in a form prescribed by the Company, and shall be effective only when filed by the Participant in writing with the Company during the Participant’s lifetime. Any such designation shall control over any inconsistent testamentary or inter vivos transfer by a Participant, and any benefit of a Participant under the Plan shall pass automatically to a Participant’s Beneficiary pursuant to a proper designation pursuant to this Section 10.1 without administration under any statute or rule of law governing the transfer of property by will, trust, gift or intestacy. 10.2 Absence of Designation. In the absence of any such designation contemplated by Section 10.1, benefits remaining unpaid at the Participant’s death shall be paid pursuant to the Participant’s will or pursuant to the laws of descent and distribution. Article 11. Deferrals The Committee may permit a Participant to elect, or the Committee may require at its sole discretion subject to the proviso set forth below, any one or more of the following: (i) the deferral of the Participant’s receipt of cash, (ii) a delay in the exercise of an Option or SAR, (iii) a delay in the lapse or waiver of restrictions with respect to Restricted Stock, or (iv) a delay of the satisfaction of any requirements or goals with respect to Performance Awards; provided, however, the Committee’s authority to take such actions hereunder shall exist only to the extent necessary to reduce or eliminate a limitation on the deductibility of compensation paid to the Participant pursuant to (and so long as such action in and of itself does not constitute the exercise of impermissible discretion under) Section 162(m) of the Code, or any successor provision thereunder. If any such deferral is required or permitted, the Committee shall establish rules and procedures for such deferrals, including provisions relating to periods of deferral, the terms of payment following the expiration of the deferral periods, and the rate of earnings, if any, to be credited to any amounts deferred thereunder. -13- Article 12. Rights of Employees 12.1 Employment. Nothing in the Plan shall interfere with or limit in any way the right of the Company to terminate any Participant’s employment at any time, nor confer upon any Participant any right to continue in the employ of the Company. For purposes of the Plan, transfer of employment of a Participant between the Company and any one of its Subsidiaries (or between Subsidiaries) shall not be deemed a termination of employment. 12.2 Participation. No Employee shall have the right to be selected to receive an Award under this Plan, or, having been so selected, to be selected to receive a future Award. Article 13. Change of Control 13.1 Impact of Event. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, in the event of a Change of Control: (a) Any Stock Options or SARs outstanding as of the date such Change of Control is determined to have occurred, and which are not then exercisable and vested, shall become fully exercisable and vested to the full extent of the original grant; provided, however, that in the case of the holder of Stock Options or SARs who is actually subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act, such Stock Options or SARs shall have been outstanding for at least six months at the date such Change of Control is determined to have occurred. (b) The restrictions and deferral limitations applicable to any Restricted Stock shall lapse, and such Restricted Stock shall become free of all restrictions and become fully vested and transferable to the full extent of the original grant. (c) All Performance Awards shall be considered to be earned and payable in full, and any deferral or other restriction shall lapse and such Performance Units shall be settled in cash as promptly as is practicable. Article 14. Amendment, Modification, and Termination 14.1 Amendment, Modification, and Termination. At any time and from time to time, the Board may terminate, amend, or modify the Plan. However, no amendment, alteration or discontinuation shall be made which would disqualify the Plan from the exemption provided by Rule 16b-3, and no such amendment shall be made without the approval of the Company’s stockholders to the extent such approval is required by law or agreement. 14.2 Awards Previously Granted. No termination, amendment, or modification of the Plan shall adversely affect in any material way any Award previously granted under the Plan, without the written consent of the Participant holding such Award except such an amendment made to cause the Plan or Award to qualify for the exemption provided by Rule 16b-3. The Committee shall have the right to replace any previously- granted Award under the Plan with an Award equal to the value of the replaced Award at the time of replacement, without obtaining the consent of the Participant holding such Award. Subject to the above provisions, the Board shall have authority to amend the Plan to take into account changes in law and tax and accounting rules as well as other developments, and to grant Awards which qualify for beneficial treatment under such rules without stockholder approval. Article 15. Withholding 15.1 Tax Withholding. The Company shall have the power and the right to deduct or withhold, or require a Participant to remit to the Company, an amount sufficient to satisfy Federal, state, and local taxes (including the Participant’s FICA obligation) required by law to be withheld with respect to any taxable event arising under or as a result of this Plan. 15.2 Share Withholding. With respect to withholding required and/or permitted upon the exercise of Options or SARs, upon the lapse of restrictions on Restricted Stock, or upon any other taxable event hereunder, Participants may elect, subject to the approval of -14- the Committee, to satisfy the withholding requirement, in whole or in part, by having the Company withhold Shares (or by surrendering Shares previously owned which have been held for longer than six months) having a Fair Market Value on the date the tax is to be determined equal to the minimum statutory total tax which could be imposed on the transaction. All elections shall be irrevocable, made in writing, signed by the Participant, and elections by Insiders shall additionally comply with the requirements established by the Committee. Article 16. Successors All obligations of the Company under the Plan, with respect to Awards granted hereunder, shall be binding on any successor to the Company, whether the existence of such successor is the result of a direct or indirect purchase, merger, consolidation, spin-off, or otherwise, of all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company. Article 17. Legal Construction 17.1 Gender and Number. Except where otherwise indicated by the context, any masculine term used herein also shall include the feminine; the plural shall include the singular and the singular shall include the plural. 17.2 Severability. In the event any provision of the Plan shall be held illegal or invalid for any reason, the illegality or invalidity shall not affect the remaining parts of the Plan, and the Plan shall be construed and enforced as if the illegal or invalid provision had not been included. 17.3 Requirements of Law. The granting of Awards and the issuance of Shares under the Plan shall be subject to all applicable laws, rules, and regulations, and to such approvals by any governmental agencies or national securities exchanges as may be required. With respect to Insiders, transactions under this Plan are intended to comply with all applicable conditions of Rule 16b-3 or its successors under the Exchange Act. To the extent any provision of the plan or action by the Committee fails to comply with Section 17.3, it shall be deemed null and void, to the extent permitted by law and deemed advisable by the Committee. Notwithstanding any other provision set forth in the Plan, if required by any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 of the Exchange Act, any “derivative security” or “equity security” offered pursuant to the Plan to any Insider may not be sold or transferred for at least six (6) months after the date of grant of such Award. The terms “equity security” and “derivative security” shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the then-current Rule 16(a) under the Exchange Act. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or agreements made pursuant thereto, the Company shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificate or certificates for Shares under the Plan prior to fulfillment of all of the following conditions: i. Listing or approval for listing upon notice of issuance, of such shares on the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., or such other securities exchange as may at the time be the principal market for the Shares; ii. Any registration or other qualification of such Shares under any state or federal law or regulation, or the maintaining in effect of any such registration or other qualification which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion upon the advice of counsel, deem necessary or advisable; and iii. Obtaining any other consent, approval, or permit from any state or federal governmental agency which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion after receiving the advice of counsel, determine to be necessary or advisable. 17.4 Pooling. Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, if any right granted pursuant to this Plan would make a Change of Control transaction ineligible for pooling-of-interests accounting under APB No.16 that but for the nature of such grant would otherwise be eligible for such accounting treatment, the Committee shall have the ability to substitute for the cash payable pursuant to such grant Common Stock with a Fair Market Value equal to the cash that would otherwise be payable hereunder. -15- 17.5 Governing Law. To the extent not preempted by Federal law, the Plan, and all agreements hereunder, shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware. -16- TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION DIRECTOR STOCK PLAN Exhibit 10.2 (as amended November 12, 1998, November 13, 2001, May 11, 2005, May 17, 2006 and November 2, 2006) Section 1. Purpose The purposes of the Plan are to assist the Company in (1) promoting a greater identity of interests between the Company’s non-employee directors and its shareholders, and (2) attracting and retaining directors by affording them an opportunity to share in the future successes of the Company. Section 2. Definitions “Act” shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. “Award” shall mean an award of Common Stock as contemplated by Section 7 or Section 8 of this Plan or a Stock Option, Restricted Stock Award or Restricted Stock Unit Award as contemplated by Section 9 of this Plan. “Board” shall mean the Board of Directors of the Company. “Change of Control” shall mean the happening of any of the following events: (i) An acquisition by any individual, entity or group (within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) or 14(d)(2) of the Act) (a “Person”) of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Act) of 20 percent or more of either (1) the then outstanding shares of Common Stock (the “Outstanding Company Common Stock”) or (2) the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities of the Company entitled to vote generally in the election of directors (the “Outstanding Company Voting Securities”); excluding, however, the following: (1) any acquisition directly from the Company, other than an acquisition by virtue of the exercise of a conversion privilege unless the security being so converted was itself acquired from the Company, (2) any acquisition by the Company, (3) any acquisition by any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or (4) any acquisition by any Person pursuant to a transaction which complies with clauses (1), (2) and (3) of subsection (iii) of this definition; or (ii) A change in the composition of the Board such that the individuals who, as of the Effective Date, constitute the Board (such Board shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Incumbent Board”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board; provided, however, for purposes of this definition, that any individual who becomes a member of the Board subsequent to the Effective Date, whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of those individuals who are members of the Board and who were also members of the Incumbent Board (or deemed to be such pursuant to this proviso) shall be considered as though such individual were a member of the Incumbent Board; but, provided further, that any such individual whose initial assumption of office occurs as a result of either an actual or threatened election contest (as such terms are used in Rule 14a-11 of Regulation 14A promulgated under the Act) or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a Person other than the Board shall not be so considered as a member of the Incumbent Board; or (iii) The consummation of a reorganization, merger, statutory share exchange or consolidation or sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company or the acquisition of assets or stock of another entity by the Company or any of its subsidiaries (“Corporate Transaction”); in each case unless, following such Corporate Transaction (1) all or substantially all of the individuals and entities who were the beneficial owners, respectively, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than 60 percent of, respectively, the outstanding shares of common stock, and the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, as the case may be, of the entity resulting from such Corporate Transaction (including, without limitation, an entity which as a result of such transaction owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) in substantially the same proportions as their ownership, immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities, as the case may be, (2) no Person (other than the Company, any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or such entity resulting from such Corporate Transaction) beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, 20 percent or more of, respectively, the outstanding shares of common stock of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction or the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of such corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of directors except to the extent that such ownership existed with respect to the Company prior to the Corporate Transaction and (3) individuals who were members of the Incumbent Board at the time of the execution of the initial agreement or of the action of the Board providing for such Corporate Transaction constitute at least a majority of the board of directors of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction; or (iv) The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company. “Code” shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time, and the rules and regulations thereunder. “Common Stock” shall mean the common stock, $.01 par value, of the Company. - 2 - “Company” shall mean Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation. “Effective Date” shall have the meaning given in Section 18 of the Plan. “ERISA” shall mean the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended from time to time, and the rules and regulations thereunder. “Fair Market Value” shall mean, as of any given date, the closing sales price of the Common Stock during normal business hours on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape, or, if not listed on such exchange, on any other national securities exchange on which the Common Stock is listed or on NASDAQ. If there is no regular public trading market for such Common Stock, the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock shall be determined by the Committee in good faith. “Fees” shall mean the annual retainer fee for a Participant in connection with his or her service on the Board for any fiscal year of the Company. “Participant” shall mean each member of the Board who is not an employee of the Company or any subsidiary of the Company. “Plan” shall mean the Tupperware Brands Corporation Director Stock Plan. “Retirement” shall mean the retirement by a Participant from the Board in accordance with the Company’s stated policy on Director retirement. “Restricted Stock Award” shall have the meaning given in Section 9(d) (iii) of the Plan. “Restricted Stock Unit Award” shall have the meaning given in Section 9(d) (iv) of the Plan. “Rules” shall mean the rules promulgated under the Act from time to time and the interpretations issued by Securities and Exchange Commission in respect thereof. “Stock Option” shall mean a non-qualified stock option granted under the Plan. Section 3. Eligibility Each member of the Board who is not an employee of the Company or any subsidiary of the Company shall be eligible to participate in the Plan. Section 4. Shares Subject to the Plan The maximum number of shares of Common Stock which shall be available for use under the Plan shall be 600,000, subject to adjustment pursuant to Section 16 hereunder. The shares issued under the Plan may be authorized and unissued shares or issued shares heretofore or hereafter acquired and held as treasury shares or shares purchased on the open market. - 3 - Section 5. Duration of Plan Unless earlier terminated pursuant to Section 11 hereof, this Plan shall automatically terminate on, and no grants, awards or elections may be made after, the date of the twentieth anniversary of the Effective Date. Section 6. Administration (a) The Plan shall be administered by the Board or any committee thereof so designated by the Board (the “Committee”), which shall have full authority to construe and interpret the Plan, to establish, amend and rescind rules and regulations relating to the Plan, and to take all such actions and make all such determinations in connection with the Plan as it may deem necessary or desirable. (b) Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, no amendment or termination of the Plan shall adversely affect the interest of any Director in Awards or Stock Options previously granted to the Director without that Director’s express written consent. Section 7. Initial Awards Each Participant shall receive a one-time grant of one thousand (1,000) shares of Common Stock, upon serving his or her initial three months as a member of the Board. Section 8. Stock in Lieu of Retainer A Participant shall receive 50 percent of his or her Fees in the form of Common Stock (the “Stock Fees”). The remaining 50 percent of a Participant’s Fees are hereinafter referred to as the “Cash Fees.” Each Participant who, in any year of the Plan, delivers to the Company written notice of an irrevocable election concerning the Cash Fees to be earned in the next fiscal year of the Company, may receive in lieu of cash an amount of shares of Common Stock equal in value to all or any portion of the Cash Fees (but only increments of 25 percent or a multiple thereof, and in no event to exceed 100 percent of the Cash Fees) as so designated by the Participant in such written notice. The amount of the Common Stock to be received in lieu of Fees shall be determined by dividing the dollar value of the Stock Fees, plus the dollar value of the Cash Fees, if any, the Participant has elected to have paid in Common Stock, that are payable in each fiscal quarter of the Company by the Fair Market Value of a share of Common Stock on the last business day of such fiscal quarter (but if such date is not a day on which the New York Stock Exchange is open, then on the next preceding day on which the New York Stock Exchange is open), except that only whole numbers of shares shall be obtainable pursuant to this Section, and any remainder Fees which otherwise would have purchased a fractional share shall be paid in cash. Any - 4 - such written notice pursuant to this Section 8 shall remain in effect for subsequent Plan years unless such Participant delivers a written notice setting forth a different election with respect to Cash Fees, which shall be applied to future Plan years until further written notice is received by the Company pursuant to this Section 8. Section 9. Stock Awards (a) Each Participant who, in any year of the Plan, delivers to the Company an irrevocable election concerning the Cash Fees to be earned in the next fiscal year of the Company, may receive in lieu of all or any portion of the Cash Fees (but only increments of 25 percent or a multiple thereof) as so designated by the Participant, a Stock Option for an amount of shares of Common Stock in each fiscal year of the Company as follows: Number of Shares Subject to Option 1,000 500 Percent of Cash Fees Forgone 100% 50% The exercise price shall be determined as follows: Fair Market Value Of a Share Of Common Stock Fair Market Value Of a Share Of Common Stock – – 100% of Cash Fees 1,000 = Exercise Price Per Share 50% of Cash Fees 500 = Exercise Price Per Share In no event, however, shall the exercise price be less than 50 percent of the Fair Market Value of a share of Common Stock on the date of the grant. In the event that the effect of the foregoing sentence is to limit the reduction of the exercise price, any portion of the Cash Fees which are so prevented from reducing the exercise price shall be paid to the affected Participant, in cash or Common Stock (as elected by the Participant) in an equitable fashion over the remainder of the year in which the Cash Fees are earned, as if an election to receive a Stock Option pursuant to this Section 9(a) had not been made. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no Participant shall be eligible to elect to receive a stock option under Section 9(a) of this Plan in respect of Cash Fees earned for any fiscal year of the Company after the Company’s 2004 fiscal year. (b) The date of grant of a Stock Option pursuant to Section 9(a) shall be the date of the annual meeting of stockholders of the Company that occurs during the year in which the Cash Fees are earned. If such day would not be a day on which the New York Stock Exchange is open, then on the next succeeding day on which the New York Stock Exchange is open. - 5 - (c) A Stock Option granted pursuant to Section 9(a) shall vest and be exercisable on the last day of the fiscal year in which the Stock Option is granted. In the event that a Participant is not a member of the Board on the last day of the fiscal year in which the Stock Option is granted, except in the case of a Participant’s death or termination for cause, such Participant’s Stock Option which has not become vested and exercisable as of such time shall (i) be reduced to an amount of shares of Common Stock which reflects the amount of the foregone Cash Fees earned as of the date of termination from service on the Board, which amount shall be determined by multiplying the number of shares of Common Stock subject to the Stock Option as determined pursuant to Section 9(a), above, by a fraction, the numerator of which shall be the number of days of the fiscal year of the Company in which the Stock Option is granted that the Participant was a member of the Board and the denominator of which shall be 365, provided, that any Stock Option for a fractional share of Common Stock shall be rounded up to the nearest whole number of shares, and (ii) shall continue to vest. The term of exercisability for a Stock Option granted under this Section 9 shall be ten (10) years. (d) (i) Each Participant may receive on the day of the Company’s annual meeting of shareholders a Stock Award in an amount of shares of Common Stock as determined by the Committee. Stock Awards shall be evidenced by agreements incorporating the terms and conditions set forth below, and which shall become effective upon execution by the Company and the Participant. (ii) Stock Options granted under Section 9(d) the Plan shall be subject to the following terms and conditions, except as otherwise determined by the Committee at the time of grant, and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (A) Option Price. The option price per Share purchasable under a Stock Option shall be equal to the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Stock Option on the date of grant. Except as may be contemplated by Section 16, the option price may not be adjusted (repriced), nor may new Stock Options be issued in exchange for the surrender of outstanding Stock Options, without shareholder approval. (B) Option Term. The term of each Stock Option shall be 10 years from the date the Stock Option is granted. (C) Exercisability. Each Stock Option granted under this Section 9(d) shall be immediately exercisable. If the Committee otherwise provides that any Stock Option is exercisable only in installments, the Committee may at any time waive such installment exercise provisions, in whole or in part, based on such factors as the Committee may determine. In addition, the Committee may at any time accelerate the exercisability of any Stock Option. - 6 - (D) Method of Exercise. Subject to the provisions of this Section 9(d), Stock Options may be exercised, in whole or in part, at any time during the option term by giving written notice of exercise to the Company specifying the number of shares subject to the Stock Option to be purchased. Such notice shall be accompanied by payment in full of the purchase price by certified or bank check or such other instrument as the Company may accept. Payment, in full or in part, may also be made in the form of delivery of unrestricted shares of Common Stock already owned by the Participant (based on the Fair Market Value of the shares on the date the Stock Option is exercised) and held for a period of not less than 6 months prior to the Stock Option exercise, or by certifying ownership of such shares by the Participant to the satisfaction of the Company for later delivery to the Company as specified by the Committee. In the discretion of the Committee, payment for any shares subject to a Stock Option may also be made pursuant to a “cashless exercise” by delivering a properly executed exercise notice to the Company, together with a copy of irrevocable instructions to a broker to deliver promptly to the Company the amount of sale or loan proceeds to pay the purchase price. To facilitate the foregoing, the Company may enter into agreements for coordinated procedures with one or more brokerage firms. No shares shall be issued until full payment therefor has been made. A Participant shall have all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of shares that is subject to such Stock Option (including, if applicable, the right to vote the shares and the right to receive dividends), when the Participant has given written notice of exercise and has paid in full for such shares. (iii) Restricted Stock Awards. A Restricted Stock Award is a Stock Award in the form of Common Stock that will be settled by delivery of shares of Common Stock. The Committee shall determine the number of Shares to be awarded to any Participant, the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards. Restricted Stock Awards may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. Restricted Stock Awards shall be subject to the following terms and conditions, except as otherwise determined by the Committee at the time of grant, and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (A) Restricted Periods. The Committee may, prior to grant, condition the vesting of a Restricted Stock Award upon continued service of the Participant. The provisions of Restricted Stock Awards need not be the same with respect to each recipient. The Committee may provide for the lapse of restrictions based upon period of service in installments or otherwise and may accelerate or waive, in whole or in part, restrictions based upon period of service. - 7 - (B) Evidence of Award. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be evidenced in such manner as the Committee may deem appropriate, including book-entry registration or issuance of one or more stock certificates. Any certificate issued in respect of Shares of Restricted Stock shall be registered in the name of such Participant and shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the terms, conditions, and restrictions applicable to such Award, substantially in the following form: “The sale or other transfer of the Shares of stock represented by this certificate, whether voluntary, involuntary, or by operation of law, is subject to certain restrictions on transfer as set forth in the Tupperware Brands Corporation Director Stock Plan, and in an Award Agreement. A copy of the Plan and such Award Agreement may be obtained from Tupperware Brands Corporation.” The Committee may require that the certificates evidencing such Shares be held in custody by the Company until the restrictions thereon shall have lapsed and that, as a condition of any Award of Restricted Stock, the Participant shall have delivered a stock power, endorsed in blank, relating to the Common Stock covered by such Award. (C) Restriction on Alienation. During the Restricted Period, the Participant shall not be permitted to sell, assign, transfer, pledge or otherwise encumber Shares of Restricted Stock. (D) Rights of a Stockholder. Except as may be provided in the Award Agreement, the Participant shall have, with respect to the shares of Restricted Stock, all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is the subject of the Restricted Stock, including, if applicable, the right to vote the Shares and the right to receive any cash dividends. Dividends payable in Shares and other non-cash dividends and distributions shall be held subject to the vesting of the underlying Restricted Stock, unless the Committee determines otherwise in the applicable Award Agreement or makes an adjustment or substitution to the Restricted Stock pursuant to the Plan. - 8 - (E) Delivery of Shares. If and when any applicable Restriction Period expires without a prior forfeiture of the Restricted Stock, unlegended evidence of ownership for such Shares shall be delivered to the Participant upon surrender of the legended certificates. (F) Award Agreement. Each Award shall be confirmed by, and be subject to, the terms of an Award Agreement. (iv) Restricted Stock Units. Restricted Stock Units are Awards denominated in Shares that will be settled, subject to the terms and conditions of the Restricted Stock Units, either by delivery of Shares to the Participant or by the payment of cash based upon the Fair Market Value of a specified number of Shares. Restricted Stock Units may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall determine the number of Shares to be awarded to any Participant, the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards. Restricted Stock Unit Awards shall be subject to the terms and conditions set forth in Section 9(d)(iii) above and to the following terms and conditions, except as otherwise determined by the Committee at the time of grant, and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (A) Performance Awards. The Committee may, in connection with the grant of Restricted Stock Units, designate them as Performance Awards, in which event it shall condition the vesting thereof upon the attainment of Performance Goals. If the Committee does not designate Restricted Stock Units as Performance Awards, it may condition the vesting thereof upon the attainment of Performance Goals. (B) Restricted Periods. The Committee may also condition the vesting thereof upon the continued service of the Participant. The applicable Award Agreement shall specify the consequences for the Restricted Stock Units of the Participant’s termination of employment. (C) Settlement of Awards. An Award of Restricted Stock Units shall be settled as and when the Restricted Stock Units vest or at a later time specified by the Committee or in accordance with an election of the Participant, if the Committee so permits. - 9 - (D) Restrictions on Alienation. Restricted Stock Units may not be sold, assigned, transferred, pledged or otherwise encumbered until they are settled, except to the extent provided in the applicable Award Agreement in the event of the Participant’s death. (E) Dividend Equivalent Rights. The Award Agreement for Restricted Stock Units shall specify whether, to what extent and on what terms and conditions the applicable Participant shall be entitled to receive current or deferred payments of cash, Common Stock or other property corresponding to dividends paid on the Common Stock. Section 10. Transferability Rights, grants and Awards under the Plan may not be assigned, transferred, pledged or hypothecated, and shall not be subject to execution, attachment or similar process. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any such right, grant or award constituting a “derivative security” under the Rules shall not be transferable by a Participant other than by will or by operation of applicable laws of descent and distribution or pursuant to a domestic relations order or qualified domestic relations order as such terms are defined by the Code or ERISA. Section 11. Amendment The Board may from time to time make such amendments to the Plan as it may deem proper and in the best interest of the Company without further approval of the Company’s stockholders, subject to Section 6(b). Section 12. Termination The Plan may be terminated at any time by the Board or by the approval by the holders of at least a majority of the shares of Common Stock present, or represented, and entitled to vote at a meeting held for such purpose. Section 13. Effect of Change of Control Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, in the event of a Change of Control, any Stock Options outstanding and not then exercisable and vested as of the date such Change of Control is determined to have occurred, shall become immediately exercisable, and shall remain exercisable throughout their entire original term, without regard to any subsequent termination of membership on the Board. Section 14. Death, Disability, Termination or Retirement of Participant (a) Death. Except as otherwise provided in Section 9(c) or Section 13 of the Plan, in the event of the death of a Participant while a member of the Board, any Stock Awards outstanding as of the date of death and not then exercisable or vested shall become - 10 - immediately exercisable and vested, and all outstanding Stock Options held by such Participant shall remain exercisable by the person to whom the Stock Option is transferred by will or by the laws of descent and distribution for a period of the lesser of (i) the remaining term of the Stock Option or (ii) three (3) years after the date of death. In the event of the death of a Participant subsequent to termination of membership from the Board, to the extent not already exercisable, and all stock options shall remain exercisable by the person to whom the Stock Option is transferred by will or by the laws of descent and distribution for a period of the lesser of (i) the remaining term of the Stock Option, or (ii) three (3) years after the date of death. (b) Disability, Retirement or Other Termination. Except as otherwise provided in Section 9(c) or Section 13 of the Plan, in the event of a Participant’s termination of membership on the Board as a result of the Participant’s disability or Retirement or for another reason other than death or cause (as defined in Section 15 of the Plan), any Stock Awards outstanding as of the date of such termination and not then exercisable or vested shall (i) be adjusted in amount to reflect the proportion of Fees earned in the final year of such Participant’s service in such year (in accordance with the operation of Sections 8 and 9 of this Plan and in consideration of such Participant’s elections for such year), and (ii) become exercisable on the last day of the Company’s then-current fiscal year. All outstanding Stock Options held by such Participant shall remain exercisable (to the extent they are exercisable at the time of such termination or become exercisable pursuant to the preceding sentence) until the end of their original term. Section 15. Effect of Termination for Cause If a Participant incurs a termination of membership on the Board for cause, such Participant’s Stock Awards which are not then exercisable or vested shall be automatically cancelled immediately. Unless otherwise determined by the Board, for purposes of the Plan “cause” shall mean (i) the conviction of the Participant for commission of a felony under Federal law or the law in the state in which such action occurred, or (ii) dishonesty in the course of fulfilling the Participant’s duties as a director. Section 16. Adjustments Upon Changes in Capitalization In the event of any change in corporate capitalization, such as a stock split or a corporate transaction, such as any merger, consolidation, separation, including a spin off, or other distribution of stock or property of the Company, any reorganization (whether or not such reorganization comes within the definition of such term in Section 368 of the Code) or any partial or complete liquidation of the company, the Committee or Board may make such substitution or adjustments in the aggregate number and class of shares reserved for issuance under the Plan, in the number, kind and option price of shares subject to outstanding Stock Options, in the number and kind of shares subject to other outstanding Awards granted under the Plan and /or such other equitable substitution or adjustments as it may determine to be appropriate in its sole discretion; provided, however, that the number of shares subject to any Award shall always be a whole number; and provided further, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of a change - 11 - in capitalization that is the result of an equity restructuring which is not the consequence of a corporate transaction with a third-party, such substitutions or adjustments shall be required to be made. Such substitutions and adjustments may include, without limitation, canceling any and all Awards in exchange for cash payments based upon the value realized by shareholders generally with respect to Shares in connection with such a corporate transaction. Section 17. Regulatory Matters The Plan is intended to be construed so that participation in the Plan will be exempt from Section 16(b) of the Act, pursuant to Rule 16b-3 as promulgated thereunder, as may be further amended or interpreted by the Securities and Exchange Commission. In the event that any provision of the Plan shall be deemed not to be in compliance with the Rules in order to enjoy the exemption from the Act, such provision shall be deemed of no force or effect and the remaining provisions of the Plan shall remain in effect. Section 18. Effectiveness of Plan The Plan as amended and restated hereby shall become effective as of the date the shareholders of the Company approve it (the “Effective Date”.) Section 19. Governing Law To the extent not preempted by Federal law, the Plan, and all agreements hereunder, shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware. - 12 - Exhibit 10.3 CHANGE OF CONTROL EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT AGREEMENT by and between TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation (the “Company”) and (the “Executive”), dated as of the day of , 20 . The Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”) has determined that it is in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders to assure that the Company will have the continued dedication of the Executive, notwithstanding the possibility, threat or occurrence of a Change of Control (as defined below) of the Company. The Board believes it is imperative to diminish the inevitable distraction of the Executive by virtue of the personal uncertainties and risks created by a pending or threatened Change of Control and to encourage the Executive’s full attention and dedication to the Company currently and in the event of any threatened or pending Change of Control, and to provide the Executive with compensation and benefits arrangements upon a Change of Control which ensure that the compensation and benefits expectations of the Executive will be satisfied and which are competitive with those of other corporations. Therefore, in order to accomplish these objectives, the Board has caused the Company to enter into this Agreement. NOW, THEREFORE, IT IS HEREBY AGREED AS FOLLOWS: 1. Certain Definitions . (a) The “Effective Date” shall be the first date during the Protection Period (as defined in Section 1(b)) on which a Change of Control occurs. Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, if a Change of Control occurs and if the Executive’s employment with the Company is terminated prior to the date on which the Change of Control occurs, and if it is reasonably demonstrated by the Executive that such termination of employment (i) was at the request of a third party who has taken steps reasonably calculated to effect the Change of Control or (ii) otherwise arose in connection with or anticipation of the Change of Control, then for all purposes of this Agreement the “Effective Date” shall mean the date immediately prior to the date of such termination of employment. (b) The “Protection Period” shall be the period commencing on the date hereof and ending on the second anniversary of such date; provided, however, that commencing on the date one year after the date hereof, and on each annual anniversary of such date (such date and each annual anniversary thereof shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Renewal Date”), the Protection Period shall be automatically extended so as to terminate two years from such Renewal Date, unless at least 60 days prior to the Renewal Date the Company shall give notice to the Executive that the Protection Period shall not be so extended. 2. Change of Control . For the purpose of this Agreement, a “Change of Control” shall mean: (a) The acquisition by any individual, entity or group (within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) or 14(d)(2) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)) (a “Person”) of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 20% or more of either (i) the then outstanding shares of common stock of the Company (the “Outstanding Company Common Stock”) or (ii) the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities of the Company entitled to vote generally in the election of directors (the “Outstanding Company Voting Securities”); provided, however, that for purposes of this subsection (a), the following acquisitions shall not constitute a Change of Control: (i) any acquisition directly from the Company, (ii) any acquisition by the Company, (iii) any acquisition by any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or (iv) any acquisition by any corporation pursuant to a transaction which complies with clauses (i), (ii) and (iii) of subsection (c) of this Section 2; or (b) Individuals who, as of the date hereof, constitute the Board (the “Incumbent Board”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board, provided that any individual becoming a director subsequent to the date hereof whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s shareholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of the directors then comprising the Incumbent Board shall be considered as though such individual were a member of the Incumbent Board, but excluding, for this purpose, any such individual whose initial assumption of office is in connection with an actual or threatened election contest or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a Person other than the Board; or (c) Consummation by the Company of a reorganization, merger or consolidation or sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company the acquisition of assets of another corporation, a statutory share exchange or other similar transactions (a “Corporate Transaction”), in each case, unless, following such Corporate Transaction, (i) all or substantially all of the individuals and entities who were the beneficial owners, respectively, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of, respectively, the then outstanding shares of common stock and the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, as the case may be, of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction (including, without limitation, a corporation which as a result of such transaction owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) in substantially the same proportions as their ownership, immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities, as the case may be, (ii) no Person (excluding any employee benefit plan (or related trust) of the Company or such corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction) beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, 20% or more of, respectively, the then outstanding shares of common stock of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction or the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities of such corporation except to the extent that such ownership existed prior to the Corporate Transaction and (iii) at least a majority of the members of the board of directors of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction were members of the Incumbent Board at the time of the execution of the initial agreement, or at the time of the action of the Board, providing for such Corporate Transaction; or 2 (d) Approval by the shareholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company. 3. Employment Period . The Company hereby agrees to continue the Executive in its employ or the employ of one of its subsidiaries, and the Executive hereby agrees to remain in such employ of the Company subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, for the period commencing on the Effective Date and ending on the second anniversary of such date (the “Employment Period”). 4. Terms of Employment. (a) Position and Duties . (i) During the Employment Period, (A) the Executive’s position (including status, offices, titles and reporting requirements), authority, duties and responsibilities shall be at least commensurate in all material respects with the most significant of those held, exercised and assigned at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date and (B) the Executive’s services shall be performed at the location where the Executive was employed immediately preceding the Effective Date or any office or location less than 35 miles from the Executive’s primary residence immediately prior to any relocation. Such position, authority, duties and responsibilities shall be regarded as not commensurate and as inconsistent and result in a diminution for purposes of Section 5(c)(i) if, as a result of a Change of Control, (I), the Company becomes a direct or indirect subsidiary of another corporation or becomes controlled, directly or indirectly, by an unincorporated entity (such ultimate parent corporation or unincorporated entity is hereinafter referred to as a “parent company”), or (II) all or substantially all of the assets of the Company are acquired by another corporation or corporations or unincorporated entity or entities owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by another corporation or unincorporated entity (such ultimate parent corporation or unincorporated entity is also hereinafter referred to as a “parent company”), unless, in each of (I) and (II), (x) Section 12 (c) of this Agreement shall have been complied with by any such parent company and (y) the Executive shall have assumed a position with such parent company and the Executive’s position, authority, duties and responsibilities with such parent company are at least commensurate in all material respects with the most significant of those held, exercised and assigned with the Company at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date, or (III) the Company becomes owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by more than one other corporation and/or unincorporated entity, as the case may be, which are not owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by a single parent company or (IV) more than one unrelated corporation or unincorporated entity acquires a significant portion of the assets of the Corporation and such unrelated corporations or unincorporated entities, as the case may be, are not owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by a single parent company. the Executive agrees to devote reasonable attention and time during normal business hours to the business and affairs of the (ii) During the Employment Period, and excluding any periods of vacation and sick leave to which the Executive is entitled, 3 Company and, to the extent necessary to discharge the responsibilities assigned to the Executive hereunder, to use the Executive’s reasonable best efforts to perform faithfully and efficiently such responsibilities. During the Employment Period it shall not be a violation of this Agreement for the Executive to (A) serve on corporate, civic or charitable boards or committees, (B) deliver lectures, fulfill speaking engagements or teach at educational institutions and (C) manage personal investments, so long as such activities do not significantly interfere with the performance of the Executive’s responsibilities as an employee of the Company in accordance with this Agreement. It is expressly understood and agreed that to the extent that any such activities have been conducted by the Executive prior to the Effective Date, the continued conduct of such activities (or the conduct of activities similar in nature and scope thereto) subsequent to the Effective Date shall not thereafter be deemed to interfere with the performance of the Executive’s responsibilities to the Company. (b) Compensation . (i) Base Salary . During the Employment Period, the Executive shall receive an annual base salary (“Annual Base Salary”), which shall be paid at a monthly rate, at least equal to twelve times the highest monthly base salary paid or payable, including any base salary which has been earned but deferred, to the Executive by the Company and its affiliated companies in respect of the twelve-month period immediately preceding the month in which the Effective Date occurs. During the Employment Period, the Annual Base Salary shall be reviewed at least annually and shall be increased at any time and from time to time as shall be substantially consistent with increases in base salary generally awarded in the ordinary course of business to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. Any increase in Annual Base Salary shall not serve to limit or reduce any other obligation to the Executive under this Agreement. Annual Base Salary shall not be reduced after any such increase and the term Annual Base Salary as utilized in this Agreement shall refer to Annual Base Salary as so increased. As used in this Agreement, the term “affiliated companies” shall include any company controlled by, controlling or under common control with the Company. (ii) Incentive Awards . In addition to Annual Base Salary, the Executive shall be awarded, for each fiscal year ending during the Employment Period, an annual incentive award (the “Annual Incentive Award”) and a long-term incentive award (which may be designated as a performance unit award)(the “Long-Term Cash Incentive Award” and together with the Annual Incentive Award, the “Incentive Awards”) in cash at least equal to the average annualized (for any fiscal year consisting of less than twelve full months or with respect to which the Executive has been employed by the Company for less than twelve full months) annual incentive award and long-term cash incentive award, respectively, paid or payable, including by reason of any deferral, to the Executive by the Company and its affiliated companies in respect of the three fiscal years immediately preceding the fiscal year in which the Effective Date occurs (together, the “Recent Incentive Awards”); provided, however, that for any year of such three-year period in which the actual incentive awards were less than the target level of such incentive awards, then the target levels of such incentive awards shall be used for purposes of the foregoing formula. Each such Annual Incentive Award and Long-Term Cash Incentive Award shall be paid no later than two and one-half months after the fiscal year for which the Annual Incentive Award or the Long-Term Cash Incentive Award, as the case may be, is awarded, unless the Executive shall elect to defer the receipt of such Annual Incentive Award or Long-Term Cash Incentive Award, which deferrals shall be made in accordance with the provisions of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). 4 (iii) Profit Sharing, Thrift, Savings and Pension Plans . In addition to Annual Base Salary and Incentive Awards payable as hereinabove provided, the Executive shall be entitled to participate during the Employment Period in all profit sharing, thrift, savings and pension plans, practices, policies and programs generally applicable to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies, but in no event shall such plans, practices, policies and programs provide the Executive with profit sharing opportunities (measured with respect to both regular and special profit sharing opportunities), thrift opportunities, savings opportunities and pension benefits opportunities, in each case, less favorable, in the aggregate, than the most favorable of those provided by the Company and its affiliated companies for the Executive under such plans, practices, policies and programs as in effect at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or if more favorable to the Executive, those provided generally at any time after the Effective Date to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. (iv) Welfare Benefit Plans . During the Employment Period, the Executive and/or the Executive’s family, as the case may be, shall be eligible for participation in and shall receive all benefits under welfare benefit plans, practices, policies and programs provided by the Company and its affiliated companies (including, without limitation, medical, prescription, dental, disability, salary continuance, employee life, group life, accidental death and travel accident insurance plans and programs) to the extent generally applicable to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies, but in no event shall such plans, practices, policies and programs provide benefits which are less favorable, in the aggregate, than the most favorable of such plans, practices, policies and programs in effect for the Executive at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or if more favorable to the Executive, those provided generally at any time after the Effective Date to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. (v) Expenses . During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be entitled to receive prompt reimbursement for all reasonable expenses incurred by the Executive in accordance with the most favorable policies, practices and procedures of the Company and its affiliated companies in effect for the Executive at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive, as in effect at any time thereafter generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. (vi) Perquisites . During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be entitled to perquisites in accordance with the most favorable plans, practices, programs and policies of the Company and its affiliated companies in effect for the Executive at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive, as in effect at any time thereafter generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. 5 (vii) Office and Support Staff . During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be entitled to an office or offices of a size and with furnishings and other appointments, and to exclusive personal secretarial and other assistance, at least equal to the most favorable of the foregoing provided to the Executive by the Company and its affiliated companies at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive, as provided at any time thereafter generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. (viii) Vacation . During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be entitled to paid vacation in accordance with the most favorable plans, policies, programs and practices of the Company and its affiliated companies as in effect for the Executive at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive, as in effect at any time thereafter generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies. 5. Termination of Employment . (a) Death or Disability . The Executive’s employment shall terminate automatically upon the Executive’s death during the Employment Period. If the Company determines in good faith that the Disability of the Executive has occurred during the Employment Period (pursuant to the definition of “Disability” set forth below), it may give to the Executive written notice in accordance with Section 13(b) of this Agreement of its intention to terminate the Executive’s employment. In such event, the Executive’s employment with the Company shall terminate effective on the 30th day after receipt of such notice by the Executive (the “Disability Effective Date”), provided that, within the 30 days after such receipt, the Executive shall not have returned to full-time performance of the Executive’s duties. For purposes of this Agreement, “Disability” means the absence of the Executive from the Executive’s duties with the Company on a substantially full-time basis for 180 consecutive business days as a result of incapacity due to mental or physical illness which is determined to be total and permanent by a physician selected by the Company or its insurers and acceptable to the Executive or the Executive’s legal representative (such agreement as to acceptability not to be withheld unreasonably). (b) Cause . The Company may terminate the Executive’s employment during the Employment Period for Cause. For purposes of this Agreement, “Cause” shall mean: (i) the willful and continued failure of the Executive to perform substantially the Executive’s duties with the Company or one of its affiliates (other than any such failure resulting from incapacity due to physical or mental illness), after a written demand for substantial performance is delivered to the Executive by the Board or the Chief Executive Officer of the Company which specifically identifies the manner in which the Board or Chief Executive Officer believes that the Executive has not substantially performed the Executive’s duties, or injurious to the Company. (ii) the willful engaging by the Executive in illegal conduct or gross misconduct which is materially and demonstrably 6 For purposes of this provision, no act or failure to act, on the part of the Executive, shall be considered “willful” unless it is done, or omitted to be done, by the Executive in bad faith or without reasonable belief that the Executive’s action or omission was in the best interests of the Company. Any act, or failure to act, based upon authority given pursuant to a resolution duly adopted by the Board or upon the instructions of the Chief Executive Officer or a senior officer of the Company or based upon the advice of counsel for the Company shall be conclusively presumed to be done, or omitted to be done, by the Executive in good faith and in the best interests of the Company. The cessation of employment of the Executive shall not be deemed to be for Cause unless and until there shall have been delivered to the Executive a copy of a resolution duly adopted by the affirmative vote of not less than three-quarters of the entire membership of the Board at a meeting of the Board or, if the Company is not the ultimate parent corporation of its affiliated companies and is not publicly-traded, the ultimate parent of the Company (excluding the Executive, if the Executive is a member of such board) at a meeting of such board called and held for such purpose (after reasonable notice is provided to the Executive and the Executive is given an opportunity, together with counsel, to be heard before the Board), finding that, in the good faith opinion of the applicable board, the Executive is guilty of the conduct described in subparagraph (i) or (ii) above, and specifying the particulars thereof in detail. (c) Good Reason . The Executive’s employment may be terminated during the Employment Period by the Executive for Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, “Good Reason” shall mean (i) the assignment to the Executive of any duties inconsistent in any respect with the Executive’s position (including status, offices, titles and reporting requirements), authority, duties or responsibilities as contemplated by Section 4(a) of this Agreement, or any other action by the Company which results in a diminution in such position, authority, duties or responsibilities (but not occurring solely as a result of the Company’s ceasing to be a publicly traded entity), excluding for this purpose an isolated, insubstantial and inadvertent action not taken in bad faith and which is remedied by the Company promptly after receipt of notice thereof given by the Executive; (ii) any failure by the Company to comply with any of the provisions of Section 4(b) of this Agreement, other than an isolated, insubstantial and inadvertent failure not occurring in bad faith and which is remedied by the Company promptly after receipt of notice thereof given by the Executive; (iii) the Company’s requiring the Executive (i) to be based at any office or location other than that described in Section 4(a) (i)(B) hereof, (ii) to be based at a location other than the principal executive offices of the Company if the Executive was employed at such location immediately preceding the Effective Date, or (iii) to travel on Company business to a substantially greater extent than required immediately prior to the Effective Date; Agreement; or (iv) any purported termination by the Company of the Executive’s employment otherwise than as expressly permitted by this 7 (v) any failure by the Company or any successor to comply with and satisfy Section 12(c) of this Agreement, provided that such successor has received at least ten days prior written notice from the Company or the Executive of the requirements of Section 12(c) of this Agreement. For purposes of this Section 5(c), any good faith determination of “Good Reason” made by the Executive shall be conclusive. The Executive’s mental or physical incapacity following the occurrence of an event described in above clauses (i) through (v) shall not affect the Executive’s ability to terminate employment for Good Reason. (d) Notice of Termination . Any termination by the Company for Cause, or by the Executive during the Window Period or for Good Reason, shall be communicated by Notice of Termination to the other party hereto given in accordance with Section 13(b) of this Agreement. For purposes of this Agreement, a “Notice of Termination” shall mean a written notice which (i) indicates the specific termination provision in this Agreement relied upon, (ii) to the extent applicable, sets forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances claimed to provide a basis for termination of the Executive’s employment under the provision so indicated and (iii) if the Date of Termination (as defined below) is other than the date of receipt of such notice, specifies the termination date (which date shall be not more than fifteen days after the giving of such notice). The failure by the Executive or the Company to set forth in the Notice of Termination any fact or circumstance which contributes to a showing of Good Reason or Cause, as the case may be, shall not waive any right of the Executive or the Company, respectively, hereunder or preclude the Executive or the Company, respectively, from asserting such fact or circumstance in enforcing the Executive’s or the Company’s rights hereunder. (e) Date of Termination . “Date of Termination” shall mean (i) if the Executive’s employment is terminated by the Company for Cause, or by the Executive during the Window Period or for Good Reason, the date of receipt of the Notice of Termination or any later date specified therein, as the case may be, (ii) if the Executive’s employment is terminated by the Company other than for Cause, Disability or death, the Date of Termination shall be the date on which the Company notifies the Executive of such termination, and (iii) if the Executive’s employment is terminated by reason of death or Disability, the Date of Termination shall be the date of death of the Executive or the Disability Effective Date, as the case may be. 6. Obligations of the Company upon Termination . (a) Good Reason; Other than for Cause or Disability . If, during the Employment Period, the Company shall terminate the Executive’s employment other than for Cause or Disability or the Executive shall terminate employment for Good Reason, the Company shall have the following obligations. aggregate of the following amounts: (i) The Company shall pay to the Executive in a lump sum in cash within 30 days after the Date of Termination the (A) the amount equal to the product of (x) three and (y) the sum of the Executive’s Annual Base Salary and the Executive’s Annual Incentive Award at the target level for the year of termination; provided, however, that such amount shall be paid in lieu of, and the Executive hereby waives the right to receive, any other amount of severance relating to salary or bonus continuation to be received by the Executive upon such termination of employment under any severance plan, policy or arrangement of the Company; and 8 (B) the amount equal to the sum of: (x) the product of (I) the target level Annual Incentive Award that would have been available to the Executive under the applicable incentive plans of the Company and the policies and procedures thereunder for the fiscal year of the Company in which the Change of Control occurs or, if greater, the fiscal year in which the Date of Termination occurs and (II) a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of days in the current fiscal year through the Date of Termination, and the denominator of which is 365; and (y) the product of (I) the target level Long-Term Cash Incentive Award that would have been available to the Executive under the applicable incentive plans of the Company and the policies and procedures thereunder for performance cycles outstanding as of the Date of Termination and (II) a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of days in the applicable Long-Term Cash Incentive Award cycle through the Date of Termination, and the denominator of which is the number of days in such cycle; provided, however, that no payout under this Agreement shall be made which would result in a duplicate payment under the plans governing the Annual Incentive Award and/or the Long-Term Cash Incentive Award for any period for which such plans, by their terms, have resulted in an accelerated payment in the event of a Change of Control; and (C) the amount of the Executive’s Annual Base Salary through the Date of Termination to the extent not theretofore paid and the amount of any compensation previously deferred by the Executive (together with any accrued interest thereon) and not yet paid by the Company and any accrued vacation pay of the Executive not yet paid by the Company. For purposes of this Agreement, the aggregate of the amounts described in clauses (A), (B) and (C) of this Section 6(a) shall hereafter be referred to as the “Special Termination Amount.” The sum of the amounts described in clauses (B) and (C) of this Section 6(a) shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Accrued Obligations”. (ii) For three years after the Date of Termination, or such longer period as may be provided by the terms of the applicable plan, program, practice or policy, the Company shall continue benefits to the Executive and, where applicable, the Executive’s family at least equal to those which would have been provided to them in accordance with the plans, programs, practices and policies described in Section 4 (b)(iv) of this Agreement if the Executive’s employment had not been terminated in accordance with the most favorable plans, practices, programs or policies of the Company and its affiliated companies generally applicable to other peer executives and their families during the 90- day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive, as in effect at any time thereafter generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies and their families (for purposes of determining eligibility of the Executive for retiree benefits pursuant to such plans, practices, programs and policies, the Executive shall be considered to have remained employed until the end of the Employment Period and to have retired on the last day of such period); provided, however, that in the event the Executive becomes reemployed with another employer and is eligible to receive medical or other welfare benefits under any employer provided plan, the medical and other welfare benefits described herein shall not be provided by the Company during such applicable period of eligibility, but shall resume if such period of eligibility shall terminate. 9 (iii) To the extent not theretofore paid or provided, the Company shall timely pay or provide to the Executive any other amounts or benefits required to be paid or provided or which the Executive is eligible to receive under any plan, program, policy or practice or contract or agreement of the Company and its affiliated companies (such other amounts and benefits shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Other Benefits”). (iv) The Company shall, at its sole expense as incurred, provide the Executive with outplacement services the scope and provider of which shall be selected by the Executive in the Executive’s sole discretion, provided that the cost of such outplacement shall not exceed $50,000. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 6(a), to the extent required in order to comply with Section 409A of the Code, amounts and benefits to be paid or provided under this Section 6(a) shall be paid or provided to the Executive on the first business day after the date that is six months following the Date of Termination. To the extent that the benefits to be provided to the Executive under Section 6(a)(ii) are so delayed, the Executive shall be entitled to COBRA continuation coverage under Section 4980B of the Code (“COBRA Coverage”) during such period of delay, and the Company shall reimburse the Executive for any Company portions of such COBRA Coverage in the seventh month following the Date of Termination, (b) Death . If the Executive’s employment is terminated by reason of the Executive’s death during the Employment Period, this Agreement shall terminate without further obligations to the Executive’s legal representatives under this Agreement, other than the payment by the Company of the Special Termination Amount, provided however, that the amount of such payment determined under Section 6(a)(i)(A) shall be adjusted as follows. The amount set forth in clause (A) shall be offset in all cases by the basic life insurance benefit paid or payable in respect of the Executive’s death and, in addition, if the death occurs after the one year anniversary following the Change of Control, it shall be offset by the amount of any salary payments made to the Executive for any periods of employment following the Change of Control. The Special Termination Amount shall be paid to the Executive’s estate or beneficiary, as applicable, in a lump sum in cash within 30 days of the Date of Termination. Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, the Executive’s family shall be entitled to receive benefits at least equal to the most favorable benefits provided generally by the Company and any of its affiliated companies to surviving families of peer executives of the Company and such affiliated companies under such plans, programs, practices and policies relating to family death benefits, if any, as in effect generally with respect to other peer executives and their families at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive and/or the Executive’s family, as in effect on the date of the Executive’s death generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies and their families. (c) Disability . If the Executive’s employment is terminated by reason of the Executive’s Disability during the Employment Period, this Agreement shall terminate without further obligations to the Executive, other than the payment by the Company of the 10 Special Termination Amount. The Special Termination Amount shall be paid to the Executive in a lump sum in cash within 30 days of the Date of Termination. Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, the Executive shall be entitled after the Disability Effective Date to receive disability and other benefits at least equal to the most favorable of those generally provided by the Company and its affiliated companies to disabled executives and/or their families in accordance with such plans, programs, practices and policies relating to disability, if any, as in effect generally with respect to other peer executives and their families at any time during the 90-day period immediately preceding the Effective Date or, if more favorable to the Executive and/or the Executive’s family, as in effect at any time thereafter through the Date of Termination generally with respect to other peer executives of the Company and its affiliated companies and their families. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 6(c), to the extent required in order to comply with Section 409A of the Code, amounts and benefits to be paid or provided under this Section 6(c) shall be paid or provided to the Executive on the first business day after the date that is six months following the Date of Termination. (d) Cause; Other than for Good Reason . If the Executive’s employment shall be terminated for Cause during the Employment Period, this Agreement shall terminate without further obligations to the Executive other than the obligation to pay to the Executive Annual Base Salary through the Date of Termination plus the amount of any compensation previously deferred by the Executive, in each case to the extent theretofore unpaid. If the Executive terminates employment during the Employment Period, excluding a termination for Good Reason, this Agreement shall terminate without further obligations to the Executive, other than for the Accrued Obligations, all of which such Accrued Obligations shall be paid to the Executive in a lump sum in cash within 30 days of the Date of Termination. (e) Rabbi Trust. In the event that the Executive becomes entitled to benefits under Section 6(a) or (c) of this Agreement, the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors shall have the authority to fund a rabbi trust immediately prior to the Change of Control or the applicable Date of Termination in an amount equal to 100 percent of the maximum aggregate benefits payable to the Executive under such Section 6(a) or (c) and any estimated Gross-Up Payment as provided for under Section 9 of this Agreement. 7. Non-exclusivity of Rights . Except as explicitly modified or otherwise explicitly provided by this Agreement, (i) nothing in this Agreement shall prevent or limit the Executive’s continuing or future participation in any benefit, bonus, incentive or other plans, programs, policies or practices provided by the Company or any of its affiliated companies and for which the Executive may qualify, nor shall anything herein limit or otherwise affect such rights as the Executive may have under any other agreements with the Company or any of its affiliated companies and (ii) amounts which are vested benefits or which the Executive is otherwise entitled to receive under any plan, policy, practice or program of the Company or any of its affiliated companies at or subsequent to the Date of Termination shall be payable in accordance with such plan, policy, practice or program except as explicitly modified by this Agreement. 8. Full Settlement . The Company’s obligation to make the payments provided for in this Agreement and otherwise to perform its obligations hereunder shall not be affected by any set-off, counterclaim, recoupment, defense or other claim, right or 11 action which the Company may have against the Executive or others. In no event shall the Executive be obligated to seek other employment or take any other action by way of mitigation of the amounts payable to the Executive under any of the provisions of this Agreement and, except as provided in Section 6(d)(ii) of this Agreement, such amounts shall not be reduced whether or not the Executive obtains other employment. The Company agrees to pay, to the full extent permitted by law, all legal fees and expenses which the Executive may reasonably incur as a result of any contest (regardless of the outcome thereof) by the Company, the Executive or others of the validity or enforceability of, or liability under, any provision of this Agreement or any guarantee of performance thereof (including as a result of any contest by the Executive about the amount of any payment pursuant to this Agreement), plus in each case interest on any delayed payment at the applicable Federal rate provided for in Section 7872(f)(2)(A) of the Code. 9. Certain Additional Payments by the Company . (a) Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, in the event it shall be determined that as a result, directly or indirectly, of any payment or distribution by the Company to or for the benefit of the Executive, whether paid or payable or distributed or distributable pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise (a “Payment”), the Executive would be subject to the excise tax imposed by Section 4999 of the Code or any interest or penalties are incurred by the Executive with respect to such excise tax (such excise tax, together with any such interest and penalties, are hereinafter collectively referred to as the “Excise Tax”), then the Executive shall be entitled to promptly receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment”) in an amount such that after payment by the Executive of all taxes (including any interest or penalties imposed with respect to such taxes), including, without limitation, any income taxes (and any interest and penalties imposed with respect thereto) and Excise Tax imposed upon the Gross-Up Payment, but excluding any income taxes on the Payment, the Executive is in the same after-tax position as if no Excise Tax had been imposed upon the Executive; provided , however , that if the Payment would result in the Executive receiving total “Parachute Payments” within the meaning of Section 280G of the Code, which equal less than one hundred and twenty percent (120%) of the amount that Executive would be entitled to receive without becoming subject to the Excise Tax, but for the application of this sentence, then the Payment shall be reduced to the minimum extent necessary (but in no event to less than zero) so that no portion of any such Payment, as so reduced, constitutes an “Excess Parachute Payment” within the meaning of Section 280G of the Code; provided , furthe r, that the foregoing reduction shall be made only if and to the extent that such reduction would result in an increase in the aggregate Payment to be provided, determined on an after-tax basis (taking into account the Excise Tax imposed, and any applicable federal, state and local income taxes). The fact that the Executive’s right to a Payment may be reduced by reason of the limitations contained in this Section 9(a) shall not of itself limit or otherwise affect any other rights of the Executive other than under this Agreement. In the event that a Payment intended to be provided under this Agreement is required to be reduced pursuant to the proviso to this Section 9(a), the Executive shall be entitled to designate which portion of the Payment will be so reduced in order to give effect to this Section 9(a). The Company shall provide the Executive with all information reasonably requested by the Executive to permit the Executive to make such designation. In the event that the Executive fails to make such designation within 10 business days after the Effective Date of Termination, the Company may effect such reduction in any manner it deems appropriate. 12 (b) Subject to the provisions of Section 9(c), all determinations required to be made under this Section 9, including whether or when a Gross-Up Payment is required and the amount of such Gross-Up Payment and the assumptions to be utilized in arriving at such determinations, shall be made by the accounting firm of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (the “Accounting Firm”) which shall provide detailed supporting calculations both to the Company and the Executive within 15 business days of receipt of notice from the Executive that there has been a Payment or such earlier time as is requested by the Company. In the event that the Accounting Firm is serving as accountant or auditor for the individual, entity or group effecting the Change of Control, the Executive shall appoint another nationally recognized accounting firm to make the determinations required hereunder (which accounting firm shall then be referred to as the Accounting Firm hereunder). All fees and expenses of the Accounting Firm shall be borne solely by the Company. Any Gross-Up Payment, as determined pursuant to this Section 9, shall be paid to the Executive within five days of the receipt of the Accounting Firm’s determination. If the Accounting Firm determines that no Excise Tax is payable by the Executive, it shall furnish the Executive with a written opinion that failure to report the Excise Tax on the Executive’s applicable federal income tax return would not result in the imposition of a negligence or similar penalty. Any determination by the Accounting Firm shall be binding upon the Company and the Executive. As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Code at the time of the initial determination by the Accounting Firm hereunder, it is possible that Gross-Up Payments which will not have been made by the Company should have been made (“Underpayment”), consistent with the calculations required to be made hereunder. In the event that the Company exhausts its remedies pursuant to Section 9(c) and the Executive thereafter is required to make a payment of any Excise Tax, the Accounting Firm shall determine the amount of the Underpayment that has occurred and any such Underpayment shall be promptly paid by the Company to or for the benefit of the Executive. (c) The Executive shall notify the Company in writing of any claim by the Internal Revenue Service that, if successful, would require the payment by the Company of the Gross-Up Payment. Such notification shall be given as soon as practicable but no later than ten business days after the Executive knows of such claim and shall apprise the Company of the nature of such claim and the date on which such claim is requested to be paid. The Executive shall not pay such claim prior to the expiration of the 30-day period following the date on which it gives such notice to the Company (or such shorter period ending on the date that any payment of taxes with respect to such claim is due). If the Company notifies the Executive in writing prior to the expiration of such period that it desires to contest such claim, the Executive shall: (i) give the Company any information reasonably requested by the Company relating to such claim, (ii) take such action in connection with contesting such claim as the Company shall reasonably request in writing from time to time, including, without limitation, accepting legal representation with respect to such claim by an attorney reasonably selected by the Company, 13 (iii) cooperate with the Company in good faith in order effectively to contest such claim, and, (iv) permit the Company to participate in any proceedings relating to such claim; provided, however, that the Company shall bear and pay directly all costs and expenses (including additional interest and penalties) incurred in connection with such contest and shall indemnify and hold the Executive harmless, on an after-tax basis, for any Excise Tax or income tax (including interest and penalties with respect thereto) imposed as a result of such representation and payment of costs and expenses. Without limitation on the foregoing provisions of this Section 9(c), the Company shall control all proceedings taken in connection with such contest and, at its sole option, may pursue or forgo any and all administrative appeals, proceedings, hearings and conferences with the taxing authority in respect of such claim and may, at its sole option, either pay the tax claimed to the appropriate taxing authority on behalf of the Executive and direct the Executive to sue for a refund or contest the claim in any permissible manner, and the Executive agrees to prosecute such contest to a determination before any administrative tribunal, in a court of initial jurisdiction and in one or more appellate courts, as the Company shall determine; provided, however, that if the Company pays such claim and directs the Executive to sue for a refund, the Company shall indemnify and hold the Executive harmless, on an after-tax basis, from any Excise Tax or income tax (including interest or penalties with respect thereto) imposed with respect to such payment or with respect to any imputed income with respect to such payment; and further provided that any extension of the statute of limitations relating to payment of taxes for the taxable year of the Executive with respect to which such contested amount is claimed to be due is limited solely to such contested amount. Furthermore, the Company’s control of the contest shall be limited to issues with respect to which a Gross-Up Payment would be payable hereunder and the Executive shall be entitled to settle or contest, as the case may be, any other issue raised by the Internal Revenue Service or any other taxing authority. (d) If, after the receipt by the Executive of a Gross-Up Payment or payment by the Company of an amount on the Executive’s behalf pursuant to Section 9(c), the Executive becomes entitled to receive any refund with respect to the Excise Tax to which such Gross-Up Payment relates or with respect to such claim, the Executive shall (subject to the Company’s complying with the requirements of Section 9(c)) promptly pay to the Company the amount of such refund (together with any interest paid or credited thereon after taxes applicable thereto). If, after payment by the Company of an amount on the Executive’s behalf pursuant to Section 9(c), a determination is made that the Executive shall not be entitled to any refund with respect to such claim and the Company does not notify the Executive in writing of its intent to contest such denial of refund prior to the expiration of 30 days after such determination, then the amount of such payment shall offset, to the extent thereof, the amount of Gross-Up Payment required to be paid. (e) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 9, the Company may, in its sole discretion, withhold and pay over to the Internal Revenue Service or any other applicable taxing authority, for the benefit of the Executive, all or any portion of any Gross-Up Payment, and the Executive hereby consents to such withholding. 14 10. Confidential Information . The Executive shall hold in a fiduciary capacity for the benefit of the Company all secret or confidential information, knowledge or data relating to the Company or any of its affiliated companies, and their respective businesses, which shall have been obtained by the Executive during the Executive’s employment by the Company or any of its affiliated companies and which shall not be or become public knowledge (other than by acts by the Executive or representatives of the Executive in violation of this Agreement). After termination of the Executive’s employment with the Company, the Executive shall not, without the prior written consent of the Company or as may otherwise be required by law or legal process, communicate or divulge any such information, knowledge or data to anyone other than the Company and those designated by it. In no event shall an asserted violation of the provisions of this Section 10 constitute a basis for deferring or withholding any amounts otherwise payable to the Executive under this Agreement. 11. Section 409A. If any compensation or benefits provided by this Agreement may result in the application of Section 409A of the Code, the Company shall, in consultation with the Executive, modify the Agreement in the least restrictive manner necessary in order to, where applicable, (a) exclude such compensation from the definition of “deferred compensation” within the meaning of such Section 409A or (b) comply with the provisions of Section 409A, other applicable provision(s) of the Code and/or any rules, regulations or other regulatory guidance issued under such statutory provisions and to make such modifications, in each case, without any diminution in the value of the payments to the Executive. 12. Successors . (a) This Agreement is personal to the Executive and without the prior written consent of the Company shall not be assignable by the Executive otherwise than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution. This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be enforceable by the Executive’s legal representatives. (b) This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be binding upon the Company and its successors and assigns. (c) The Company will require any successor (whether direct or indirect, by purchase, merger, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company to assume expressly and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that the Company would be required to perform it if no such succession had taken place. As used in this Agreement, “Company” shall mean the Company as hereinbefore defined and any successor to its business and/or assets as aforesaid which assumes and agrees to perform this Agreement by operation of law, or otherwise. 13. Miscellaneous . (a) This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Delaware, without reference to principles of conflict of laws. The captions of this Agreement are not part of the provisions hereof and shall have no force or effect. This Agreement may not be amended or modified otherwise than by a written agreement executed by the parties hereto or their respective successors and legal representatives. The execution by the Company and the Executive of this Agreement shall automatically supersede and render ineffective any previous agreement covering the same subject matter hereof and such previous agreement shall be deemed terminated in its entirety. 15 (b) All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be given by hand delivery to the other party or by registered or certified mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid, addressed as follows: If to the Executive : c/o Tupperware Brands Corporation 14901 South Orange Blossom Trail Orlando, Florida 32837 If to the Company : Tupperware Brands Corporation 14901 South Orange Blossom Trail Orlando, Florida 32837 Attention: General Counsel Mailing Address : P.O. Box 2353 Orlando, Florida 32802-2353 or to such other address as either party shall have furnished to the other in writing in accordance herewith. Notice and communications shall be effective when actually received by the addressee. (c) The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision of this Agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement. (d) The Company may withhold from any amounts payable under this Agreement such Federal, state or local taxes as shall be required to be withheld pursuant to any applicable law or regulation. (e) The Executive’s or the Company’s failure to insist upon strict compliance with any provision hereof shall not be deemed to be a waiver of such provision or any other provision of this Agreement. (f) The Executive and the Company acknowledge that, except as may otherwise be provided under any other written agreement between the Executive and the Company, the employment of the Executive by the Company is “at will” and, subject to Section 1(a) hereof, prior to the Effective Date, may be terminated by either the Executive or the Company at any time. Moreover, if prior to the Effective Date, the Executive’s employment with the Company terminates, then the Executive shall have no further rights under this Agreement. From and after the Effective Date this Agreement shall supersede any other agreement between the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof. 16 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Executive has hereunto set the Executive’s hand and, pursuant to the authorization from its Board of Directors, the Company has caused these presents to be executed in its name on its behalf, all as of the day and year first above written. (Executive) TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION By 17 TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION 2006 INCENTIVE PLAN NON-QUALIFIED STOCK OPTION GRANT AGREEMENT Exhibit 10.7 Optionee: Number of Shares of Common Stock Subject to Option: Option Price: Date of Grant: Exercise Rights Begin: Dates Extraordinary Exercise Rights: Option Term Expires: Number of Shares Exercisable 1. Option Grant. Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“Tupperware”), pursuant to the Tupperware Brands Corporation 2006 Incentive Plan (the “Plan”), a copy of which is attached, hereby grants to the Optionee as of the Date of Grant an option (the “Stock Option”) to purchase from Tupperware a number of shares of the common stock of Tupperware, $0.01 par value (“Common Stock”), at the Option Price, all as specifically indicated above. The Stock Option is exercisable in accordance with the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Plan. The Optionee shall execute and return this Agreement to Tupperware. If Tupperware determines that any agreement from the Optionee is appropriate in order to comply with any listing, registration or other legal requirement, the Optionee shall execute and deliver such agreement to Tupperware. All determinations and interpretations made by Tupperware in connection with any question arising under this Agreement or the Plan are binding and conclusive upon the Optionee or his or her legal representative. If there is any conflict between the provisions of this Agreement and the Plan, the Plan shall control. Capitalized terms used and not defined in this Agreement have the meanings given to them in the Plan. 2. Term and Exercise Period. The Stock Option becomes exercisable as set forth above. Any portion of the Stock Option which becomes exercisable continues to be exercisable, until exercised, during the Option Term, except as stated below. The Option Term means the period which begins on the date the Exercise Rights Begin and ends on the date the Option Term Expires, except as may otherwise be set forth in this Agreement. 3. Exercise Procedure. To exercise the Stock Option, the Optionee shall deliver a notice to Tupperware specifying the number of shares to be purchased, and include payment in full, or arrangements satisfactory to Tupperware for payment in full of the Option Price for such shares. Tupperware shall make available to the Optionee a form or electronic process that may be used for this purpose. The date of exercise shall be the date on which such notice and payment, or arrangements satisfactory to Tupperware for payment, are received by Tupperware. 4. Payment of the Option Price. As provided under Article 6, Section 6.4 of the Plan, payment of the Option Price for the number of shares to be purchased shall be made; (i) in cash (including a check, bank draft, money order or wire transfer); (ii) by delivery or certification to Tupperware of shares of Common Stock having a fair market value at least equal to the Option Price for such unrestricted Shares already owned by the Optionee of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option (based on the Fair Market Value of the Shares on the date the Stock Option is exercised) and, unless such Shares were acquired in the open market, held for a period of not less than 6 months prior to the exercise of the Stock Option; or (iii) by any combination of cash and such shares of Common Stock. 5. Delivery of Certificate(s). Upon any exercise of the Stock Option, and subject to the payment of the Option Price under Section 4 of this Agreement and of all tax obligations under Section 6 of this Agreement, Tupperware shall deliver the shares purchased in book entry form. The shares shall be registered in the name of the Optionee, the Optionee’s transferee, or if the Optionee so requests, in writing at the time of exercise, jointly in the name of the Optionee and another person with rights of survivorship. If the Optionee dies, the shares shall be registered in the name of the person entitled to exercise the Stock Option in accordance with the Plan. 6. Tax Consequences. To the extent that the grant, exercise or other event of the Stock Option results in a tax obligation, the Optionee shall deliver to Tupperware the amount of money or shares as Tupperware may require to meet its withholding obligation under applicable tax laws or regulations. Similarly, the Optionee shall execute any forms or documents necessary for the Company to meet its financial or reporting requirements relating to the Grant. The Optionee may pay this amount by any of the forms permitted under Section 4 above. In lieu of a cash payment of such amount, Tupperware shall have the right to retain, or sell without notice, a sufficient number of such shares to cover the amount required to be withheld. The Optionee shall review with the Optionee’s own tax advisors the federal, state, local and/or foreign tax consequences of this investment and the transactions contemplated by this Agreement. The Optionee shall rely solely on such advisors and not on any statements or representations of Tupperware or any of its agents. The Optionee understands that the Optionee (and not Tupperware) shall be responsible for the Optionee’s own tax liability that may arise as a result of this investment or the transactions contemplated by the Agreement. 7. Notices. All notices hereunder to Tupperware shall be delivered or mailed to the Corporate Secretary of Tupperware at its headquarters office. All notices hereunder to the Optionee shall be delivered in writing either electronically or mailed to the Optionee’s address indicated below, unless the Optionee notifies Tupperware in writing of a change of address. 8. Assumption of Risk. It is expressly understood and agreed that the Optionee assumes all risks incident to any change hereafter in applicable laws or regulations, or incident to any change in the market value of the Common Stock after the exercise of this option in whole or in part. 9. Impact of Certain Events. Upon the Optionee’s death, Disability, retirement or termination, or upon a Change of Control, the Optionee shall have such modified rights of vesting and exercisability as set forth on Exhibit A attached hereto. 10. Data Transfer and Privacy. To administer this Plan, the Optionee must provide Tupperware with personal data to identify him or her, including name and address. The personal data will be transferred to Tupperware’s U.S. headquarters in Orlando, Florida, and processed there. Tupperware may transfer the personal data to an outside vendor (such as a bank) for further processing. By signing below, the Optionee explicitly consents to this collection, transfer and processing, as necessary for operation of this Plan. During each of these steps, Tupperware treats personal data with care to ensure its privacy and ensure that any outside vendors do the same. For European Union residents, the data is treated in accordance with Tupperware’s European Union Data Transfer Policy. 11. Recovery of Award. In the event of any restatement of Tupperware’s financials statements (“Restatement”) resulting from the error, omission, fraud or other misconduct of an Optionee, any previous delivery of common stock of Tupperware, or a grant of a Stock Option which was made to the Optionee, shall be subject to recovery and/or cancellation by Tupperware as the Compensation Committee (the “Committee”) of the Board of Directors, in its sole discretion, shall in good faith determine. Tupperware may recover all or a portion of any award made to the Optionee with respect to a fiscal year of Tupperware when the financial results of a Restatement negatively affect the financial statements of Tupperware. The Committee may determine: (i) the amount to be recovered and/or cancelled; (ii) to recover different amounts from different Optionees or different classes of Optionees on such basis as it deems appropriate; (iii) whether to seek repayment from a Optionee or to reduce an amount otherwise payable to a Optionee under any compensation, plan, program or arrangement maintained by Tupperware, including the use of set off, subject to applicable law; (iv) the valuation of any shares of common stock determined to be withheld from a Optionee in connection with such an action; and (v) whether to cancel outstanding Stock Options in connection with such an action and the valuation thereof for such purpose. 12. Capitalized Terms. Unless otherwise defined in this Agreement, all capitalized terms used herein or in any exhibit hereto shall have such definitions as set forth in the Plan. The parties confirm this Agreement effective as of the Date of Grant and have executed it on , 200 . Tupperware Brands Corporation Thomas M. Roehlk Executive Vice President, Chief Legal Officer & Secretary Optionee (Please sign and date form. Type or print address.) Signature Street Address (Home) City State Postal Code Country Exhibit A Impact of Certain Events Death If the Optionee’s employment terminates by reason of death, the Stock Option shall become immediately and fully exercisable and may thereafter be exercised by the estate of the Optionee for a period of three years from the date of such death; provided, however, that if the Optionee is at least sixty years of age at the time of death and has fifteen years service with the Company, the Stock Option may thereafter be exercised by the estate of the Optionee for a period of six years from the date of such death. In no event, however, may the Stock Option be exercisable beyond the end of the Option Term. Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, if the Optionee dies after termination of the Optionee’s employment, the Stock Option may thereafter be exercised, to the extent the Stock Option was exercisable as of the date of such death, for a period that expires on the earliest of (i) the first anniversary of the date of such death, (ii) the last date on which the Optionee would have been entitled to exercise the Stock Option had the Optionee not died or (iii) the end of the Option Term; provided, however, that if the Optionee had retired from the Company prior to the date of death, the estate of the Optionee shall continue to have the benefit of the vesting and exercisability benefits specified by the provisions governing retirement as set forth below. Disability If the Optionee’s employment terminates by reason of Disability, the Stock Option, if not fully vested and exercisable as of the date of such termination, shall continue to vest according to the Stock Option’s stated vesting schedule and may thereafter be exercised by the Optionee, to the extent it was exercisable at the time of termination or thereafter becomes exercisable, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, for a period of three years from the date of such termination of employment or until the end of the Option Term, whichever period is the shorter; provided, however, that if the Optionee dies within such period, the Stock Option shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the Option Term, whichever period is the shortest. Retirement If the Optionee’s employment terminates by reason of retirement, the following vesting and exercisability terms will apply. The Optionee shall be deemed to have terminated employment by reason of retirement if the Optionee has attained age and years of service requirements set forth below, has given due notice (as determined by the Committee), and has entered into an agreement, the form and content of which shall be specified by the Committee, not to compete with the Company and its Affiliates for a period of one year following such retirement. In no event, however, may the Stock Option be exercisable after the end of the Option Term. Age at Retirement 55 or more 60 or more Minimum Years of Service with Company 10 15 Years of Continued Vesting Following Retirement 1 6 Years of Continued Exercisability Following Retirement 2 6 Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the Optionee dies within such period of continued exercisability, the Stock Option shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the end of the Option Term, whichever period is the shortest. Termination for Cause Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if the Optionee incurs a termination of employment for Cause, the Stock Option shall thereupon terminate. Other Termination If the Optionee incurs a voluntary termination of employment, the Stock Option, to the extent then exercisable, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, may be exercised for the lesser of thirty days from the date of such termination of employment or until the end of the Option Term. If the Optionee incurs a termination of employment by the Company, other than by reason of retirement, Disability or Cause, the Stock Option, to the extent it is then exercisable, or becomes exercisable during the one-year period following termination of employment by the Company, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, may be exercised at any time from the date of vesting until the first anniversary of the date of such termination of employment or, if sooner, the end of the Option Term; provided, however, that if the Optionee dies within such period of post-termination exercisability, the Stock Option shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the Option Term, whichever period is the shortest. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Optionee incurs a termination of employment after a Change of Control, the Stock Option shall remain exercisable, to the extent it was exercisable immediately before such termination, through the end of the Option Term. TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION 2006 INCENTIVE PLAN RESTRICTED STOCK AGREEMENT Recipient: Number of Shares: Date of Award: Restricted Period Ends: 1. Restricted Stock Award. Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“Tupperware”), pursuant to the Tupperware Brands Corporation 2006 Incentive Plan (the “Plan”), a copy of which is attached, hereby awards to the Recipient as of the Date of Award an award of a number of shares of common stock of Tupperware, $0.01 par value (“Shares”), all as specifically indicated above. The award is subject to the terms, conditions and restrictions of this Agreement and the Plan. The Recipient shall execute and return to Tupperware this Agreement and the stock power described in Paragraph 4 of this Agreement. All determinations and interpretations made by Tupperware in connection with any question arising under this Agreement or the Plan are binding and conclusive upon the Recipient or his or her legal representative. 2. Restrictions on Shares and Impact of Termination. The Restricted Period (as defined in Article 8 of the Plan) applicable to any Shares begins on the Date of Award and ends on the date the Restricted Period Ends, as set forth above, except as otherwise provided in Article 8 of the Plan. In the event of a Change of Control (as defined in Article 2 of the Plan), all restrictions shall lapse immediately in accordance with Article 15 of the Plan, as may be amended from time to time by the Board of Directors of Tupperware. If the Recipient dies while employed by Tupperware or a Subsidiary (as defined in Article 2 of the Plan), the restrictions shall lapse on the date of death. If the Recipient incurs a termination of employment for Cause, the Restricted Stock Award shall thereupon terminate. Except to the extent otherwise provided in Article 15.1(b) of the Plan, in the event that the Recipient is involuntarily terminated (other than for Cause), the Committee shall have the discretion to waive, in whole or in part, any or all remaining restrictions with respect to any or all such Recipient’s shares of Restricted Stock. Upon a Recipient’s termination of employment for any reason during the Restricted Period, except to the extent otherwise provided by the Committee, in this Agreement and in Article 15.1(b) of the Plan, all Shares still subject to restriction shall be forfeited by the Recipient, including in the event of retirement prior to the end of the Restricted Period. 3. Stockholder Rights. During the Restricted Period, the Recipient shall have all of the rights of a stockholder of Tupperware, including the right to receive dividends and the right to vote, except as otherwise set forth in this Agreement or in Article 8 of the Plan. 4. Issuance and Possession of Stock Certificates During Restricted Period. Shares will be issued and registered in certificate form or, if Tupperware so permits, book entry form, in the name of the Recipient in the stockholder records of Tupperware. The Recipient shall deliver to Tupperware the Recipient’s blank endorsement of a stock power. Such certificates will be held by Tupperware or its agent until the restrictions lapse or such Shares are forfeited in accordance with the Plan. 5. Adjustments to Shares. Recipient agrees to deliver to Tupperware any new or additional shares (or certificates representing stock or other securities), which he or she may receive during the Restricted Period with respect to the Shares (“Other Certificates”), together with a blank endorsement of a stock power. All such Shares or other securities will be subject to the same restrictions during the Restricted Period as the Shares. Other Certificates will be held by Tupperware or its agent. 6. Delivery of Shares. Subject to the payment of tax obligations under Section 7 of this Agreement, Tupperware will deliver or cause to be delivered Shares evidenced by a direct registration account statement of the shares in book entry form, and any Other Certificates at the end of the Restricted Period, and will deliver them to the Recipient or Recipient’s transferee free of the restrictions imposed by the Plan or this Agreement. 7. Tax Consequences. To the extent that the receipt of the Restricted Shares or the termination of the Restricted Period with respect to any Shares results in a tax obligation, the Recipient shall deliver to the Company at the time of such receipt or lapse on the restrictions, as the case may be, such amount of money or shares of unrestricted stock as the Company may require to meet its withholding obligation under applicable tax laws or regulations. Similarly, the Recipient shall execute any forms or documents necessary for the Company to meet its financial or reporting requirements relating to this Award. In lieu of a cash payment of such amount, the Company shall have the right to retain, or sell without notice, a sufficient number of the Shares or such other Shares or securities represented by Other Certificates to cover the amount required to be withheld. The Recipient acknowledges by his or her signature below that he or she should review with the Recipient’s own tax advisors the federal, state, local and/or foreign tax consequences of this investment and the transactions contemplated by this Agreement. The Recipient shall rely solely on such advisors and not on any statements or representations of the Company or any of its agents. The Recipient understands that the Recipient (and not the Company) shall be responsible for the Recipient’s own tax liability that may arise as a result of this investment or the transactions contemplated by this Agreement. 8. Notices. All notices hereunder to Tupperware shall be delivered or mailed to the Corporate Secretary of Tupperware at its headquarters office. All notices hereunder to the Recipient shall be delivered in writing, either electronically or mailed to the Recipient’s address indicated below, unless the Recipient notifies Tupperware in writing of a change of address. 9. Data Transfer and Privacy. To administer this Plan, the Recipient must provide Tupperware with personal data to identify him or her, including name and address. The personal data will be transferred to Tupperware’s U.S. headquarters in Orlando, Florida, and processed there. Tupperware may transfer the personal data to an outside vendor (such as a bank) for further processing. By signing below, the Recipient explicitly consents to this collection, transfer and processing, as necessary for operation of this Plan. During each of these steps, Tupperware treats personal data with care to ensure its privacy, and ensure that any outside vendors do the same. For European Union residents, the data is treated in accordance with Tupperware’s European Union Data Transfer Policy. 10. Recovery of Award. In the event of any restatement of Tupperware’s financial statements (“Restatement”) resulting from the error, omission, fraud or other misconduct of the Recipient, any previous delivery of common stock of Tupperware, including dividends declared thereon and paid, or a grant of an award which was made to the Recipient, shall be subject to recovery and/or cancellation by Tupperware as the Compensation Committee (the “Committee”) of the Board of Directors, in its sole discretion, shall in good faith determine. Tupperware may recover all or a portion of any award made to the Recipient with respect to a fiscal year of Tupperware when the financial results of a Restatement negatively affect the financial statements of Tupperware. The Committee may determine: (i) the amount to be recovered and/or cancelled; (ii) to recover different amounts from different Recipients or different classes of Recipients on such basis as it deems appropriate; (iii) whether to seek repayment from a Recipient or to reduce an amount otherwise payable to a Recipient under any compensation, plan, program or arrangement maintained by Tupperware, including the use of set off, subject to applicable law; (iv) the valuation of any shares of common stock determined to be withheld from a Recipient in connection with such an action; and (v) whether to cancel outstanding awards in connection with such an action and the valuation thereof for such purpose. The parties confirm this Agreement effective as of the Date of Award and have executed it on , 20 . Tupperware Brands Corporation Thomas M. Roehlk Executive Vice President, Chief Legal Officer & Secretary Recipient (Please sign and date form. Type or print address.) Signature Street Address (Home) City State/Province Postal Code Country Exhibit 10.11 TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION 2000 INCENTIVE PLAN (As amended May 11, 2000, August 10, 2000, November 2, 2006 and December 14, 2006)) Article 1. Establishment, Purpose, and Duration 1.1 Establishment of the Plan. Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation (hereinafter referred to as the “Company”), hereby establishes an incentive compensation plan to be known as the “Tupperware Brands Corporation 2000 Incentive Plan” (hereinafter referred to as the “Plan”), as set forth in this document. The Plan permits the grant of Non-Qualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, Stock Appreciation Rights, Restricted Stock, and Performance Awards. The Plan shall become effective as of the Effective Date, and shall remain in effect as provided in Section 1.3 herein. 1.2 Purpose of the Plan. The purpose of the Plan is to promote the success and enhance the value of the Company by linking the personal interests of Participants to those of the Company’s stockholders and by providing Participants with an incentive for outstanding performance. The Plan is further intended to provide flexibility to the Company in its ability to motivate, attract, and retain the services of Participants upon whose judgment, interest, and special efforts the successful conduct of its operations largely is dependent. 1.3 Duration of the Plan. The Plan shall commence on the Effective Date and shall remain in effect, subject to the right of the Board of Directors to terminate, amend or modify the Plan at any time pursuant to Article 14 herein, until all Shares subject to it shall have been purchased or acquired according to the Plan’s provisions. However, in no event may an Award be granted under the Plan on or after May 11, 2010. Article 2. Definitions Whenever used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below and, when the meaning is intended, the initial letter of the word is capitalized: (a) “Award” means, individually or collectively, a grant under this Plan of Non-Qualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock, or Performance Awards. (b) “Award Agreement” means an agreement entered into by each Participant and the Company, setting forth the terms and provisions applicable to Awards granted to Participants under this Plan. (c) “Beneficial Owner” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Rule 13d-3 of the General Rules and Regulations under the Exchange Act. (d) “Beneficiary” means a person who may be designated by a Participant pursuant to Article 10 and to whom any benefit under the Plan is to be paid in case of the Participant’s death or physical or mental incapacity, as determined by the Committee, before he or she receives any or all of such benefit. (e) “Board” or “Board of Directors” means the Board of Directors of the Company. (f) “Cause” means (i) conviction of a Participant for committing a felony under federal law or the laws of the state in which such action occurred, (ii) dishonesty in the course of fulfilling a Participant’s employment duties or (iii) willful and deliberate failure on the part of a Participant to perform his employment duties in any material respect, or such other events as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee shall have the sole discretion to determine whether “Cause” exists, and its determination shall be final. 1 (g) “Change of Control” of the Company means: i. An acquisition by any Person of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 20% or more of either (1) the then outstanding Shares (the “Outstanding Company Common Stock”) or (2) the combined voting power of the then outstanding Shares entitled to vote generally in the election of directors (the “Outstanding Company Voting Securities”); excluding, however, the following: (1) any acquisition directly from the Company, other than an acquisition by virtue of the exercise of a conversion privilege unless the security being so converted was itself acquired from the Company, (2) any acquisition by the Company, (3) any acquisition by any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or (4) any acquisition by any Person pursuant to a transaction which complies with clauses (1), (2) and (3) of subsection (iii) of this definition; or ii. A change in the composition of the Board such that the individuals who, as of the effective date of the Plan, constitute the Board (such Board shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Incumbent Board”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board; provided, however, for purposes of this definition, that any individual who becomes a member of the Board subsequent to such effective date, whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of those individuals who are members of the Board and who were also members of the Incumbent Board (or deemed to be such pursuant to this proviso) shall be considered as though such individual were a member of the Incumbent Board; but, provided further, that any such individual whose initial assumption of office occurs as a result of either an actual or threatened election contest (as such terms are used in Rule 14a-11 of Regulation 14A promulgated under the Exchange Act) or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a person or legal entity other than the Board shall not be so considered as a member of the Incumbent Board; or iii. The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a reorganization, merger or consolidation or sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company or the acquisition of assets of another corporation (“Corporate Transaction”) or, if consummation of such Corporate Transaction is subject, at the time of such approval by stockholders, to the consent of any government or governmental agency, the obtaining of such consent (either explicitly or implicitly by consummation); excluding, however, such a Corporate Transaction pursuant to which (1) all or substantially all of the individuals and entities who are the Beneficial Owners, respectively, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction will beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than 60% of, respectively, the outstanding Shares, and the combined voting power of the then outstanding Shares entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, as the case may be, of the Company resulting from such Corporate Transaction (including, without limitation, a corporation which as a result of such transaction owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) in substantially the same proportions as their ownership, immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities, as the case may be, (2) no Person (other than the Company, any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or such corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction) will beneficially own, directly or indirectly, 20% or more of, respectively, the outstanding shares of common stock of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction or the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of such corporation 2 entitled to vote generally in the election of directors except to the extent that such ownership existed with respect to the Company prior to the Corporate Transaction and (3) individuals who were members of the Incumbent Board will constitute at least a majority of the board of directors of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction; or iv. The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company. (h) “Change of Control Price” means the higher of (i) the highest reported sales price, regular way, of a share of Common Stock in any transaction reported on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or other national exchange on which such shares are listed or on NASDAQ during the 60-day period prior to and including the date of a Change of Control or (ii) if the Change of Control is the result of a tender or exchange offer or a Corporate Transaction, the highest price per share of Common Stock paid in such tender or exchange offer or Corporate Transaction; provided, however, that (x) in the case of a Stock Option which (A) is held by an optionee who is an officer or director of the Corporation and is subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act and (B) was granted within 240 days of the Change of Control, then the Change of Control Price for such Stock Option shall be the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock on the date such Stock Option is exercised or deemed exercised and (y) in the case of Incentive Stock Options and Stock Appreciation Rights relating to Incentive Stock Options, the Change of Control Price shall be in all cases the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock on the date such Incentive Stock Option or Stock Appreciation Right is exercised. To the extent that the consideration paid in any such transaction described above consists all or in part of securities or other noncash consideration, the value of such securities or other noncash consideration shall be determined in the sole discretion of the Board. (i) “Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time. (j) “Commission” means the Securities and Exchange Commission or any successor agency. (k) “Committee” means the committee described in Article 3 or (unless otherwise stated) its designee pursuant to a delegation by the Committee as contemplated by Section 3.3. (l) “Company” means Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation, or any successor thereto as provided in Article 16 herein. (m) “Covered Employee” has the meaning ascribed thereto in Section 162(m) of the Code and the regulations thereunder. (n) “Director” means any individual who is a member of the Board of Directors of the Company. (o) “Disinterested Person” means a member of the Board who qualifies as a disinterested person as defined in Rule 16b-3(c)(2), as promulgated by the Commission under the Exchange Act, or any successor definition adopted by the Commission. (p) “Effective Date” means May 11, 2000. (q) “Employee” means any nonunion employee of the Company or of the Company’s Subsidiaries. Directors who are not otherwise employed by the Company shall not be considered Employees under this Plan. (r) “Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time, or any successor Act thereto. 3 (s) “Fair Market Value” means, except as expressly provided otherwise, as of any given date, the closing sales price of the Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or, if not listed on such exchange, on any other national securities exchange on which the Common Stock is listed or on NASDAQ. If there is no regular public trading market for such Common Stock, the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock shall be determined by the Committee in good faith. (t) “Freestanding SAR” means an SAR that is granted independently of any Options pursuant to Section 7.1 herein. (u) “Incentive Stock Option” or “ISO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is designated as an Incentive Stock Option and is intended to meet the requirements of Section 422 of the Code. (v) “Insider” shall mean an Employee who is, on the relevant date, an officer, director, or ten percent (10%) beneficial owner of the Company, as defined under Section 16 of the Exchange Act. (w) “Non-Qualified Stock Option” or “NQSO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is not intended to be an Incentive Stock Option. (x) “Option” means an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-Qualified Stock Option. (y) “Option Price” means the price at which a Share may be purchased by a Participant pursuant to an Option, as determined by the Committee. (z) “Participant” means an Employee of the Company who has been granted an Award under the Plan. (aa) “Performance Award” means an Award granted to an Employee, as described in Article 9 herein, including Performance Units and Performance Shares. (ab) “Performance Goals” means the performance goals established by the Committee prior to the grant of Performance Awards that are based on the attainment of one or any combination of the following: specified levels of net income or earnings per share from continuing operations, operating income, revenues, return on operating assets, return on equity, stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation) and/or total stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation and/or dividend growth), achievement of cost control, working capital turns, cash flow, net income, economic value added, segment profit, sales force growth, or stock price of the Company or such subsidiary, division or department of the Company for or within which the Participant is primarily employed and that are intended to qualify under Section 162(m) (4) (c) of the Code. Such Performance Goals also may be based upon the attaining of specified levels of Company performance under one or more of the measures described above relative to the performance of other corporations. Such Performance Goals shall be set by the Committee within the time period prescribed by Section 162(m) of the Code and related regulations. (ac) “Performance Period” means a time period during which Performance Goals established in connection with Performance Awards must be met. (ad) “Performance Unit” means an Award granted to an Employee, as described in Article 9 herein. (ae) “Performance Share” means an Award granted to an Employee, as described in Article 9 herein. 4 (af) “Restriction Period” or “Period” means the period or periods during which the transfer of Shares of Restricted Stock is limited based on the passage of time and the continuation of service with the Company and the Shares are subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture, as provided in Article 8 herein. (ag) “Person” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 3(a) (9) of the Exchange Act and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof, including a “group” as defined in Section 13(d). (ah) “Restricted Stock” means an Award granted to a Participant pursuant to Article 8 herein. (ai) “Share” means a share of common stock of the Company. (aj) “Subsidiary” or “Subsidiaries” means any corporation or corporations in which the Company owns directly, or indirectly through subsidiaries, at least fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock, or any other entity (including, but not limited to, partnerships and joint ventures) in which the Company owns at least fifty percent (50%) of the combined equity thereof. (ak) “Stock Appreciation Right” or “SAR” means an Award, granted alone (Freestanding SAR) or in connection with a related Option (Tandem SAR), designated as an SAR, pursuant to the terms of Article 7 herein. (al) “Tandem SAR” means an SAR that is granted in connection with a related Option pursuant to Section 7.1 herein, the exercise of which shall require forfeiture of the right to purchase a Share under the related Option (and when a Share is purchased under the Option, the Tandem SAR shall similarly be cancelled). Article 3. Administration 3.1 The Committee . The Plan shall be administered by the Compensation and Directors Committee or such other committee of the Board as the Board may from time to time designate (the “Committee”), which shall be composed of not less than two Disinterested Persons each of whom shall be an “outside director” for purposes of Section 162(m)(4) of the Code, and shall be appointed by and serve at the pleasure of the Board. 3.2 Authority of the Committee . The Committee shall have plenary authority to grant Awards pursuant to the terms of the Plan to officers and employees of the Company and its subsidiaries and Affiliates. Among other things, the Committee shall have the authority, subject to the terms of the Plan: (a) To select the officers and employees to whom Awards may from time to time be granted; (b) To determine whether and to what extent Incentive Stock Options, Non-Qualified Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock and Performance Awards or any combination thereof are to be granted hereunder; (c) To determine the number of Shares to be covered by each Award granted hereunder; (d) To determine the terms and conditions of any Award granted hereunder (including, but not limited to, the option price (subject to Section 6.4 (a)), any vesting condition, restriction or limitation (which may be related to the performance of the Participant, the Company or any subsidiary or Affiliate) and any vesting acceleration or forfeiture waiver regarding any Award and the Shares relating thereto, based on such factors as the Committee shall determine; 5 (e) To modify, amend or adjust the terms and conditions of any Award, at any time or from time to time, including but not limited to Performance Goals, unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments; and (f) To determine to what extent and under what circumstances Shares and other amounts payable with respect to an Award shall be deferred. The Committee shall have the authority to adopt, alter and repeal such administrative rules, guidelines and practices governing the Plan as it shall from time to time deem advisable, to interpret the terms and provisions of the Plan and any Award issued under the Plan (and any agreement relating thereto) and to otherwise supervise the administration of the Plan. 3.3 Action of the Committee. The Committee may act only by a majority of its members then in office, except that the members thereof may (i) delegate to an officer of the Company the authority to make decisions pursuant to Section 6.4, provided that no such delegation may be made that would cause Awards or other transactions under the Plan to cease either to be exempt from Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act or to qualify as “qualified performance-based compensation” as such term is defined in the regulations promulgated under Section 162(m) of the Code, and (ii) authorize any one or more of their number or any officer of the Company to execute and deliver documents on behalf of the Committee. 3.4 Decisions Binding. Any determination made by the Committee or pursuant to delegated authority pursuant to the provisions of the Plan with respect to any Award shall be made in the sole discretion of the Committee or such delegate at the time of the grant of the Award or, unless in contravention of any express term of the Plan, at any time thereafter. All decisions made by the Committee or any appropriately delegated officer pursuant to the provisions of the Plan shall be final and binding on all persons, including the Company and Plan Participants. Article 4. Shares Subject to the Plan 4.1 Number of Shares. Subject to adjustment as provided in Section 4.3 herein, the total number of Shares available for grant under the Plan shall be four million (4,000,000); provided, however, the total number of available Shares that may be used for Restricted Stock Awards under the Plan shall be limited to two hundred thousand (200,000) and the total amount of available Shares that may be used for Performance Awards under the Plan shall be limited to four hundred thousand (400,000) shares. No Participant may be granted (i) a Stock Option in any one year covering in excess of 600,000 Shares, or (ii) a Performance Share Award in any one year in excess of 100,000 Shares. Shares subject to an Award under the Plan may be authorized and unissued shares or may be treasury shares. The following rules will apply for purposes of the determination of the number of Shares available for grant under the Plan: (a) While an Award is outstanding, it shall be counted against the authorized pool of Shares, regardless of its vested status. (b) The grant of an Option, or Restricted Stock or Performance Award involving Shares shall reduce the Shares available for grant under the Plan by the number of Shares subject to such Award. (c) The grant of a Tandem SAR shall not reduce the number of Shares available for grant by the number of Shares subject to the related Option (i.e., there is no double counting of Options and their related Tandem SARs). 6 (d) The grant of a Freestanding SAR shall reduce the number of Shares available for grant by the number of Freestanding SARs granted. (e) The Committee shall reduce the appropriate number of Shares from the authorized pool where a Performance Award is payable in Shares. 4.2 Lapsed Awards. If any Award granted under this Plan is cancelled, forfeited, terminates, expires, or lapses for any reason (with the exception of the termination of a Tandem SAR upon exercise of the related Option or the termination of a related Option upon exercise of the corresponding Tandem SAR), any Shares subject to such Award again shall be available for the grant of an Award under the Plan. However, in the event that prior to the Award’s cancellation, forfeiture, termination, expiration, or lapse, the holder of the Award at any time received one or more “benefits of ownership” pursuant to such Award (as defined by the Commission, pursuant to any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 or any successor rule of the Exchange Act), the Shares subject to such Award shall not be made available for regrant under the Plan to Insiders, but shall be available for regrants under the Plan to Participants who are not Insiders. 4.3 Adjustments in Authorized Shares and Prices. In the event of any change in corporate capitalization, such as a stock split or a corporate transaction, such as any merger, consolidation, separation, including a spin-off, or other distribution of stock or property of the Company, any reorganization (whether or not such reorganization comes within the definition of such term in Section 368 of the Code) or any partial or complete liquidation of the Company, the Committee or Board may make such substitution or adjustments in the aggregate number and class of shares reserved for issuance under the Plan, in the number, kind and option price of shares subject to outstanding Stock Options or SARs, in the number and kind of shares subject to other outstanding Awards granted under the Plan or subject to limitations such as Restricted Stock Awards or per-Participant maximum awards and/or such other equitable substitution or adjustments as it may determine to be appropriate in its sole discretion; provided, however, that the number of shares subject to any Award shall always be a whole number; and provided further, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of a change in capitalization that is the result of an equity restructuring which is not the consequence of a corporate transaction with a third-party, such substitutions or adjustments shall be required to be made. Such adjusted option price shall also be used to determine the amount payable by the Company upon the exercise of any Tandem SAR. Article 5. Eligibility and Participation 5.1 Eligibility. Persons eligible to be granted Awards under this Plan include all Employees of the Company and its Subsidiaries, as determined by the Committee, including Employees who are members of the Board, but excluding Directors who are not Employees. 5.2 Actual Participation. Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Committee may, from time to time, select from all eligible Employees, those to whom Awards shall be granted and shall determine the nature and amount of each Award. Article 6. Stock Options 6.1 Grant of Options. Stock Options may be granted alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan and may be of two types: Incentive Stock Options and Non-Qualified Stock Options. Any Stock Option granted under the Plan shall be in such form as the Committee may from time to time approve. The Committee shall have the authority to grant any optionee Incentive Stock Options, Non- Qualified Stock Options or both types of Stock Options (in each case with or without Stock Appreciation Rights); provided, however, that grants hereunder are subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4. Incentive Stock Options may be granted only to employees of the Company and any “subsidiary corporation” (as such term is defined 7 in Section 424(f) of the Code). To the extent that any Stock Option is not designated as an Incentive Stock Option or even if so designated does not qualify as an Incentive Stock Option, it shall constitute a Non-Qualified Stock Option. 6.2 Award Agreement. Stock Options shall be evidenced by option agreements, the terms and provisions of which may differ. An option agreement shall indicate on its face whether it is intended to be an agreement for an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-Qualified Stock Option. The grant of a Stock Option shall occur on the date the Committee by resolution selects an individual to be a Participant in any grant of a Stock Option, determines the number of Shares to be subject to such Stock Option to be granted to such individual and specifies the terms and provisions of the Stock Option, or such later date as the Committee designates. The Company shall notify a Participant of any grant of a Stock Option, and a written option agreement or agreements shall be duly executed and delivered by the Company to the Participant. Such agreement or agreements shall become effective upon execution by the Company and the Participant. 6.3 Incentive Stock Options. Anything in the Plan to the contrary notwithstanding, no term of the Plan relating to Incentive Stock Options shall be interpreted, amended or altered nor shall any discretion or authority granted under the Plan be exercised so as to disqualify the Plan under Section 422 of the Code or, without the consent of the optionee affected, to disqualify any Incentive Stock Option under such Section 422. 6.4 Terms and Conditions. Stock Options granted under the Plan shall be subject to the following terms and conditions and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (a) Option Price . The option price per Share purchasable under a Stock Option shall be determined by the Committee and set forth in the option agreement, and shall not be less than the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Stock Option on the date of grant. Options may not be repriced without shareholder approval. (b) Option Term . The term of each Stock Option shall be fixed by the Committee, but no Incentive Stock Option shall be exercisable more than 10 years after the date the Stock Option is granted. (c) Exercisability . Except as otherwise provided herein, Stock Options shall be exercisable at such time or times and subject to such terms and conditions as shall be determined by the Committee. If the Committee provides that any Stock Option is exercisable only in installments, the Committee may at any time waive such installment exercise provisions, in whole or in part, based on such factors as the Committee may determine. In addition, the Committee may at any time accelerate the exercisability of any Stock Option. (d) Method of Exercise . Subject to the provisions of this Article 6, Stock Options may be exercised, in whole or in part, at any time during the option term by giving written notice of exercise to the Company specifying the number of Shares subject to the Stock Option to be purchased. Such notice shall be accompanied by payment in full of the purchase price by certified or bank check or such other instrument as the Company may accept. If approved by the Committee, payment, in full or in part, may also be made in the form of delivery of unrestricted Shares already owned by the optionee of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option (based on the Fair Market Value of the shares on the date the Stock Option is exercised) and for a period of not less than 6 months prior to the Stock Option Exercise, or by certifying ownership of such Shares by the Participant to the satisfaction of the Company for later delivery to the Company as specified by the Committee; provided, however, that, in the case of an Incentive Stock Option the right to make a payment in the form of already owned Shares of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option may be authorized only at the time the Stock Option is granted. 8 In the discretion of the Committee, payment for any Shares subject to a Stock Option may also be made pursuant to a “cashless exercise” by delivering a properly executed exercise notice to the Company, together with a copy of irrevocable instructions to a broker to deliver promptly to the Company the amount of sale or loan proceeds to pay the purchase price, and, if requested, the amount of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding taxes. To facilitate the foregoing, the Company may enter into agreements for coordinated procedures with one or more brokerage firms. No shares shall be issued until full payment therefor has been made. An optionee shall have all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is subject to such Stock Option (including, if applicable, the right to vote the shares and the right to receive dividends), when the optionee has given written notice of exercise and has paid in full for such Shares. (e) Restrictions on Share Transferability . The Committee may impose such restrictions on any Shares acquired pursuant to the exercise of an Option under the Plan as it may deem advisable, including, without limitation, restrictions under applicable federal securities laws, under the requirements of any stock exchange or market upon which such Shares are then listed and/or traded, and under any blue sky or state securities laws applicable to such Shares. (f) Nontransferability of Stock Options . Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, no Stock Option shall be transferable by the optionee other than (i) by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution; or (ii) in the case of a Non-Qualified Stock Option, pursuant to (a) a domestic relations order issued by a tribunal of competent jurisdiction or (b) a gift to members of such optionee’s immediate family, whether directly or indirectly or by means of a trust or partnership or otherwise, if expressly permitted under the applicable option agreement. All Stock Options shall be exercisable, subject to the terms of this Plan, during the optionee’s lifetime, only by the optionee or by the guardian or legal representative of the optionee or, in the case of a Non-Qualified Stock Option, its alternative payee pursuant to such domestic relations order, it being understood that the term “holder” and “optionee” include the guardian and legal representative of the optionee named in the option agreement and any person to whom an option is transferred by will or the laws of descent and distribution or, in the case of a Non-Qualified Stock Option, pursuant to a domestic relations order or a gift permitted under the applicable option agreement. (g) Death . Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee’s employment terminates by reason of death, any Stock Option held by such optionee shall become immediately and fully exercisable and (unless another period is specified by the Committee in the option agreement) may thereafter be exercised by the estate of the optionee for a period of three years from the date of such death; provided, however, that if the optionee is at least sixty years of age at the time of death and has fifteen years service with the Company, such Stock Option may thereafter be exercised by the estate of the optionee for a period of six years from the date of such death. In no event, however, may a Stock Option be exercisable beyond the stated expiration date of such Stock Option. Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee dies after termination of the optionee’s employment, any Stock Option held by such optionee may thereafter be exercised, to the extent such Stock Option was exercisable as of the date of such death, for a period that expires on the earliest of (i) the first anniversary of the date of such death, (ii) the last date on which the optionee would have been entitled to exercise such Stock Option had the optionee not died or (iii) the date on which the stated term of such Stock Option expires; provided, however, that if such optionee had retired from the Company prior to the date of death, the estate of the optionee shall continue to have the benefit of the vesting and exercisability benefits specified by Section 6.4(i). (h) Termination by Reason of Disability . Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee’s employment terminates by reason of Disability, any Stock Option held by such optionee, if not fully vested and exercisable as of the 9 date of such termination, shall continue to vest according to such Stock Option’s stated vesting schedule and may thereafter be exercised by the optionee, to the extent it was exercisable at the time of termination or thereafter becomes exercisable, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, for a period of three years (or such shorter period as the Committee may specify in the option agreement) from the date of such termination of employment or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shorter; provided, however, that if the optionee dies within such period, any unexercised Stock Option held by such optionee shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shortest. In the event of termination of employment by reason of Disability, if an Incentive Stock Option is exercised after the expiration of the exercise periods that apply for purposes of Section 422 of the Code, such Stock Option will thereafter be treated as a Non-Qualified Stock Option. (i) Termination by Reason of Retirement . Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee’s employment terminates by reason of retirement, the following vesting and exercisability terms will apply. For purposes of this Plan, an optionee shall be deemed to have terminated employment by reason of retirement if such optionee has attained age and years of service requirements set forth below, has given due notice (as determined by the Committee), and has entered into an agreement, the form and content of which shall be specified by the Committee, not to compete with the Company and its Affiliates for a period of one year following such retirement. In no event, however, may the option become exercisable beyond the option term fixed by the Committee. Age at Retirement 55 or more 60 or more Minimum Years of Service with Company 10 15 Years of Continued Vesting Following Retirement 1 6 Years of Continued Exercisability Following Retirement 2 6 Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the optionee dies within such period of continued exercisability, any unexercised Stock Option held by such optionee shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shortest. In the event of termination of employment by reason of retirement, if an Incentive Stock Option is exercised after the expiration of the exercise periods that apply for purposes of Section 422 of the Code, such Stock Option will thereafter be treated as a Non-Qualified Stock Option. (j) Other Termination . Unless otherwise determined by the Committee: (A) if an optionee incurs a voluntary termination of Employment, any Stock Option held by such optionee, to the extent then exercisable, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, may be exercised for the lesser of thirty days from the date of such termination of Employment or the balance of such Stock Option’s term; and (B) if an optionee incurs a termination of Employment because such optionee’s Employment is terminated by the Company or an Affiliate, other than by reason of retirement or Disability or for Cause, any Stock Option held by such optionee, to the extent then exercisable, or becomes exercisable during the one-year period following termination of employment by the Company or an Affiliate, or on such accelerated basis as the Committee may determine, may be exercised for the lesser of one year from the date of such termination of Employment or the balance of such Stock Option’s term; provided, however, that if the optionee dies within such thirty-day or one-year period, as the case may be, any unexercised Stock Option held by such optionee shall continue to be exercisable to the extent to which it was exercisable at the time of death for the remainder of such period, or for a period of 12 months from the date of such death, or until the expiration of the stated term of such Stock Option, whichever period is the shortest. 10 Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an optionee incurs a Termination of Employment at or after a Change of Control, other than by reason of death, Disability or Retirement, any Stock Option held by such optionee shall be exercisable for the lesser of (1) six months and one day from the date of such termination of Employment, and (2) the balance of such Stock Option’s term. In the event of termination of Employment, if an Incentive Stock Option is exercised after the expiration of the exercise periods that apply for purposes of Section 422 of the Code, such Stock Option will thereafter be treated as a Non-Qualified Stock Option. (k) Termination for Cause. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if an optionee incurs a Termination of Employment for Cause, all Stock Options held by such optionee shall thereupon terminate. (l) Change of Control Cash-Out . Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, during the 60-day period from and after a Change of Control (the “Exercise Period”), unless the Committee shall determine otherwise at the time of grant, an optionee shall have the right, whether or not the Stock Option is fully exercisable and in lieu of the payment of the exercise price for the Shares being purchased under the Stock Option and by giving notice to the Company, to elect (within the Exercise Period) to surrender all or part of the Stock Option to the Company and to receive cash, within 30 days of such notice, in an amount equal to the amount by which the Change of Control Price per Share shall exceed the exercise price per Share under the Stock Option (the “Spread”) multiplied by the number of Shares granted under the Stock Option as to which the right granted under this Section 6.4(l) shall have been exercised; provided, however, that if the Change of Control is within six months of the date of grant of a particular Stock Option held by an optionee who is an officer or director of the Company and is subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act no such election shall be made by such optionee with respect to such Stock Option prior to six months from the date of grant. However, if the end of such 60-day period from and after a Change of Control is within six months of the date of grant of a Stock Option held by an optionee who is an officer or director of the Company and is subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act, such Stock Option shall be cancelled in exchange for a cash payment to the optionee, effected on the day which is six months and one day after the date of grant of such Option, equal to the Spread multiplied by the number of Shares granted under the Stock Option. Article 7. Stock Appreciation Rights 7.1 Grant of SARs. Subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan, an SAR may be granted to an Employee at any time and from time to time as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee may grant Freestanding SARs, Tandem SARs, or any combination of these forms of SAR. In the case of a Non-Qualified Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted either at or after the time of grant of such Stock Option. In the case of an Incentive Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted only at the time of grant of such Stock Option. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number of SARs granted to each Participant (subject to Article 4 herein) and, consistent with the provisions of the Plan, in determining the terms and conditions pertaining to such SARs. However, the grant price of a Freestanding SAR shall be at least equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant of the SAR. The grant price of Tandem SARs shall equal the Option Price of the related Option. In no event shall any SAR granted hereunder become exercisable within the first six (6) months of its grant. SARs may not be repriced without stockholder approval. 7.2 Exercise of Tandem SARs. Tandem SARs may be exercised for all or part of the Shares subject to the related Option upon the surrender of the right to exercise the equivalent portion of the related Option. A Tandem SAR shall terminate and no longer be exercisable upon the termination or exercise of the related Stock Option. A Tandem SAR may be exercised only with respect to the Shares for which its related Option is then exercisable. 11 Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, with respect to a Tandem SAR granted in connection with an ISO; (i) the Tandem SAR will expire no later than the expiration of the underlying ISO; (ii) the value of the payout with respect to the Tandem SAR may be for no more than one hundred percent (100%) of the difference between the Option Price of the underlying ISO and the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the underlying ISO at the time the Tandem SAR is exercised; and (iii) the Tandem SAR may be exercised only when the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the ISO exceeds the Option Price of the ISO. 7.3 Exercise of Freestanding SARs. Subject to the other provisions of this Article 7, Freestanding SARs may be exercised upon whatever terms and conditions the Committee, at its sole discretion, imposes upon them. 7.4 SAR Agreement. Each SAR grant shall be evidenced by an Award Agreement that shall specify the grant price, the term of the SAR, and such other provisions as the Committee shall determine. 7.5 Term of SARs. The term of an SAR granted under the Plan shall be determined by the Committee, at its sole discretion; provided, however, that such term shall not exceed ten (10) years. 7.6 Payment of SAR Amount. Upon exercise of an SAR, a Participant shall be entitled to receive payment from the Company in an amount determined by multiplying: (a) The excess of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of exercise over the grant price of the SAR; by (b) The number of Shares with respect to which the SAR is exercised. At the discretion of the Committee, the payment upon SAR exercise may be in cash, in Shares of equivalent value, or in some combination thereof. 7.7 Rule 16-3 Requirements. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, the Committee may impose such conditions on exercise of an SAR (including, without limitation, the right of the Committee to limit the time of exercise to specified periods) as may be required to satisfy the requirements of any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 (or any successor rule) of the Act. 7.8 Nontransferability of SARs. No SAR granted under the Plan may be sold, transferred, pledged, assigned, or otherwise alienated or hypothecated, other than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution. Further, all SARs granted to a Participant under the Plan shall be exercisable during his or her lifetime only by such Participant. Notwithstanding the foregoing, at the discretion of the Committee, an Award Agreement may permit the transferability of an SAR by a Participant solely to members of the Participant’s immediate family or trusts for the benefit of such persons. Article 8. Restricted Stock 8.1 Administration. Shares of Restricted Stock may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall determine the officers and employees to whom and the time or times at which grants of Restricted Stock will be awarded, the number of shares to be awarded to any Participant (subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4), the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards, in addition to those contained in Section 8.3. The Committee may, prior to grant, condition the vesting of Restricted Stock upon continued service of the Participant. The provisions of Restricted Stock Awards need not be the same with respect to each recipient. 12 8.2 Awards and Certificates. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be evidenced in such manner as the Committee may deem appropriate, including book-entry registration or issuance of one or more stock certificates. Any certificate issued in respect of shares of Restricted Stock shall be registered in the name of such Participant and shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the terms, conditions, and restrictions applicable to such Award, substantially in the following form: “The sale or other transfer of the Shares of stock represented by this certificate, whether voluntary, involuntary, or by operation of law, is subject to certain restrictions on transfer as set forth in the Tupperware Corporation 2000 Incentive Plan, and in a Restricted Stock Agreement. A copy of the Plan and such Restricted Stock Agreement may be obtained from Tupperware Corporation.” The Committee may require that the certificates evidencing such Shares be held in custody by the Company until the restrictions thereon shall have lapsed and that, as a condition of any Award of Restricted Stock, the Participant shall have delivered a stock power, endorsed in blank, relating to the Common Stock covered by such Award. 8.3 Terms and Conditions. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be subject to the following terms and conditions: (a) Subject to the provisions of the Plan and the Restricted Stock Agreement referred to in Section 8.3(f), during the Restricted Period, the Participant shall not be permitted to sell, assign, transfer, pledge or otherwise encumber shares of Restricted Stock, except that, if expressly provided in the Restricted Stock Agreement, a Participant may, during the Restriction Period, transfer shares of Restricted Stock to members of the Participant’s immediate family or trusts or partnerships for the benefit of such persons. Within these limits, the Committee may provide for the lapse of restrictions based upon period of service in installments or otherwise and may accelerate or waive, in whole or in part, restrictions based upon period of service. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any Restricted Stock Award granted hereunder shall have a Restriction Period of not less than three years, except that an aggregate amount of Restricted Stock Awards not exceeding one-third of the Shares available for use as Restricted Stock Awards pursuant to Section 4.1 of the Plan may be issued without a minimum Restriction Period. (b) Except as provided in this paragraph (b) and paragraph (a), above, and the Restricted Stock Agreement, the Participant shall have, with respect to the shares of Restricted Stock, all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is the subject of the Restricted Stock, including, if applicable, the right to vote the shares and the right to receive any cash dividends. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee in the applicable Restricted Stock Agreement, dividends payable in Shares shall be paid in the form of Restricted Stock of the same class as the Shares with which such dividend was paid, held subject to the vesting of the underlying Restricted Stock. In the event that any dividend constitutes a “derivative security” or an “equity security” pursuant to Rule 16(a) under the Act, such dividend shall be subject to a vesting period equal to the longer of: (i) the remaining vesting period of the Shares of Restricted Stock with respect to which the dividend is paid; or (ii) six months. The Committee shall establish procedures for the application of this provision. (c) Except to the extent otherwise provided in the applicable Restricted Stock Agreement and paragraphs (a) and (d) of this Section 8.3 and Section 13.1(b), upon a Participant’s Termination of Employment for any reason during the Restriction Period, all Shares still subject to restriction shall be forfeited by the Participant. 13 (d) Except to the extent otherwise provided in Section 13.1(b), in the event that a Participant retires or such Participant’s employment is involuntarily terminated (other than for Cause), the Committee shall have the discretion to waive, in whole or in part, any or all remaining restrictions with respect to any or all of such Participant’s shares of Restricted Stock. (e) If and when any applicable Restriction Period expires without a prior forfeiture of the Restricted Stock, unlegended certificates for such shares shall be delivered to the Participant upon surrender of the legended certificates. (f) Each Award shall be confirmed by, and be subject to, the terms of a Restricted Stock Agreement. Article 9. Performance Awards 9.1 Grant of Performance Awards. Subject to the terms of the Plan, Performance Awards may be granted to eligible Employees at any time and from time to time, as shall be determined by the Committee, and may be granted either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number, amount and timing of Awards granted to each Participant. Such Performance Awards may take the form determined by the Committee, including without limitation, cash, Shares, Performance Units and Performance Shares, or any combination thereof. Performance Awards may be awarded as short-term or long-term incentives. 9.2 Performance Goals. (a) The Committee shall set Performance Goals at its discretion which, depending on the extent to which they are met, will determine the number and/or value of Performance Awards that will be paid out to the Participants, and may attach to such Performance Awards one or more restrictions, including, without limitation, a requirement that Participants pay a stipulated purchase price for each Performance Share, or restrictions which are necessary or desirable as a result of applicable laws or regulations. Each Performance Award may be confirmed by, and be subject to, a Performance Award Agreement. (b) The Committee shall have the authority at any time to make adjustments to Performance Goals for any outstanding Performance Awards which the Committee deems necessary or desirable unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments. (c) Performance Periods shall, in all cases, exceed six (6) months in length. 9.3 Value of Performance Units/Shares. (a) Each Performance Unit shall have an initial value that is established by the Committee at the time of grant. (b) Each Performance Share shall have an initial value equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant. 9.4 Earning of Performance Awards. After the applicable Performance Period has ended, the holder of any Performance Award shall be entitled to receive the payout earned by the Participant over the Performance Period, to be determined as a function of the extent to which the corresponding Performance Goals have been achieved, except as adjusted pursuant to Section 9.2(b) or as deferred pursuant to Article 11. 9.5 Timing of Payment of Performance Awards. Payment of earned Performance Awards shall be made in accordance with terms and conditions prescribed or authorized by the Committee. The Committee may permit the Participants to elect to defer or the Committee may require the deferral of, the receipt of Performance Awards upon such terms as the Committee deems appropriate. 14 9.6 Nontransferability. Performance Awards may not be sold, transferred, pledged, assigned, or otherwise alienated or hypothecated, other than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution. Further, a Participant’s rights under the Plan shall be exercisable during the Participant’s lifetime only by the Participant or the Participant’s Beneficiary. Notwithstanding the foregoing, at the discretion of the Committee, an Award Agreement may permit the transferability of a Performance Award by a Participant solely to members of the Participant’s immediate family or trusts or partnerships for the benefit of such persons. 9.7 Termination. Performance Awards shall be subject to the following terms and conditions: (a) Except to the extent otherwise provided in the applicable Performance Award Agreement, if any, and Sections 9.7(b) and 13.1 (c), upon a Participant’s Termination of Employment for any reason during the Performance Period or before any applicable Performance Goals are satisfied, the rights to the shares still covered by the Performance Award shall be forfeited by the Participant. (b) Except to the extent otherwise provided in Section 13.1(c), in the event that a Participant’s employment is terminated (other than for Cause), or in the event a Participant retires, the Committee shall have the discretion to waive, in whole or in part, any or all remaining payment limitations (other than, in the case of Performance Awards with respect to which a Participant is a Covered Employee, satisfaction of any applicable Performance Goals unless the Participant’s employment is terminated by reason of death or disability) with respect to any or all of such Participant’s Performance Awards. Article 10. Beneficiary 10.1 Designation. Each Participant under the Plan may, from time to time, name any Beneficiary or Beneficiaries (who may be named contingently or successively). Each such designation shall revoke all prior designations by the same Participant, shall be in a form prescribed by the Company, and shall be effective only when filed by the Participant in writing with the Company during the Participant’s lifetime. Any such designation shall control over any inconsistent testamentary or inter vivos transfer by a Participant, and any benefit of a Participant under the Plan shall pass automatically to a Participant’s Beneficiary pursuant to a proper designation pursuant to this Section 10.1 without administration under any statute or rule of law governing the transfer of property by will, trust, gift or intestacy. 10.2 Absence of Designation. In the absence of any such designation contemplated by Section 10.1, benefits remaining unpaid at the Participant’s death shall be paid pursuant to the Participant’s will or pursuant to the laws of descent and distribution. Article 11. Deferrals The Committee may permit a Participant to elect, or the Committee may require at its sole discretion subject to the proviso set forth below, any one or more of the following: (i) the deferral of the Participant’s receipt of cash, (ii) a delay in the exercise of an Option or SAR, (iii) a delay in the lapse or waiver of restrictions with respect to Restricted Stock, or (iv) a delay of the satisfaction of any requirements or goals with respect to Performance Awards; provided, however, the Committee’s authority to take such actions hereunder shall exist only to the extent necessary to reduce or eliminate a limitation on the deductibility of compensation paid to the Participant pursuant to (and so long as such action in and of itself does not constitute the exercise of impermissible discretion under) 15 Section 162(m) of the Code, or any successor provision thereunder. If any such deferral is required or permitted, the Committee shall establish rules and procedures for such deferrals, including provisions relating to periods of deferral, the terms of payment following the expiration of the deferral periods, and the rate of earnings, if any, to be credited to any amounts deferred thereunder. Article 12. Rights of Employees 12.1 Employment. Nothing in the Plan shall interfere with or limit in any way the right of the Company to terminate any Participant’s employment at any time, nor confer upon any Participant any right to continue in the employ of the Company. For purposes of the Plan, transfer of employment of a Participant between the Company and any one of its Subsidiaries (or between Subsidiaries) shall not be deemed a termination of employment. 12.2 Participation. No Employee shall have the right to be selected to receive an Award under this Plan, or, having been so selected, to be selected to receive a future Award. Article 13. Change of Control 13.1 Impact of Event. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, in the event of a Change of Control: (a) Any Stock Options or SARs outstanding as of the date such Change of Control is determined to have occurred, and which are not then exercisable and vested, shall become fully exercisable and vested to the full extent of the original grant; provided, however, that in the case of the holder of Stock Options or SARs who is subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act, such Stock Options or SARs shall have been outstanding for at least six months at the date such Change of Control is determined to have occurred. (b) The restrictions and deferral limitations applicable to any Restricted Stock shall lapse, and such Restricted Stock shall become free of all restrictions and become fully vested and transferable to the full extent of the original grant. (c) The target payout opportunities attainable under all outstanding Awards of performance-based Restricted Stock, performance- based Restricted Stock Units, Performance Units, Performance Shares, and cash-based Awards (excluding any long-term Awards issued to individual Participants and that are not broad-based programs and which are denominated in cash and paid in cash, which may be designated as “gainsharing” Awards, but not including Performance Share Awards, and which shall continue to be in effect) shall be deemed to have been earned on a pro-rata basis for that portion of the Performance Period(s) having elapsed under such outstanding Awards as of the effective date of the Change of Control. The vesting of all Awards denominated in Shares shall be deemed to have been earned on a pro-rata basis for that portion of the Performance Period(s) having elapsed under such outstanding Awards as of the effective date of the Change of Control, and there shall be paid out to Participants in cash within ten (10) days following the effective date of the Change of Control the value of such vested Shares in an amount equal to the product of the number of such vested Shares and the Fair Market Value per Share determined immediately prior to the Change of Control, based upon an assumed achievement of all relevant target performance goals. Awards denominated in cash shall be paid on a pro-rata basis to Participants in cash within ten (10) days following the effective date of the Change of Control based upon assumed achievement of all relevant target performance goals. 16 Article 14. Amendment, Modification, and Termination 14.1 Amendment, Modification, and Termination. At any time and from time to time, the Board may terminate, amend, or modify the Plan. However, without the approval of the stockholders of the Company, no such amendment or modification may: (a) Increase the total number of Shares which may be issued under this Plan, except as provided in Article 4 hereof; or (b) Modify the eligibility requirements; or (c) Materially increase the benefits accruing under the Plan. 14.2 Awards Previously Granted. No termination, amendment, or modification of the Plan shall adversely affect in any material way any Award previously granted under the Plan, without the written consent of the Participant holding such Award except such an amendment made to cause the Plan or Award to qualify for the exemption provided by Rule 16b-3. The Committee shall have the right to replace any previously granted Award under the Plan with an Award equal to the value of the replaced Award at the time of replacement, without obtaining the consent of the Participant holding such Award. Subject to the above provisions, the Board shall have authority to amend the Plan to take into account changes in law and tax and accounting rules as well as other developments, and to grant Awards which qualify for beneficial treatment under such rules without stockholder approval. Article 15. Withholding 15.1 Tax Withholding. The Company shall have the power and the right to deduct or withhold, or require a Participant to remit to the Company, an amount sufficient to satisfy federal, state, and local taxes (including the Participant’s FICA obligation) required by law to be withheld with respect to any taxable event arising under or as a result of this Plan. 15.2 Share Withholding. With respect to withholding required and/or permitted upon the exercise of Options or SARs, upon the lapse of restrictions on Restricted Stock, or upon any other taxable event hereunder, Participants may elect, subject to the approval of the Committee, to satisfy the withholding requirement, in whole or in part, by having the Company withhold Shares (or by surrendering Shares previously owned which have been held for longer than six months) having a Fair Market Value on the date the tax is to be determined equal to the minimum statutory total tax which could be imposed on the transaction. All elections shall be irrevocable, made in writing, signed by the Participant, and elections by Insiders shall additionally comply with the requirements established by the Committee. Article 16. Successors All obligations of the Company under the Plan, with respect to Awards granted hereunder, shall be binding on any successor to the Company, whether the existence of such successor is the result of a direct or indirect purchase, merger, consolidation, spin-off, or otherwise, of all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company. Article 17. Legal Construction 17.1 Gender and Number. Except where otherwise indicated by the context, any masculine term used herein also shall include the feminine; the plural shall include the singular and the singular shall include the plural. 17.2 Severability. In the event any provision of the Plan shall be held illegal or invalid for any reason, the illegality or invalidity shall not affect the remaining parts of the Plan, and the Plan shall be construed and enforced as if the illegal or invalid provision had not been included. 17 17.3 Requirements of Law. The granting of Awards and the issuance of Shares under the Plan shall be subject to all applicable laws, rules, and regulations, and to such approvals by any governmental agencies or national securities exchanges as may be required. With respect to Insiders, transactions under this Plan are intended to comply with all applicable conditions of Rule 16b-3 or its successors under the Exchange Act. To the extent any provision of the plan or action by the Committee fails to comply with Section 17.3, it shall be deemed null and void, to the extent permitted by law and deemed advisable by the Committee. Notwithstanding any other provision set forth in the Plan, if required by any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 of the Exchange Act, any “derivative security” or “equity security” offered pursuant to the Plan to any Insider may not be sold or transferred for at least six (6) months after the date of grant of such Award. The terms “equity security” and “derivative security” shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the then-current Rule 16(a) under the Exchange Act. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or agreements made pursuant thereto, the Company shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificate or certificates for Shares under the Plan prior to fulfillment of all of the following conditions: (a) Listing or approval for listing upon notice of issuance, of such shares on the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., or such other securities exchange as may at the time be the principal market for the Shares; (b) Any registration or other qualification of such Shares under any state or federal law or regulation, or the maintaining in effect of any such registration or other qualification which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion upon the advice of counsel, deem necessary or advisable; and (c) Obtaining any other consent, approval, or permit from any state or federal governmental agency which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion after receiving the advice of counsel, determine to be necessary or advisable. 17.4 Pooling. Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, if any right granted pursuant to this Plan would make a Change of Control transaction ineligible for pooling-of-interests accounting under APB No. 16 that but for the nature of such grant would otherwise be eligible for such accounting treatment, the Committee shall have the ability to substitute for the cash payable pursuant to such grant Common Stock with a Fair Market Value equal to the cash that would otherwise be payable hereunder. 17.5 Governing Law. To the extent not preempted by federal law, the Plan, and all agreements hereunder, shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware. 18 TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION 2002 INCENTIVE PLAN (as amended November 2, 2006 and December 14,2006) Exhibit 10.14 Article 1. Establishment, Purpose, and Duration 1.1 Establishment of the Plan. Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation (hereinafter referred to as the “Company”), hereby establishes an incentive compensation plan to be known as the “Tupperware Brands Corporation 2002 Incentive Plan” (hereinafter referred to as the “Plan”), as set forth in this document. The Plan permits the grant of Non-Qualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, Stock Appreciation Rights, Restricted Stock, and Performance Awards. The Plan shall become effective as of the Effective Date, and shall remain in effect as provided in Section 1.3 herein. 1.2 Purpose of the Plan. The purpose of the Plan is to promote the success and enhance the value of the Company by linking the personal interests of Participants to those of the Company’s stockholders and by providing Participants with an incentive for outstanding performance. The Plan is further intended to provide flexibility to the Company in its ability to motivate, attract, and retain the services of Participants upon whose judgment, interest, and special efforts the successful conduct of its operations largely is dependent. 1.3 Duration of the Plan. The Plan shall commence on the Effective Date and shall remain in effect, subject to the right of the Board of Directors to terminate, amend or modify the Plan at any time pursuant to Article 14 herein, until all Shares subject to it shall have been purchased or acquired according to the Plan’s provisions. Article 2. Definitions Whenever used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below and, when the meaning is intended, the initial letter of the word is capitalized: (a) “Award” means, individually or collectively, a grant under this Plan of Non-Qualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock, or Performance Awards. (b) “Award Agreement” means an agreement entered into by each Participant and the Company, setting forth the terms and provisions applicable to Awards granted to Participants under this Plan, including without limitation, stock option agreements, SAR agreements and restricted stock agreements. (c) “Beneficial Owner” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Rule 13d-3 of the General Rules and Regulations under the Exchange Act. (d) “Beneficiary” means a person who may be designated by a Participant pursuant to Article 10 and to whom any benefit under the Plan is to be paid in case of the Participant’s death or physical or mental incapacity, as determined by the Committee, before he or she receives any or all of such benefit. (e) “Board” or “Board of Directors” means the Board of Directors of the Company. (f) “Cause” means (i) conviction of a Participant for committing a felony under federal law or the laws of the state in which such action occurred, (ii) dishonesty in the course of fulfilling a Participant’s employment duties (iii) willful and deliberate 1 failure on the part of a Participant to perform his employment duties in any material respect, including compliance with the Company’s Code of Conduct, or (iv) such other events as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee shall have the sole discretion to determine whether “Cause” exists, and its determination shall be final. (g) “Change of Control” of the Company means: i. An acquisition by any Person of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 20 percent or more of either (1) the then outstanding Shares (the “Outstanding Company Common Stock”) or (2) the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities of the Company entitled to vote generally in the election of Directors (the “Outstanding Company Voting Securities”); excluding, however, the following: (1) any acquisition directly from the Company, other than an acquisition by virtue of the exercise of a conversion privilege unless the security being so converted was itself acquired from the Company, (2) any acquisition by the Company, (3) any acquisition by any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or (4) any acquisition by any Person pursuant to a transaction which complies with clauses (1), (2) and (3) of subsection (iii) of this definition; or ii. A change in the composition of the Board such that the individuals who, as of the Effective Date of the Plan, constitute the Board (such Board shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Incumbent Board”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board; provided, however, for purposes of this definition, that any individual who becomes a member of the Board subsequent to such Effective Date, whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of those individuals who are members of the Board and who were also members of the Incumbent Board (or deemed to be such pursuant to this proviso) shall be considered as though such individual were a member of the Incumbent Board; but, provided further, that any such individual whose initial assumption of office occurs as a result of either an actual or threatened election contest (as such terms are used in Rule 14a-11 of Regulation 14A promulgated under the Exchange Act) or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a person or legal entity other than the Board shall not be so considered as a member of the Incumbent Board; or iii. The consummation of a reorganization, merger, statutory share exchange or consolidation or sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company or the acquisition of assets or stock of another entity by the Company or any of its subsidiaries (“Corporate Transaction”), in each case unless, following such Corporate Transaction, (1) all or substantially all of the individuals and entities who were the Beneficial Owners, respectively, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than 60 percent of, respectively, the common stock and the combined voting power of the then-outstanding voting securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, as the case may be, of the entity resulting from such Corporate Transaction (including, without limitation, an entity which as a result of such transaction owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) in substantially the same proportions as their ownership, immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities, as the case may be, (2) no Person (other than the Company, any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or such entity resulting from such Corporate Transaction) beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, 20 percent or more of, respectively, the outstanding shares of Common Stock of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction or the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of such 2 corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of Directors except to the extent that such ownership existed with respect to the Company prior to the Corporate Transaction and (3) individuals who were members of the Incumbent Board at the time of the execution of the initial agreement or of the action of the Board providing for such Corporate Transaction constitute at least a majority of the Board of Directors of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction; or iv. The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company. (h) “Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time. (i) “Commission” means the Securities and Exchange Commission or any successor agency. (j) “Committee” means the committee described in Article 3 or (unless otherwise stated) its designee pursuant to a delegation by the Committee as contemplated by Section 3.3. (k) “Common Stock” shall mean the common stock of the Company, par value $.01 per share. (l) “Company” means Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation, or any successor thereto as provided in Article 16 herein. (m) “Covered Employee” has the meaning ascribed thereto in Section 162(m) of the Code and the regulations thereunder. (n) “Director” means any individual who is a member of the Board of Directors of the Company. (o) “Disability” means the inability of an Employee to perform the material duties of his or her occupation as determined by the Committee. (p) “Effective Date” means May 15, 2002. (q) “Employee” means any nonunion employee of the Company or of the Company’s Subsidiaries or affiliates. Directors who are not otherwise employed by the Company shall not be considered Employees under this Plan. (r) “Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time, or any successor act thereto. (s) “Fair Market Value” means, except as expressly provided otherwise, as of any given date, the closing sales price of the Common Stock during normal business hours on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or, if not listed on such exchange, on any other national securities exchange on which the Common Stock is listed or on NASDAQ. If there is no regular public trading market for such Common Stock, the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock shall be determined by the Committee in good faith. (t) “Freestanding SAR” means a SAR that is granted independently of any Options pursuant to Section 7.1 herein. (u) “Incentive Stock Option” or “ISO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is designated as an Incentive Stock Option and is intended to meet the requirements of Section 422 of the Code. 3 (v) “Insider” shall mean an Employee who is, on the relevant date, an officer, Director, or more than ten percent (10 percent) Beneficial Owner of the Company. (x) “Non-Qualified Stock Option” or “NQSO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is not intended to be an Incentive Stock Option. (y) “Option” or “Stock Option” means an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-Qualified Stock Option. (z) “Option Price” means the price at which a Share may be purchased by a Participant pursuant to an Option, as determined by the Committee. (aa) “Outside Director” means a member of the Board who qualifies as an outside director as defined in Rule 162(m) of the Code, as promulgated by the Internal Revenue Service (the “Service”) under the Code, or any implementing or interpretive regulations from time to time, or any successor definition adopted by the Service. (ab) “Participant” means an Employee of or a consultant to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates who has been granted an Award under the Plan. (ac) “Performance Award” means an Award granted to a Participant, as described in Article 9 herein, including Performance Units and Performance Shares. (ad) “Performance Goals” means the performance goals established by the Committee prior to the grant of Performance Awards that are based on the attainment of one or any combination of the following: specified levels of net income or earnings per share from continuing operations, operating income, revenues, return on operating assets, return on equity, stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation) and/or total stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation plus cash dividends), achievement of cost control, working capital turns, cash flow, net income, economic value added, segment profit, sales force growth, or stock price of the Company or such Subsidiary, division or department of the Company for or within which the Participant primarily renders services and that are intended to qualify under Section 162(m) (4) (c) of the Code. Such Performance Goals also may be based upon the attaining of specified levels of Company performance under one or more of the measures described above relative to the performance of other corporations. Such Performance Goals shall be set by the Committee within the time period prescribed by Section 162(m) of the Code and related regulations. (ae) “Performance Period” means a time period during which Performance Goals established in connection with Performance Awards must be met. (af) “Performance Unit” means an Award granted to a Participant, as described in Article 9 herein. (ag) “Performance Share” means an Award granted to a Participant, as described in Article 9 herein. (ah) “Restriction Period” or “Period” means the period or periods during which the transfer of Shares of Restricted Stock is limited based on the passage of time and the continuation of service with the Company and the Shares are subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture, as provided in Article 8 herein. (ai) “Person” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 3(a) (9) of the Exchange Act and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof, including a “group” as defined in Section 13(d). 4 (aj) “Restricted Stock” means an Award granted to a Participant pursuant to Article 8 herein. (ak) “Share” means a share of common stock of the Company. (al) “Subsidiary” or “Subsidiaries” means any corporation or corporations in which the Company owns directly, or indirectly through Subsidiaries, at least twenty-five percent (25 percent) of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock, or any other entity (including, but not limited to, partnerships and joint ventures) in which the Company owns at least twenty-five percent (25 percent) of the combined equity thereof. (am) “Stock Appreciation Right” or “SAR” means an Award, granted alone (Freestanding SAR) or in connection with a related Option (Tandem SAR), designated as a SAR, pursuant to the terms of Article 7 herein. (an) “Tandem SAR” means a SAR that is granted in connection with a related Option pursuant to Section 7.1 herein, the exercise of which shall require forfeiture of the right to purchase a Share under the related Option (and when a Share is purchased under the Option, the Tandem SAR shall similarly be cancelled). Article 3. Administration 3.1 The Committee . The Plan shall be administered by the Compensation and Directors Committee or such other committee of the Board as the Board may from time to time designate, which shall be composed solely of not less than two Outside Directors, and shall be appointed by and serve at the pleasure of the Board. 3.2 Authority of the Committee . The Committee shall have plenary authority to grant Awards pursuant to the terms of the Plan to Employees of and to consultants to the Company and its Subsidiaries and affiliates. Among other things, the Committee shall have the authority, subject to the terms of the Plan: (a) To select the Employees and consultants to whom Awards may from time to time be granted; (b) To determine whether and to what extent Incentive Stock Options, Non-Qualified Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock and Performance Awards or any combination thereof are to be granted hereunder; (c) To determine the number of Shares to be covered by each Award granted hereunder; (d) To determine (by approving the forms of Award Agreements or otherwise by resolution) the terms and conditions of any Award granted hereunder (including, but not limited to, the Option Price (subject to Section 6.4 (a)) the duration, any vesting condition, restriction or limitation (which may be related to the performance of the Participant, the Company or any Subsidiary or affiliate), any vesting acceleration or forfeiture waiver regarding any Award and the Shares relating thereto, and the impact on any Award from termination of employment (whether as a consequence of death, Disability, retirement, action by the Company, action by the Employee or Change of Control) of an Employee, or the termination of services of a consultant, based on such factors as the Committee shall determine; (e) To determine the methodology of counting Shares available for grant under the terms of the Plan. 5 (f) To modify, amend or adjust the terms and conditions of any Award, at any time or from time to time, including but not limited to Performance Goals, unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments; and (g) To determine to what extent and under what circumstances Shares and other amounts payable with respect to an Award shall be deferred. The Committee shall have the authority to adopt, alter and repeal such administrative rules, guidelines and practices governing the Plan as it shall from time to time deem advisable, to interpret the terms and provisions of the Plan and any Award issued under the Plan (and any Award Agreement relating thereto) and to otherwise supervise the administration of the Plan. 3.3 Action of the Committee. The Committee may, to the fullest extent permitted by law and subject to such limitations and procedures as may be required by law or as the Committee may deem appropriate, (i) delegate to an officer of the Company the authority to take actions or make decisions pursuant to Section 2(f), Section 3.2, Section 5.2, and Section 6.4, provided that no such delegation may be made that would cause Awards or other transactions under the Plan to cease either to be exempt from Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act or to qualify as “qualified performance-based compensation” as such term is defined in the regulations promulgated under Section 162(m) of the Code, and (ii) authorize any one or more of their members or any officer of the Company to execute and deliver documents on behalf of the Committee. 3.4 Decisions Binding. Any determination made by the Committee or pursuant to delegated authority pursuant to the provisions of the Plan with respect to any Award shall be made in the sole discretion of the Committee or such delegate at the time of the grant of the Award or, unless in contravention of any express term of the Plan, at any time thereafter. All decisions made by the Committee or any appropriately delegated officer pursuant to the provisions of the Plan shall be final and binding on all persons, including the Company and Plan Participants. Article 4. Shares Subject to the Plan 4.1 Number of Shares. Subject to adjustment as provided in Section 4.3 herein, the total number of Shares available for grant under the Plan shall be two million eight hundred fifty thousand (2,850,000); provided, however, the total number of available Shares that may be used for Restricted Stock Awards under the Plan shall be limited to two hundred thousand (200,000) and the total amount of available Shares that may be used for Performance Awards under the Plan shall be limited to four hundred thousand (400,000) Shares. No Participant may be granted (i) Stock Options and Freestanding SARs in any one year covering, in the aggregate, in excess of 600,000 Shares, or (ii) Performance Share Awards in any one year in excess of 100,000 Shares. Shares subject to an Award under the Plan may be authorized and unissued Shares or may be treasury Shares. 4.2 Lapsed Awards. If any Award granted under this Plan is cancelled, forfeited, terminates, expires, or lapses for any reason (with the exception of the termination of a Tandem SAR upon exercise of the related Option or the termination of a related Option upon exercise of the corresponding Tandem SAR), any Shares subject to such Award again shall be available for the grant of an Award under the Plan. 4.3 Adjustments in Authorized Shares and Prices. In the event of any change in corporate capitalization, such as a stock split, or a corporate transaction, such as any merger, consolidation, separation, including a spin-off, or other distribution of stock or property of the Company, any reorganization (whether or not such reorganization comes within the definition of such term in Section 368 of the Code) or any partial or complete liquidation of the Company, the Committee or Board may make such substitution or adjustments in the aggregate number and class of Shares reserved for issuance under the Plan, in the number, kind and Option Price of Shares subject to outstanding Stock Options or SARs, in the number and kind of Shares subject to other outstanding Awards 6 granted under the Plan or subject to limitations such as Restricted Stock Awards or per-Participant maximum awards and/or such other equitable substitution or adjustments as it may determine to be appropriate in its sole discretion; provided, however, that the number of Shares subject to any Award shall always be a whole number. Such adjusted Option Price shall also be used to determine the amount payable by the Company upon the exercise of any Tandem SAR; and provided further, however , that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of a change in capitalization that is the result of an equity restructuring which is not the consequence of a corporate transaction with a third-party, such substitutions or adjustments shall be required to be made. Such substitutions and adjustments may include, without limitation, canceling any and all Awards in exchange for cash payments based upon the value realized by shareholders generally with respect to Shares in connection with such a corporate transaction. Article 5. Eligibility and Participation 5.1 Eligibility. Persons eligible to be granted Awards under this Plan include all Employees of and all consultants to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates, as determined by the Committee, including Employees who are members of the Board, but excluding Directors who are not Employees. 5.2 Actual Participation. Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Committee may, from time to time, select from all eligible Employees and consultants, those to whom Awards shall be granted and shall determine the nature and amount of each Award. Article 6. Stock Options 6.1 Grant of Options. Stock Options may be granted alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan and may be of two types: Incentive Stock Options and Non-Qualified Stock Options. Any Stock Option granted under the Plan shall be in such form as the Committee may from time to time approve. The Committee shall have the authority to grant any optionee Incentive Stock Options, Non- Qualified Stock Options or both types of Stock Options (in each case with or without Stock Appreciation Rights); provided, however, that grants hereunder are subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4. Incentive Stock Options may be granted only to employees of the Company and any “subsidiary corporation” (as such term is defined in Section 424(f) of the Code). To the extent that any Stock Option is not designated as an Incentive Stock Option or even if so designated does not qualify as an Incentive Stock Option, it shall constitute a Non-Qualified Stock Option. 6.2 Award Agreement. Stock Options shall be evidenced by Award Agreements, the terms and provisions of which may differ. An Award Agreement shall indicate on its face whether it is intended to be an agreement for an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-Qualified Stock Option. The grant of a Stock Option shall occur on the date the Committee by resolution selects an individual to be a Participant in any grant of a Stock Option, determines the number of Shares to be subject to such Stock Option to be granted to such individual and specifies the terms and provisions of the Stock Option, or such later date as the Committee designates. The Company shall notify a Participant of any grant of a Stock Option, and a written Award Agreement or agreements shall be duly executed and delivered by the Company to the Participant. Such agreement or agreements shall become effective upon execution by the Company and the Participant. 6.3 Incentive Stock Options. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, no Incentive Stock Option may be granted under the Plan on or after November 13, 2011. 6.4 Terms and Conditions. Stock Options granted under the Plan shall be subject to the following terms and conditions and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (a) Stock Option Price . The Option Price per Share purchasable under a Stock Option shall be determined by the Committee and set forth in the Award Agreement, and shall not be less than the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Stock Option on the date of grant. 7 (b) Option Term . The term of each Stock Option shall be fixed by the Committee, but no Incentive Stock Option shall be exercisable more than 10 years after the date the Stock Option is granted. (c) Exercisability . Except as otherwise provided herein, Stock Options shall be exercisable at such time or times and subject to such terms and conditions as shall be determined by the Committee. If the Committee provides that any Stock Option is exercisable only in installments, the Committee may at any time waive such installment exercise provisions, in whole or in part, based on such factors as the Committee may determine. In addition, the Committee may at any time accelerate the exercisability of any Stock Option. (d) Method of Exercise . Subject to the provisions of this Article 6, Stock Options may be exercised, in whole or in part, at any time during the term of the Stock Option by giving written notice of exercise to the Company specifying the number of Shares subject to the Stock Option to be purchased. Such notice shall be accompanied by payment in full of the Option Price by certified or bank check or such other instrument as the Company may accept. Payment, in full or in part, may also be made in the form of delivery of unrestricted Shares already owned by the optionee of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option (based on the Fair Market Value of the Shares on the date the Stock Option is exercised) and, unless such Shares were acquired in the open market, held for a period of not less than 6 months prior to the exercise of the Stock Option, or by certifying ownership of such Shares by the Participant to the satisfaction of the Company for later delivery to the Company as specified by the Committee; provided, however, that, in the case of an Incentive Stock Option the right to make a payment in the form of already owned Shares of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option may be authorized only at the time the Stock Option is granted. In the discretion of the Committee, payment for any Shares subject to a Stock Option may also be made pursuant to a “cashless exercise” by delivering a properly executed exercise notice to the Company, together with a copy of irrevocable instructions to a broker to deliver promptly to the Company the amount of sale or loan proceeds to pay the purchase price, and, if requested, the amount of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding taxes. To facilitate the foregoing, the Company may enter into agreements for coordinated procedures with one or more brokerage firms. No Shares shall be issued until full payment therefor has been made. An optionee shall have all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is subject to such Stock Option (including, if applicable, the right to vote the Shares and the right to receive dividends), when the optionee has given written notice of exercise and has paid in full for such Shares. (e) Restrictions on Share Transferability . The Committee may impose such restrictions on any Shares acquired pursuant to the exercise of a Stock Option under the Plan as it may deem advisable, including, without limitation, restrictions under applicable federal securities laws, under the requirements of any stock exchange or market upon which such Shares are then listed and/or traded, and under any blue sky or state securities laws applicable to such Shares. Article 7. Stock Appreciation Rights 7.1 Grant of SARs. Subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan, a SAR may be granted to an Employee or consultant at any time and from time to time as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee may grant Freestanding SARs, Tandem SARs, or any combination of these forms of SAR. In the case of a Non-Qualified Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted either at or after the time of grant of such Stock Option. In the case of an Incentive Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted only at the time of grant of such Stock Option. 8 The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number of SARs granted to each Participant (subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4) and, consistent with the provisions of the Plan, in determining the terms and conditions pertaining to such SARs. However, the grant price of a Freestanding SAR shall be at least equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant of the SAR. The grant price of Tandem SARs shall equal the Option Price of the related Option. SARs may not be repriced without stockholder approval. 7.2 Exercise of Tandem SARs. Tandem SARs may be exercised for all or part of the Shares subject to the related Option upon the surrender of the right to exercise the equivalent portion of the related Option. A Tandem SAR shall terminate and no longer be exercisable upon the termination or exercise of the related Stock Option. A Tandem SAR may be exercised only with respect to the Shares for which its related Option is then exercisable. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, with respect to a Tandem SAR granted in connection with an ISO; (i) the Tandem SAR will expire no later than the expiration of the underlying ISO; (ii) the value of the payout with respect to the Tandem SAR may be for no more than one hundred percent (100 percent) of the difference between the Option Price of the underlying ISO and the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the underlying ISO at the time the Tandem SAR is exercised; and (iii) the Tandem SAR may be exercised only when the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the ISO exceeds the Option Price of the ISO. 7.3 Exercise of Freestanding SARs. Subject to the other provisions of this Article 7, Freestanding SARs may be exercised upon whatever terms and conditions the Committee, at its sole discretion, imposes upon them. 7.4 SAR Agreement. Each SAR grant shall be evidenced by an Award Agreement that shall specify the grant price, the term of the SAR, and such other provisions as the Committee shall determine. 7.5 Term of SARs. The term of a SAR granted under the Plan shall be determined by the Committee, at its sole discretion; provided, however, that such term shall not exceed ten (10) years. 7.6 Payment of SAR Amount. Upon exercise of a SAR, a Participant shall be entitled to receive payment from the Company in an amount determined by multiplying: (a) The excess of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of exercise over the grant price of the SAR; by (b) The number of Shares with respect to which the SAR is exercised. At the discretion of the Committee, the payment upon SAR exercise may be in cash, in Shares of equivalent value, or in some combination thereof. 7.7 Rule 16-3 Requirements. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, the Committee may impose such conditions on exercise of a SAR (including, without limitation, the right of the Committee to limit the time of exercise to specified periods) as may be required to satisfy the requirements of any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 (or any successor rule) of the Exchange Act. 9 Article 8. Restricted Stock 8.1 Administration. Shares of Restricted Stock may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall determine the Employees and consultants to whom and the time or times at which grants of Restricted Stock will be awarded, the number of Shares to be awarded to any Participant (subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4), the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards, in addition to those contained in Section 8.3. The Committee may, prior to grant, condition the vesting of Restricted Stock upon continued service of the Participant. The provisions of Restricted Stock Awards need not be the same with respect to each recipient. 8.2 Awards and Certificates. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be evidenced in such manner as the Committee may deem appropriate, including book-entry registration or issuance of one or more stock certificates. Any certificate issued in respect of Shares of Restricted Stock shall be registered in the name of such Participant and shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the terms, conditions, and restrictions applicable to such Award, substantially in the following form: “The sale or other transfer of the Shares of stock represented by this certificate, whether voluntary, involuntary, or by operation of law, is subject to certain restrictions on transfer as set forth in the Tupperware Corporation 2000 Incentive Plan, and in an Award Agreement. A copy of the Plan and such Award Agreement may be obtained from Tupperware Corporation.” The Committee may require that the certificates evidencing such Shares be held in custody by the Company until the restrictions thereon shall have lapsed and that, as a condition of any Award of Restricted Stock, the Participant shall have delivered a stock power, endorsed in blank, relating to the Common Stock covered by such Award. 8.3 Terms and Conditions. Shares of Restricted Stock shall be subject to the following terms and conditions: (a) Subject to the provisions of the Plan and the Award Agreement referred to in Section 8.3(d), during the Restricted Period, the Participant shall not be permitted to sell, assign, transfer, pledge or otherwise encumber Shares of Restricted Stock. Within these limits, the Committee may provide for the lapse of restrictions based upon period of service in installments or otherwise and may accelerate or waive, in whole or in part, restrictions based upon period of service. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any Restricted Stock Award granted hereunder shall have a Restriction Period of not less than three years, except that an aggregate amount of Restricted Stock Awards not exceeding one-third of the Shares available for use as Restricted Stock Awards pursuant to Section 4.1 of the Plan may be issued without a minimum Restriction Period. (b) Except as provided in this paragraph (b) and paragraph (a), above, and the Award Agreement, the Participant shall have, with respect to the shares of Restricted Stock, all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is the subject of the Restricted Stock, including, if applicable, the right to vote the Shares and the right to receive any cash dividends. Dividends payable in Shares and other non-cash dividends and distributions shall be held subject to the vesting of the underlying Restricted Stock, unless the Committee determines otherwise in the applicable Award Agreement or makes an adjustment or substitution to the Restricted Stock pursuant to Section 4.3 in connection with such dividend or distribution. In the event that any dividend constitutes a “derivative security” or an “equity security” pursuant to Rule 16(a) under the Exchange Act, such dividend shall be subject to a vesting period equal to the longer of: (i) the remaining vesting period of the Shares of Restricted Stock with respect to which the dividend is paid; or (ii) six months. The Committee shall establish procedures for the application of this provision. 10 (c) If and when any applicable Restriction Period expires without a prior forfeiture of the Restricted Stock, unlegended certificates for such Shares shall be delivered to the Participant upon surrender of the legended certificates. (d) Each Award shall be confirmed by, and be subject to, the terms of an Award Agreement. Article 9. Performance Awards 9.1 Grant of Performance Awards. Subject to the terms of the Plan, Performance Awards may be granted to eligible Employees and consultants at any time and from time to time, as shall be determined by the Committee, and may be granted either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number, amount and timing of Awards granted to each Participant. Such Performance Awards may take the form determined by the Committee, including without limitation, cash, Shares, Performance Units and Performance Shares, or any combination thereof. Performance Awards may be awarded as short-term or long- term incentives. 9.2 Performance Goals. (a) The Committee shall set Performance Goals at its discretion which, depending on the extent to which they are met, will determine the number and/or value of Performance Awards that will be paid out to the Participants, and may attach to such Performance Awards one or more restrictions, including, without limitation, a requirement that Participants pay a stipulated purchase price for each Performance Share, or restrictions which are necessary or desirable as a result of applicable laws or regulations. Each Performance Award may be confirmed by, and be subject to, an Award Agreement. (b) The Committee shall have the authority at any time to make adjustments to Performance Goals for any outstanding Performance Awards which the Committee deems necessary or desirable unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments. 9.3 Value of Performance Units/Shares. (a) Each Performance Unit shall have an initial value that is established by the Committee at the time of grant. (b) Each Performance Share shall have an initial value equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant. 9.4 Earning of Performance Awards. After the applicable Performance Period has ended, the holder of any Performance Award shall be entitled to receive the payout earned by the Participant over the Performance Period, to be determined as a function of the extent to which the corresponding Performance Goals have been achieved, except as adjusted pursuant to Section 9.2(b) or as deferred pursuant to Article 11. 9.5 Timing of Payment of Performance Awards. Payment of earned Performance Awards shall be made in accordance with terms and conditions prescribed or authorized by the Committee. The Committee may permit the Participants to elect to defer or the Committee may require the deferral of, the receipt of Performance Awards upon such terms as the Committee deems appropriate. 11 Article 10. Beneficiary 10.1 Designation. Each Participant under the Plan may, from time to time, name any Beneficiary or Beneficiaries (who may be named contingently or successively). Each such designation shall revoke all prior designations by the same Participant, shall be in a form prescribed by the Company, and shall be effective only when filed by the Participant in writing with the Company during the Participant’s lifetime. Any such designation shall control over any inconsistent testamentary or inter vivos transfer by a Participant, and any benefit of a Participant under the Plan shall pass automatically to a Participant’s Beneficiary pursuant to a proper designation pursuant to this Section 10.1 without administration under any statute or rule of law governing the transfer of property by will, trust, gift or intestacy. 10.2 Absence of Designation. In the absence of any such designation contemplated by Section 10.1, benefits remaining unpaid at the Participant’s death shall be paid pursuant to the Participant’s will or pursuant to the laws of descent and distribution. Article 11. Deferrals The Committee may permit a Participant to elect, or the Committee may require at its sole discretion subject to the proviso set forth below, any one or more of the following: (i) the deferral of the Participant’s receipt of cash, (ii) a delay in the exercise of an Option or SAR, (iii) a delay in the lapse or waiver of restrictions with respect to Restricted Stock, or (iv) a delay of the satisfaction of any requirements or goals with respect to Performance Awards; provided, however, the Committee’s authority to take such actions hereunder shall exist only to the extent necessary to reduce or eliminate a limitation on the deductibility of compensation paid to the Participant pursuant to (and so long as such action in and of itself does not constitute the exercise of impermissible discretion under) Section 162(m) of the Code, or any successor provision thereunder. If any such deferral is required or permitted, the Committee shall establish rules and procedures for such deferrals, including provisions relating to periods of deferral, the terms of payment following the expiration of the deferral periods, and the rate of earnings, if any, to be credited to any amounts deferred thereunder. Article 12. Rights of Employees and Consultants 12.1 Employment. Nothing in the Plan shall interfere with or limit in any way the right of the Company to terminate any Participant’s employment or status as a consultant at any time, nor confer upon any Participant any right to continue in the employ of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates or to continue as a consultant. For purposes of the Plan, transfer of employment of a Participant between the Company and any one of its Subsidiaries and affiliates (or between Subsidiaries and affiliates) shall not be deemed a termination of employment. However, if a Subsidiary or affiliate of the Company ceases to be a Subsidiary or affiliate, any Participant who is no longer employed by or a consultant to the Company or one of its remaining Subsidiaries and affiliates following such event shall be considered to have terminated his or her employment or consultancy, notwithstanding any continued employment or consultancy with such former Subsidiary or affiliate. 12.2 Participation. No Employee or consultant shall have the right to be selected to receive an Award under this Plan, or, having been so selected, to be selected to receive a future Award. Article 13. Change of Control 13.1 Treatment of Outstanding Awards . Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, unless otherwise specifically prohibited under applicable laws, or by the rules and regulations of any governing governmental agencies or national security exchanges, or unless the Committee shall determine otherwise in the applicable Award Agreement: (a) Any and all Options and SARs granted hereunder shall become immediately exercisable, and shall remain exercisable throughout their entire original term, without regard to any subsequent termination of employment or consulting agreement; 12 (b) Any restriction periods and restrictions imposed on Restricted Shares that are not performance-based shall lapse; and (c) The target payout opportunities attainable under all outstanding Awards of performance-based Restricted Stock, performance- based Restricted Stock Units, Performance Units, Performance Shares, and cash-based Awards (excluding any long-term Awards issued to individual Participants and that are not broad-based programs and which are denominated in cash and paid in cash, which may be designated as “gainsharing” Awards, but not including Performance Share Awards, and which shall continue to be in effect) shall be deemed to have been earned on a pro-rata basis for that portion of the Performance Period(s) having elapsed under such outstanding Awards as of the effective date of the Change of Control. The vesting of all Awards denominated in Shares shall be deemed to have been earned on a pro-rata basis for that portion of the Performance Period(s) having elapsed under such outstanding Awards as of the effective date of the Change of Control, and there shall be paid out to Participants in cash within ten (10) days following the effective date of the Change of Control the value of such vested Shares in an amount equal to the product of the number of such vested Shares and the Fair Market Value per Share determined immediately prior to the Change of Control, based upon an assumed achievement of all relevant target performance goals. Awards denominated in cash shall be paid on a pro-rata basis to Participants in cash within ten (10) days following the effective date of the Change of Control based upon assumed achievement of all relevant target performance goals. 13.2 Termination, Amendment, and Modifications of Change-of-Control Provisions . Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan or any Award Agreement provision, the provisions of this Article 13 may not be terminated, amended, or modified in any manner that adversely affects any then-outstanding Award without the prior written consent of the Participant if such action is taken (a) on or after the date of a Change of Control or (b) at the request of a party seeking to effectuate a Change of Control or otherwise in anticipation of a Change of Control. Article 14. Amendment, Modification, and Termination 14.1 Amendment, Modification, and Termination. Except as specifically provided in Section 13.2, at any time and from time to time, the Board may terminate, amend, or modify the Plan. However, without the approval of the stockholders of the Company, no such amendment or modification may: (a) Increase the total number of Shares which may be issued under this Plan, except as provided in Article 4 hereof; or (b) Modify the eligibility requirements; or (c) Materially increase the benefits accruing under the Plan. 14.2 Awards Previously Granted. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Committee shall have the right to replace any previously granted Award under the Plan with an Award equal to the value of the replaced Award at the time of replacement, as determined by the Committee in its sole discretion, without obtaining the consent of the Participant holding such Award; provided, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing or the terms of any Award Agreement provision, the Committee shall not modify the Option Price of an Award (reprice a Stock Option) or issue new Options in exchange for the surrender of outstanding Options without shareholder approval; and provided, further, that no such replacement shall deprive the Participant of any rights he or she may have pursuant to Article 13, which shall apply to the replacement Award to the same extent as to the replaced Award. 13 Subject to the above provisions, the Board shall have authority to amend the Plan to take into account changes in law and tax and accounting rules as well as other developments, and to grant Awards which qualify for beneficial treatment under such rules without stockholder approval. Article 15. Withholding 15.1 Tax Withholding. The Company shall have the power and the right to deduct or withhold, or require a Participant to remit to the Company, an amount sufficient to satisfy federal, state, and local taxes (including the Participant’s FICA obligation) required by law to be withheld with respect to any taxable event arising under or as a result of this Plan. 15.2 Share Withholding. With respect to withholding required and/or permitted upon the exercise of Options or SARs, upon the lapse of restrictions on Restricted Stock, or upon any other taxable event hereunder, Participants may elect, subject to the approval of the Committee, to satisfy the withholding requirement, in whole or in part, by having the Company withhold Shares (or by surrendering Shares previously owned which have been held for longer than six months or purchased in the open market) having a Fair Market Value on the date the tax is to be determined equal to the minimum statutory total tax which could be imposed on the transaction. All elections shall be irrevocable, made in writing, signed by the Participant, and elections by Insiders shall additionally comply with the requirements established by the Committee. Article 16. Successors All obligations of the Company under the Plan, with respect to Awards granted hereunder, shall be binding on any successor to the Company, whether the existence of such successor is the result of a direct or indirect purchase, merger, consolidation, spin-off, or otherwise, of all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company. Article 17. Nontransferability of Awards. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, no Award shall be transferable (either by sale, pledge, assignment, gift, or other alienation or hypothecation) by a Participant other than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution. Article 18. Legal Construction 18.1 Gender and Number. Except where otherwise indicated by the context, any masculine term used herein also shall include the feminine; the plural shall include the singular and the singular shall include the plural. 18.2 Severability. In the event any provision of the Plan shall be held illegal or invalid for any reason, the illegality or invalidity shall not affect the remaining parts of the Plan, and the Plan shall be construed and enforced as if the illegal or invalid provision had not been included. 18.3 Requirements of Law. The granting of Awards and the issuance of Shares under the Plan shall be subject to all applicable laws, rules, and regulations, and to such approvals by any governmental agencies or national securities exchanges as may be required. With respect to Insiders, transactions under this Plan are intended to comply with all applicable conditions of Rule 16b-3 or its successors under the Exchange Act. To the extent any provision of the Plan or action by the Committee fails to comply with Section 18.3, it shall be deemed null and void, to the extent permitted by law and deemed advisable by the Committee. 14 Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or agreements made pursuant thereto, the Company shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificate or certificates for Shares under the Plan prior to fulfillment of all of the following conditions: (a) Listing or approval for listing upon notice of issuance, of such Shares on the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., or such other securities exchange as may at the time be the principal market for the Shares; (b) Any registration or other qualification of such Shares under any state or federal law or regulation, or the maintaining in effect of any such registration or other qualification which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion upon the advice of counsel, deem necessary or advisable; and (c) Obtaining any other consent, approval, or permit from any state or federal governmental agency which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion after receiving the advice of counsel, determine to be necessary or advisable. 18.4 Governing Law. To the extent not preempted by federal law, the Plan, and all agreements hereunder, shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware. 15 TUPPERWARE BRANDS CORPORATION 2006 INCENTIVE PLAN (as amended December 14, 2006) Exhibit 10.16 ARTICLE 1. Establishment, Purpose, and Duration 1.1. Establishment of the Plan . Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation (hereinafter referred to as the “Company”), hereby establishes an incentive compensation plan to be known as the “Tupperware Brands Corporation 2006 Incentive Plan” (hereinafter referred to as the “Plan”), as set forth in this document. The Plan permits the grant of Non-Qualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, Stock Appreciation Rights, Restricted Stock, Restricted Stock Units, Performance Awards and other stock-based and non-stock-based awards. The Plan shall become effective as of the Effective Date, and shall remain in effect as provided in Section 1.3 herein. 1.2. Purpose of the Plan . The purpose of the Plan is to promote the success and enhance the value of the Company by linking the personal interests of Participants to those of the Company’s stockholders and by providing Participants with an incentive for outstanding performance. The Plan is further intended to provide flexibility to the Company in its ability to motivate, attract, and retain the services of Participants upon whose judgment, interest, and special efforts the successful conduct of its operations largely is dependent. 1.3. Duration of the Plan . The Plan shall commence on the Effective Date and shall remain in effect, subject to the right of the Board of Directors to terminate, amend or modify the Plan at any time pursuant to Article 16 herein, until all Shares subject to it shall have been purchased or acquired according to the Plan’s provisions. ARTICLE 2. Definitions Whenever used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below and, when the meaning is intended, the initial letter of the word is capitalized: (a) “Award” means, individually or collectively, a grant under this Plan of Non-Qualified Stock Options, Incentive Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock, Restricted Stock Units, Performance Awards or other stock-based awards. (b) “Award Agreement” means an agreement entered into by each Participant and the Company, setting forth the terms and provisions applicable to Awards granted to Participants under this Plan, including without limitation, stock option agreements, SAR agreements and restricted stock agreements. (c) “Beneficial Owner” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Rule 13d-3 of the General Rules and Regulations under the Exchange Act. (d) “Beneficiary” means a person who may be designated by a Participant pursuant to Article 12 and to whom any benefit under the Plan is to be paid in case of the Participant’s death or physical or mental incapacity, as determined by the Committee, before he or she receives any or all of such benefit. (e) “Board” or “Board of Directors” means the Board of Directors of the Company. (f) “Cause” means (i) “Cause” as defined in any employment, consulting or similar agreement between the Participant and the Company or one of its Subsidiaries or affiliates (an “Individual Agreement”), or (ii) if there is no such Individual Agreement or if it does not define Cause, (A) conviction of a Participant for committing a felony under federal law or the laws of the state in which such action occurred, (B) dishonesty in the course of fulfilling a Participant’s employment duties, (C) willful and deliberate failure on the part of a Participant to perform his employment duties in any material respect, including compliance with the Company’s Code of Conduct, or (D) before a Change of Control, such other events as shall be determined by the Committee. Before a Change of Control, the Committee shall, unless otherwise provided in an Individual Agreement, have the sole discretion to determine whether “Cause” exists with respect to subclauses (A), (B) and (C) above, and its determination shall be final. (g) “Change of Control” of the Company means: i. An acquisition by any Person of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 20 percent or more of either (1) the then outstanding Shares (the “Outstanding Company Common Stock”) or (2) the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting securities of the Company entitled to vote generally in the election of Directors (the “Outstanding Company Voting Securities”); excluding, however, the following: (1) any acquisition directly from the Company, other than an acquisition by virtue of the exercise of a conversion privilege unless the security being so converted was itself acquired from the Company, (2) any acquisition by the Company, (3) any acquisition by any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or (4) any acquisition by any Person pursuant to a transaction which complies with clauses (1), (2) and (3) of subsection (iii) of this definition; or ii. A change in the composition of the Board such that the individuals who, as of the Effective Date of the Plan, constitute the Board (such Board shall be hereinafter referred to as the “Incumbent Board”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board; provided , however , for purposes of this definition, that any individual who becomes a member of the Board subsequent to such Effective Date, whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of those individuals who are members of the Board and who were also members of the Incumbent Board (or deemed to be such pursuant to this proviso) shall be considered as though such individual were a member of the Incumbent Board; but, provided further , that any such individual whose initial assumption of office occurs as a result of either an actual or threatened election contest or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a person or legal entity other than the Board shall not be so considered as a member of the Incumbent Board; or iii. The consummation of a reorganization, merger, statutory share exchange or consolidation or sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company or the acquisition of assets or stock of another entity by the Company or any of its subsidiaries or other similar transactions (“Corporate Transaction”), in each case unless, following such Corporate Transaction, (1) all or substantially all of the individuals and entities who were the Beneficial Owners, respectively, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction beneficially own, directly or indirectly, more than 50 percent of, respectively, the common stock and the combined voting power of the then-outstanding voting securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, as the case may be, of the entity resulting from such Corporate Transaction (including, without limitation, an entity which as a result of such transaction owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) in substantially the same proportions as their ownership, immediately prior to such Corporate Transaction, of the Outstanding Company Common Stock and Outstanding Company Voting Securities, as the case may be, (2) no Person (other than the Company, any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company or any corporation controlled by the Company or such entity resulting from such Corporate Transaction) beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, 20 percent or more of, respectively, the outstanding shares of Common Stock of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction or the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of such corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of Directors except to the extent that such ownership existed with respect to the Company prior to the Corporate Transaction and (3) individuals who were members of the Incumbent Board at the time of the execution of the initial agreement or of the action of the Board providing for such Corporate Transaction constitute at least a majority of the Board of Directors of the corporation resulting from such Corporate Transaction; or 2 iv. The approval by the stockholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company. (h) “Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time. (i) “Commission” means the Securities and Exchange Commission or any successor agency. (j) “Committee” means the committee described in Article 3 or (unless otherwise stated) its designee pursuant to a delegation by the Committee as contemplated by Section 3.3. (k) “Common Stock” shall mean the common stock of the Company, par value $.01 per share. (l) “Company” means Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation, or any successor thereto as provided in Article 18 herein. (m) “Covered Employee” has the meaning ascribed thereto in Section 162(m) of the Code and the regulations thereunder. (n) “Director” means any individual who is a member of the Board of Directors of the Company. (o) “Disability” means the inability of an Employee to perform the material duties of his or her occupation as determined by the Committee. (p) “Effective Date” means the date the Plan is approved by the stockholders of the Company. (q) “Employee” means any nonunion employee of the Company or of the Company’s Subsidiaries or affiliates. Directors who are not otherwise employed by the Company shall not be considered Employees under this Plan. (r) “Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time, or any successor act thereto. (s) “Fair Market Value” means, except as expressly provided otherwise, as of any given date, the closing sales price of the Common Stock during normal business hours on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or, if not listed on such exchange, on any other national securities exchange on which the Common Stock is listed or on NASDAQ. If there is no regular public trading market for such Common Stock, the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock shall be determined by the Committee in good faith. (t) “Freestanding SAR” means a SAR that is granted independently of any Options pursuant to Section 7.1 herein. (u) “Incentive Stock Option” or “ISO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is designated as an Incentive Stock Option and is intended to meet the requirements of Section 422 of the Code. (v) “Insider” shall mean an Employee who is, on the relevant date, an officer, Director, or more than ten percent (10 percent) Beneficial Owner of the Company. 3 (w) “Non-Qualified Stock Option” or “NQSO” means an option to purchase Shares, granted under Article 6 herein, which is not intended to be an Incentive Stock Option. (x) “Option” or “Stock Option” means an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-Qualified Stock Option. (y) “Option Price” means the price at which a Share may be purchased by a Participant pursuant to an Option, as determined by the Committee. (z) “Outside Director” means a member of the Board who qualifies as an outside director as defined in Rule 162(m) of the Code, as promulgated by the Internal Revenue Service (the “Service”) under the Code, or any implementing or interpretive regulations from time to time, or any successor definition adopted by the Service. (aa) “Participant” means an Employee of or a consultant to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates who has been granted an Award under the Plan. (bb) “Performance Award” means an Award granted to a Participant, as described in Article 10 herein, including Performance Units and Performance Shares. (cc) “Performance Goals” means the performance goals established by the Committee prior to the grant of Performance Awards that are based on the attainment of one or any combination of the following: specified levels of net income or earnings per share from continuing operations, operating income, revenues, return on operating assets, return on equity, stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation) and/or total stockholder return (measured in terms of stock price appreciation plus cash dividends), achievement of cost control, working capital turns, cash flow, net income, economic value added, segment profit, sales force growth, or stock price of the Company or such Subsidiary, division or department of the Company for or within which the Participant primarily renders services and that are intended to qualify under Section 162(m) (4) (c) of the Code. Such Performance Goals also may be based upon the attaining of specified levels of Company performance under one or more of the measures described above relative to the performance of other corporations. Such Performance Goals shall be set by the Committee within the time period prescribed by Section 162(m) of the Code and related regulations. (dd) “Performance Period” means a time period during which Performance Goals established in connection with Performance Awards must be met. (ee) “Performance Unit” means an Award granted to a Participant, as described in Article 10 herein. (ff) “Performance Share” means an Award granted to a Participant, as described in Article 10 herein. (gg) “Restriction Period” or “Period” means the period or periods during which the transfer of Shares of Restricted Stock is limited based on the passage of time and the continuation of service with the Company and the Shares are subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture, as provided in Article 8 herein. (hh) “Person” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in Section 3(a)(9) of the Exchange Act and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof, including a “group” as defined in Section 13(d). (ii) “Restricted Stock” means an Award granted to a Participant pursuant to Article 8 herein. (jj) “Restricted Stock Unit” means an Award granted to a Participant pursuant to Article 9 herein. 4 (kk) “Share” means a share of common stock of the Company. (ll) “Subsidiary” or “Subsidiaries” means any corporation or corporations in which the Company owns directly, or indirectly through Subsidiaries, at least twenty-five percent (25 percent) of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock, or any other entity (including, but not limited to, partnerships and joint ventures) in which the Company owns at least twenty-five percent (25 percent) of the combined equity thereof. (mm) “Stock Appreciation Right” or “SAR” means an Award, granted alone (Freestanding SAR) or in connection with a related Option (Tandem SAR), designated as a SAR, pursuant to the terms of Article 7 herein. (nn) “Tandem SAR” means a SAR that is granted in connection with a related Option pursuant to Section 7.1 herein, the exercise of which shall require forfeiture of the right to purchase a Share under the related Option (and when a Share is purchased under the Option, the Tandem SAR shall similarly be cancelled). ARTICLE 3. Administration 3.1. The Committee . The Plan shall be administered by the Compensation and Governance Committee or such other committee of the Board as the Board may from time to time designate, which shall be composed solely of not less than two Outside Directors, and shall be appointed by and serve at the pleasure of the Board. 3.2. Authority of the Committee . The Committee shall have plenary authority to grant Awards pursuant to the terms of the Plan to Employees of and to consultants to the Company and its Subsidiaries and affiliates. Among other things, the Committee shall have the authority, subject to the terms of the Plan: (a) To select the Employees and consultants to whom Awards may from time to time be granted; (b) To determine whether and to what extent Incentive Stock Options, Non-Qualified Stock Options, SARs, Restricted Stock, Restricted Stock Units, Performance Awards or other stock-based or non-stock-based awards or any combination thereof are to be granted hereunder; (c) To determine the number of Shares to be covered by each Award granted hereunder; (d) To determine (by approving the forms of Award Agreements or otherwise by resolution) the terms and conditions of any Award granted hereunder (including, but not limited to, the Option Price (subject to Section 6.4 (a)) the duration, any vesting condition, restriction or limitation (which may be related to the performance of the Participant, the Company or any Subsidiary or affiliate), any vesting acceleration or forfeiture waiver regarding any Award and the Shares relating thereto, and the impact on any Award from termination of employment (whether as a consequence of death, Disability, retirement, action by the Company, action by the Employee or Change of Control) of an Employee, or the termination of services of a consultant, based on such factors as the Committee shall determine; (e) To determine the methodology of counting Shares available for grant under the terms of the Plan. (f) To modify, amend or adjust the terms and conditions of any Award, at any time or from time to time, including but not limited to Performance Goals, unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments; and 5 (g) To determine to what extent and under what circumstances Shares and other amounts payable with respect to an Award shall be deferred. The Committee shall have the authority to adopt, alter and repeal such administrative rules, guidelines and practices governing the Plan as it shall from time to time deem advisable, to interpret the terms and provisions of the Plan and any Award issued under the Plan (and any Award Agreement relating thereto) and to otherwise supervise the administration of the Plan. 3.3. Action of the Committee . The Committee may, to the fullest extent permitted by law and subject to such limitations and procedures as may be required by law or as the Committee may deem appropriate, (i) delegate to an officer of the Company the authority to take actions or make decisions pursuant to Section 2(f), Section 3.2, Section 5.2, and Section 6.4, provided that no such delegation may be made that would cause Awards or other transactions under the Plan to cease either to be exempt from Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act or to qualify as “qualified performance-based compensation” as such term is defined in the regulations promulgated under Section 162(m) of the Code, and (ii) authorize any one or more of their members or any officer of the Company to execute and deliver documents on behalf of the Committee. 3.4. Decisions Binding . Any determination made by the Committee or pursuant to delegated authority pursuant to the provisions of the Plan with respect to any Award shall be made in the sole discretion of the Committee or such delegate at the time of the grant of the Award or, unless in contravention of any express term of the Plan, at any time thereafter. All decisions made by the Committee or any appropriately delegated officer pursuant to the provisions of the Plan shall be final and binding on all persons, including the Company and Plan Participants. ARTICLE 4. Shares Subject to the Plan 4.1. Number of Shares . Subject to adjustment as provided in Section 4.3 herein, the total number of Shares available for grant under the Plan shall be the sum of (x) 2,395,000 and (y) the number of Shares that remain available for issuance under the Tupperware Corporation 1996 Incentive Plan, the Tupperware Corporation 2000 Incentive Plan and the Tupperware Corporation 2002 Incentive Plan (collectively the “Prior Plans”). The total number of available Shares that may be used for Stock Options intended to be Incentive Stock Options, under the Plan shall be 2,395,000 Shares, the total number of available shares that may be used for Restricted Stock Awards under the Plan shall be limited to 1,197,500 and the total amount of available Shares that may be used for Performance Awards under the Plan shall be limited to 1,050,500. No Participant may be granted (i) Stock Options and Freestanding SARs in any one year covering, in the aggregate, in excess of 750,000 Shares, or (ii) Restricted Stock, Restricted Stock Units and Performance Awards in any one year in excess of 250,000 Shares. Shares subject to an Award under the Plan may be authorized and unissued Shares or may be treasury Shares. As of the Effective Date, the Company shall cease to grant awards under the Tupperware Corporation 1996 Incentive Plan, the Tupperware Corporation 2000 Incentive Plan and the Tupperware Corporation 2002 Incentive Plan (collectively the “Prior Plans”). Unused Shares available for the grant of awards under the Prior Plans shall be available for the grant of awards under the Plan and shall not be counted for purposes of determining the maximum number of Shares available for delivery under the Plan except as specified in the first sentence of this Section 4.1., and provided that any such shares shall be limited for use as Restricted Stock Awards under the Plan as they were limited under the Prior Plans. 4.2. Lapsed Awards/Withheld Shares . If any Award granted under this Plan or the Prior Plans is cancelled, forfeited, terminates, expires, or lapses for any reason (with the exception of the termination of a Tandem SAR upon exercise of the related Option or the termination of a related Option upon exercise of the corresponding Tandem SAR), any Shares subject to such Award again shall be available for the grant of an Award under the Plan. 4.3. Adjustments in Authorized Shares and Prices . In the event of any change in corporate capitalization, such as a stock split, or a corporate transaction, such as any merger, consolidation, separation, including a spin-off, or other distribution of stock or property of the Company, any reorganization (whether or not such reorganization comes within the definition of such term in Section 368 of the Code) or any partial or complete liquidation of the Company, the Committee or Board may make such substitution or adjustments in the aggregate number and class of Shares reserved for issuance under the Plan, in the number, kind and Option Price 6 of Shares subject to outstanding Stock Options or SARs, in the number and kind of Shares subject to other outstanding Awards granted under the Plan or subject to limitations such as Restricted Stock Awards or Restricted Stock Units or per-Participant maximum awards and/or such other equitable substitution or adjustments as it may determine to be appropriate in its sole discretion; provided , however , that the number of Shares subject to any Award shall always be a whole number; and provided further, however, that notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of a change in capitalization that is the result of an equity restructuring which is not the consequence of a corporate transaction with a third- party, such substitutions or adjustments shall be required to be made. Such adjusted Option Price shall also be used to determine the amount payable by the Company upon the exercise of any Tandem SAR. Such substitutions and adjustments may include, without limitation, canceling any and all Awards in exchange for cash payments based upon the value realized by shareholders generally with respect to Shares in connection with such a corporate transaction. ARTICLE 5. Eligibility and Participation 5.1. Eligibility . Persons eligible to be granted Awards under this Plan include all Employees of and all consultants to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates, and all prospective Employees of and consultants to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates, as determined by the Committee, including Employees who are members of the Board, but excluding Directors who are not Employees. 5.2. Actual Participation . Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Committee may, from time to time, select from all eligible Employees and consultants, those to whom Awards shall be granted and shall determine the nature and amount of each Award. ARTICLE 6. Stock Options 6.1. Grant of Options . Stock Options may be granted alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan and may be of two types: Incentive Stock Options and Non-Qualified Stock Options. Any Stock Option granted under the Plan shall be in such form as the Committee may from time to time approve. The Committee shall have the authority to grant any optionee Incentive Stock Options, Non- Qualified Stock Options or both types of Stock Options (in each case with or without Stock Appreciation Rights); provided , however , that grants hereunder are subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4. Incentive Stock Options may be granted only to employees of the Company and any “subsidiary corporation” (as such term is defined in Section 424(f) of the Code). To the extent that any Stock Option is not designated as an Incentive Stock Option or even if so designated does not qualify as an Incentive Stock Option, it shall constitute a Non-Qualified Stock Option. 6.2. Award Agreement . Stock Options shall be evidenced by Award Agreements, the terms and provisions of which may differ. An Award Agreement shall indicate on its face whether it is intended to be an agreement for an Incentive Stock Option or a Non-Qualified Stock Option. The grant of a Stock Option shall occur on the date the Committee by resolution selects an individual to be a Participant in any grant of a Stock Option, determines the number of Shares to be subject to such Stock Option to be granted to such individual and specifies the terms and provisions of the Stock Option, or such later date as the Committee designates. The Company shall notify a Participant of any grant of a Stock Option, and a written Award Agreement or agreements shall be duly executed and delivered by the Company to the Participant. Such agreement or agreements shall become effective upon execution by the Company and the Participant. 6.3. Incentive Stock Options . Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, no Incentive Stock Option may be granted under the Plan after the 10 th anniversary of the Effective Date. 6.4. Terms and Conditions . Stock Options granted under the Plan shall be subject to the following terms and conditions and shall contain such additional terms and conditions as the Committee shall deem desirable: (a) Stock Option Price . The Option Price per Share purchasable under a Stock Option shall be determined by the Committee and set forth in the Award Agreement, and shall not be less than the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Stock Option on the date of grant. 7 (b) Option Term . The term of each Stock Option shall be fixed by the Committee, but no Incentive Stock Option shall be exercisable more than 10 years after the date the Stock Option is granted. (c) Exercisability . Except as otherwise provided herein, Stock Options shall be exercisable at such time or times and subject to such terms and conditions as shall be determined by the Committee. If the Committee provides that any Stock Option is exercisable only in installments, the Committee may at any time waive such installment exercise provisions, in whole or in part, based on such factors as the Committee may determine. In addition, the Committee may at any time accelerate the exercisability of any Stock Option. (d) Method of Exercise . Subject to the provisions of this Article 6, Stock Options may be exercised, in whole or in part, at any time during the term of the Stock Option by giving written notice of exercise to the Company specifying the number of Shares subject to the Stock Option to be purchased. Such notice shall be accompanied by payment in full of the Option Price by certified or bank check or such other instrument as the Company may accept. Payment, in full or in part, may also be made in the form of delivery of unrestricted Shares already owned by the optionee of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option (based on the Fair Market Value of the Shares on the date the Stock Option is exercised) and, unless such Shares were acquired in the open market, held for a period of not less than six months prior to the exercise of the Stock Option, or by certifying ownership of such Shares by the Participant to the satisfaction of the Company for later delivery to the Company as specified by the Committee; provided , however , that, in the case of an Incentive Stock Option, the right to make a payment in the form of already owned Shares of the same class as the Shares subject to the Stock Option may be authorized only at the time the Stock Option is granted. In the discretion of the Committee and to the extent permitted by applicable law, payment for any Shares subject to a Stock Option may also be made pursuant to a “cashless exercise” by delivering a properly executed exercise notice to the Company, together with a copy of irrevocable instructions to a broker to deliver promptly to the Company the amount of sale or loan proceeds to pay the purchase price, and, if requested, the amount of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding taxes. To facilitate the foregoing, the Company may enter into agreements for coordinated procedures with one or more brokerage firms. No Shares shall be issued until full payment therefor has been made. An optionee shall have all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is subject to such Stock Option (including, if applicable, the right to vote the Shares and the right to receive dividends), when the optionee has given written notice of exercise and has paid in full for such Shares. (e) Restrictions on Share Transferability . The Committee may impose such restrictions on any Shares acquired pursuant to the exercise of a Stock Option under the Plan as it may deem advisable, including, without limitation, restrictions under applicable federal securities laws, under the requirements of any stock exchange or market upon which such Shares are then listed and/or traded, and under any blue sky or state securities laws applicable to such Shares. ARTICLE 7. Stock Appreciation Rights 7.1. Grant of SARs . Subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan, a SAR may be granted to an Employee or consultant at any time and from time to time as shall be determined by the Committee. The Committee may grant Freestanding SARs, Tandem SARs, or any combination of these forms of SAR. In the case of a Non-Qualified Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted either at or after the time of grant of such Stock Option. In the case of an Incentive Stock Option, Tandem SARs may be granted only at the time of grant of such Stock Option. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number of SARs granted to each Participant (subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4) and, consistent with the provisions of the Plan, in 8 determining the terms and conditions pertaining to such SARs. However, the grant price of a Freestanding SAR shall be at least equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant of the SAR. The grant price of Tandem SARs shall equal the Option Price of the related Option. SARs may not be repriced without stockholder approval. 7.2. Exercise of Tandem SARs . Tandem SARs may be exercised for all or part of the Shares subject to the related Option upon the surrender of the right to exercise the equivalent portion of the related Option. A Tandem SAR shall terminate and no longer be exercisable upon the termination or exercise of the related Stock Option. A Tandem SAR may be exercised only with respect to the Shares for which its related Option is then exercisable. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, with respect to a Tandem SAR granted in connection with an ISO: (i) the Tandem SAR will expire no later than the expiration of the underlying ISO; (ii) the value of the payout with respect to the Tandem SAR may be for no more than one hundred percent (100 percent) of the difference between the Option Price of the underlying ISO and the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the underlying ISO at the time the Tandem SAR is exercised; and (iii) the Tandem SAR may be exercised only when the Fair Market Value of the Shares subject to the ISO exceeds the Option Price of the ISO. 7.3. Exercise of Freestanding SARs . Subject to the other provisions of this Article 7, Freestanding SARs may be exercised upon whatever terms and conditions the Committee, at its sole discretion, imposes upon them. 7.4. SAR Agreement . Each SAR grant shall be evidenced by an Award Agreement that shall specify the grant price, the term of the SAR, and such other provisions as the Committee shall determine. 7.5. Term of SARs . The term of a SAR granted under the Plan shall be determined by the Committee, at its sole discretion; provided , however , that such term shall not exceed ten (10) years. 7.6. Payment of SAR Amount . Upon exercise of a SAR, a Participant shall be entitled to receive payment from the Company in an amount determined by multiplying: (a) The excess of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of exercise over the grant price of the SAR; by (b) The number of Shares with respect to which the SAR is exercised. At the discretion of the Committee, the payment upon SAR exercise may be in cash, in Shares of equivalent value, or in some combination thereof. 7.7. Rule 16-3 Requirements . Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, the Committee may impose such conditions on exercise of a SAR (including, without limitation, the right of the Committee to limit the time of exercise to specified periods) as may be required to satisfy the requirements of any rule or interpretation promulgated under Section 16 (or any successor rule) of the Exchange Act. ARTICLE 8. Restricted Stock 8.1. Administration . Shares of Restricted Stock may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall determine the Employees and consultants to whom and the time or times at which grants of Restricted Stock will be awarded, the number of Shares to be awarded to any Participant (subject to the aggregate limit on grants to individual Participants set forth in Article 4), the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards, in addition to those contained in Section 8.3. The Committee may, prior to grant, condition the vesting of Restricted Stock upon continued service of the Participant. The provisions of Restricted Stock Awards need not be the same with respect to each recipient. 9 8.2. Awards and Certificates . Shares of Restricted Stock shall be evidenced in such manner as the Committee may deem appropriate, including book-entry registration or issuance of one or more stock certificates. Any certificate issued in respect of Shares of Restricted Stock shall be registered in the name of such Participant and shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the terms, conditions, and restrictions applicable to such Award, substantially in the following form: “The sale or other transfer of the Shares of stock represented by this certificate, whether voluntary, involuntary, or by operation of law, is subject to certain restrictions on transfer as set forth in the Tupperware Brands Corporation 2006 Incentive Plan, and in an Award Agreement. A copy of the Plan and such Award Agreement may be obtained from Tupperware Brands Corporation.” The Committee may require that the certificates evidencing such Shares be held in custody by the Company until the restrictions thereon shall have lapsed and that, as a condition of any Award of Restricted Stock, the Participant shall have delivered a stock power, endorsed in blank, relating to the Common Stock covered by such Award. 8.3. Terms and Conditions . Shares of Restricted Stock shall be subject to the following terms and conditions: (a) Subject to the provisions of the Plan and the Award Agreement referred to in Section 8.3(d), during the Restricted Period, the Participant shall not be permitted to sell, assign, transfer, pledge or otherwise encumber Shares of Restricted Stock. Within these limits, the Committee may provide for the lapse of restrictions based upon period of service in installments or otherwise and may accelerate or waive, in whole or in part, restrictions based upon period of service. (b) Except as provided in this paragraph (b) and paragraph (a), above, and the Award Agreement, the Participant shall have, with respect to the shares of Restricted Stock, all of the rights of a stockholder of the Company holding the class or series of Shares that is the subject of the Restricted Stock, including, if applicable, the right to vote the Shares and the right to receive any cash dividends. Dividends payable in Shares and other non-cash dividends and distributions shall be held subject to the vesting of the underlying Restricted Stock, unless the Committee determines otherwise in the applicable Award Agreement or makes an adjustment or substitution to the Restricted Stock pursuant to Section 4.3 in connection with such dividend or distribution. (c) If and when any applicable Restriction Period expires without a prior forfeiture of the Restricted Stock, unlegended certificates for such Shares shall be delivered to the Participant upon surrender of the legended certificates. (d) Each Award shall be confirmed by, and be subject to, the terms of an Award Agreement. ARTICLE 9. Restricted Stock Units 9.1. Nature of Award . Restricted Stock Units are Awards denominated in Shares that will be settled, subject to the terms and conditions of the Restricted Stock Units, either by delivery of Shares to the Participant or by the payment of cash based upon the Fair Market Value of a specified number of Shares. Restricted Stock Units may be awarded either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall determine the Employees and consultants to whom and the time or times at which grants of Restricted Stock Units will be awarded, the number of Shares to be awarded to any Participant, the conditions for vesting, the time or times within which such Awards may be subject to forfeiture and any other terms and conditions of the Awards, in addition to those contained in Section 9.2. 9.2. Terms and Conditions . The Committee may, in connection with the grant of Restricted Stock Units, designate them as Performance Awards, in which event it shall condition the vesting thereof upon the attainment of Performance Goals. If the Committee does not designate Restricted Stock Units as Performance Awards, it may also condition the vesting thereof upon the attainment of Performance Goals. Regardless of whether Restricted Stock Units are Performance Awards, the Committee may also 10 condition the vesting thereof upon the continued service of the Participant. The applicable Award Agreement shall specify the consequences for the Restricted Stock Units of the Participant’s termination of employment. An Award of Restricted Stock Units shall be settled as and when the Restricted Stock Units vest or at a later time specified by the Committee or in accordance with an election of the Participant, if the Committee so permits. Restricted Stock Units may not be sold, assigned, transferred, pledged or otherwise encumbered until they are settled, except to the extent provided in the applicable Award Agreement in the event of the Participant’s death. The Award Agreement for Restricted Stock Units shall specify whether, to what extent and on what terms and conditions the applicable Participant shall be entitled to receive current or deferred payments of cash, Common Stock or other property corresponding to the dividends payable on the Common Stock (subject to Section 21.3 below). ARTICLE 10. Performance Awards 10.1. Grant of Performance Awards . Subject to the terms of the Plan, Performance Awards may be granted to eligible Employees and consultants at any time and from time to time, as shall be determined by the Committee, and may be granted either alone or in addition to other Awards granted under the Plan. The Committee shall have complete discretion in determining the number, amount and timing of Awards granted to each Participant. Such Performance Awards may take the form determined by the Committee, including without limitation, cash, Shares, Performance Units and Performance Shares, or any combination thereof. Performance Awards may be awarded as short-term or long- term incentives. 10.2. Performance Goals . (a) The Committee shall set Performance Goals at its discretion which, depending on the extent to which they are met, will determine the number and/or value of Performance Awards that will be paid out to the Participants, and may attach to such Performance Awards one or more restrictions, including, without limitation, a requirement that Participants pay a stipulated purchase price for each Performance Share, or restrictions which are necessary or desirable as a result of applicable laws or regulations. Each Performance Award may be confirmed by, and be subject to, an Award Agreement. (b) The Committee shall have the authority at any time to make adjustments to Performance Goals for any outstanding Performance Awards which the Committee deems necessary or desirable unless at the time of establishment of goals the Committee shall have precluded its authority to make such adjustments. 10.3. Value of Performance Units/Shares. (a) Each Performance Unit shall have an initial value that is established by the Committee at the time of grant. (b) Each Performance Share shall have an initial value equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant. 10.4. Earning of Performance Awards . After the applicable Performance Period has ended, the holder of any Performance Award shall be entitled to receive the payout earned by the Participant over the Performance Period, to be determined as a function of the extent to which the corresponding Performance Goals have been achieved, except as adjusted pursuant to Section 10.2(b) or as deferred pursuant to Article 13. 10.5. Timing of Payment of Performance Awards . Payment of earned Performance Awards shall be made in accordance with terms and conditions prescribed or authorized by the Committee. The Committee may permit the Participants to elect to defer or the Committee may require the deferral of, the receipt of Performance Awards upon such terms as the Committee deems appropriate. ARTICLE 11. Other Stock-Based Awards Other Awards of Common Stock and other Awards that are valued in whole or in part by reference to, or are otherwise based upon, Common Stock, including (without limitation) dividend equivalents and convertible debentures, may be granted under the Plan. 11 ARTICLE 12. Beneficiary 12.1. Designation . Each Participant under the Plan may, from time to time, name any Beneficiary or Beneficiaries (who may be named contingently or successively). Each such designation shall revoke all prior designations by the same Participant, shall be in a form prescribed by the Company, and shall be effective only when filed by the Participant in writing with the Company during the Participant’s lifetime. Any such designation shall control over any inconsistent testamentary or inter vivos transfer by a Participant, and any benefit of a Participant under the Plan shall pass automatically to a Participant’s Beneficiary pursuant to a proper designation pursuant to this Section 12.1 without administration under any statute or rule of law governing the transfer of property by will, trust, gift or intestacy. 12.2. Absence of Designation . In the absence of any such designation contemplated by Section 12.1, benefits remaining unpaid at the Participant’s death shall be paid pursuant to the Participant’s will or pursuant to the laws of descent and distribution. ARTICLE 13. Deferrals 13.1. Deferrals . The Committee may permit a Participant to elect, or the Committee may require at its sole discretion subject to the proviso set forth below, any one or more of the following: (i) the deferral of the Participant’s receipt of cash, (ii) a delay in the exercise of an Option or SAR, (iii) a delay in the lapse or waiver of restrictions with respect to Restricted Stock, or (iv) a delay of the satisfaction of any requirements or goals with respect to Performance Awards; provided , however , the Committee’s authority to take such actions hereunder shall exist only to the extent necessary to reduce or eliminate a limitation on the deductibility of compensation paid to the Participant pursuant to (and so long as such action in and of itself does not constitute the exercise of impermissible discretion under) Section 162(m) of the Code, or any successor provision thereunder. If any such deferral is required or permitted, the Committee shall establish rules and procedures for such deferrals, including provisions relating to periods of deferral, the terms of payment following the expiration of the deferral periods, and the rate of earnings, if any, to be credited to any amounts deferred thereunder. 13.2. Section 409A . Notwithstanding the foregoing, if any deferral permitted by this Plan or an Award Agreement or any distribution of an Award pursuant to the terms of this Plan or an Award Agreement would subject a Participant to tax under Section 409A of the Code, the Company shall modify the Plan or applicable Award Agreement in the least restrictive manner necessary in order to comply with the provisions of Section 409A, other applicable provision(s) of the Code and/or any rules, regulations or other regulatory guidance issued under such statutory provisions and, in each case, without any material diminution in the value of the payments to an affected Participant. ARTICLE 14. Rights of Employees and Consultants 14.1. Employment . Nothing in the Plan shall interfere with or limit in any way the right of the Company to terminate any Participant’s employment or status as a consultant at any time, nor confer upon any Participant any right to continue in the employ of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or affiliates or to continue as a consultant. For purposes of the Plan, transfer of employment of a Participant between the Company and any one of its Subsidiaries and affiliates (or between Subsidiaries and affiliates) shall not be deemed a termination of employment. However, if a Subsidiary or affiliate of the Company ceases to be a Subsidiary or affiliate, any Participant who is no longer employed by or a consultant to the Company or one of its remaining Subsidiaries and affiliates following such event shall be considered to have terminated his or her employment or consultancy, notwithstanding any continued employment or consultancy with such former Subsidiary or affiliate. 14.2. Participation . No Employee or consultant shall have the right to be selected to receive an Award under this Plan, or, having been so selected, to be selected to receive a future Award. 12 ARTICLE 15. Change of Control 15.1. Treatment of Outstanding Awards . Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, unless otherwise specifically prohibited under applicable laws, or by the rules and regulations of any governing governmental agencies or national security exchanges, or unless the Committee shall determine otherwise in the applicable Award Agreement: (a) Any and all Options and SARs granted hereunder shall become immediately exercisable, and shall remain exercisable throughout their entire original term, without regard to any subsequent termination of employment or consulting agreement; (b) Any restriction periods and restrictions imposed on Restricted Stock that is not performance-based shall lapse; (c) All Restricted Stock Units shall be considered to be earned and payable in full, and such Restricted Stock Units shall be settled in cash as promptly as is practicable; and (d) The target payout opportunities attainable under all outstanding Awards of performance-based Restricted Stock, performance- based Restricted Stock Units, Performance Units, Performance Shares, and cash-based Awards (excluding any long-term Awards issued to individual Participants and that are not broad-based programs and which are denominated in cash and paid in cash, which may be designated as “gainsharing” Awards, but not including Performance Share Awards, and which shall continue to be in effect) shall be deemed to have been earned on a pro-rata basis for that portion of the Performance Period(s) having elapsed under such outstanding Awards as of the effective date of the Change of Control. The vesting of all Awards denominated in Shares shall be deemed to have been earned on a pro-rata basis for that portion of the Performance Period(s) having elapsed under such outstanding Awards as of the effective date of the Change of Control, and there shall be paid out to Participants in cash within ten (10) days following the effective date of the Change of Control the value of such vested Shares in an amount equal to the product of the number of such vested Shares and the Fair Market Value per Share determined immediately prior to the Change of Control, based upon an assumed achievement of all relevant target performance goals. Awards denominated in cash shall be paid on a pro-rata basis to Participants in cash within ten (10) days following the effective date of the Change of Control based upon assumed achievement of all relevant target performance goals. 15.2. Termination, Amendment, and Modifications of Change-of-Control Provisions . Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan or any Award Agreement provision, the provisions of this Article 15 may not be terminated, amended, or modified in any manner that adversely affects any then-outstanding Award without the prior written consent of the Participant if such action is taken (a) on or after the date of a Change of Control or (b) at the request of a party seeking to effectuate a Change of Control or otherwise in anticipation of a Change of Control. ARTICLE 16. Term, Amendment, Modification, and Termination 16.1. Amendment, Modification, and Termination . Except as specifically provided in Section 15.2, at any time and from time to time, the Board may terminate, amend, or modify the Plan. However, without the approval of the stockholders of the Company, no such amendment or modification may: (a) Increase the total number of Shares which may be issued under this Plan, except as provided in Article 4 hereof; or (b) Modify the eligibility requirements; or (c) Materially increase the benefits accruing under the Plan. 13 16.2. Awards Previously Granted . Notwithstanding the foregoing, prior to a Change of Control, the Committee shall have the right to replace any previously granted Award under the Plan with an Award equal to the value of the replaced Award at the time of replacement, as determined by the Committee in its sole discretion, without obtaining the consent of the Participant holding such Award; provided , however , that notwithstanding the foregoing or the terms of any Award Agreement provision, the Committee shall not modify the Option Price of an Award (reprice a Stock Option) or issue new Options in exchange for the surrender of outstanding Options without stockholder approval; and provided , further , that no such replacement shall deprive the Participant of any rights he or she may have pursuant to Article 15, which shall apply to the replacement Award to the same extent as to the replaced Award. 16.3. Changes in Law and Tax Accounting . Notwithstanding the provisions of Sections 16.1 and 16.2, the Board shall have authority to amend the Plan to take into account changes in law and tax and accounting rules as well as other developments, and to grant Awards which qualify for beneficial treatment under such rules without stockholder approval. ARTICLE 17. Withholding 17.1. Tax Withholding . The Company shall have the power and the right to deduct or withhold, or require a Participant to remit to the Company, an amount sufficient to satisfy federal, state, and local taxes (including the Participant’s FICA obligation) required by law to be withheld with respect to any taxable event arising under or as a result of this Plan. 17.2. Share Withholding . With respect to withholding required and/or permitted upon the exercise of Options or SARs, upon the lapse of restrictions on Restricted Stock, or upon any other taxable event hereunder, Participants may elect, subject to the approval of the Committee, to satisfy the withholding requirement, in whole or in part, by having the Company withhold Shares (or by surrendering Shares previously owned which have been held for longer than six months or purchased in the open market) having a Fair Market Value on the date the tax is to be determined equal to the minimum statutory total tax which could be imposed on the transaction. All elections shall be irrevocable, made in writing, signed by the Participant, and elections by Insiders shall additionally comply with the requirements established by the Committee. ARTICLE 18. Successors All obligations of the Company under the Plan, with respect to Awards granted hereunder, shall be binding on any successor to the Company, whether the existence of such successor is the result of a direct or indirect purchase, merger, consolidation, spin-off, or otherwise, of all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company. ARTICLE 19. Nontransferability of Awards. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, no Award shall be transferable (either by sale, pledge, assignment, gift, or other alienation or hypothecation) by a Participant other than by will or by application of the laws of descent and distribution; provided, however, no Award may be transferred for value (as defined in the General Instructions to Form S-8). ARTICLE 20. Unfunded Status of Plan It is presently intended that the Plan constitute an “unfunded” plan for incentive and deferred compensation. The Committee may authorize the creation of trusts or other arrangements to meet the obligations created under the Plan to deliver Common Stock or make payments; provided, however, that unless the Committee otherwise determines, the existence of such trusts or other arrangements shall be consistent with the “unfunded” status of the Plan. 14 ARTICLE 21. Miscellaneous 21.1. Subsidiary Employees . In the case of a grant of an Award to an employee or consultant of any Subsidiary of the Company, the Company may, if the Committee so directs, issue or transfer the shares of Common Stock, if any, covered by the Award to the Subsidiary, for such lawful consideration as the Committee may specify, upon the condition or understanding that the Subsidiary will transfer the shares of Common Stock to the employee or consultant in accordance with the terms of the Award specified by the Committee pursuant to the provisions of the Plan. All shares of Common Stock underlying Awards that are forfeited or canceled should revert to the Company. 21.2. Foreign Employees and Foreign Law Considerations . The Committee may grant Awards to individuals who are eligible to participate in the plan who are foreign nationals, who are located outside the United States or who are not compensated from a payroll maintained in the United States, or who are otherwise subject to (or could cause the Company to be subject to) legal or regulatory provisions of countries or jurisdictions outside the United States, on such terms and conditions different from those specified in the Plan as may, in the judgment of the Committee, be necessary or desirable to foster and promote achievement of the purposes of the Plan, and, in furtherance of such purposes, the Committee may make such modifications, amendments, procedures, or subplans as may be necessary or advisable to comply with such legal or regulatory provisions. 21.3. Limitation on Dividend Reinvestment and Dividend Equivalents . Reinvestment of dividends in additional Restricted Stock at the time of any dividend payment, and the payment of Shares with respect to dividends to Participants holding Awards of Restricted Stock Units, shall only be permissible if sufficient Shares are available under Section 4 for such reinvestment (taking into account then outstanding Options and other Awards). ARTICLE 22. Legal Construction 22.1. Gender and Number . Except where otherwise indicated by the context, any masculine term used herein also shall include the feminine; the plural shall include the singular and the singular shall include the plural. 22.2. Severability . In the event any provision of the Plan shall be held illegal or invalid for any reason, the illegality or invalidity shall not affect the remaining parts of the Plan, and the Plan shall be construed and enforced as if the illegal or invalid provision had not been included. 22.3. Requirements of Law . The granting of Awards and the issuance of Shares under the Plan shall be subject to all applicable laws, rules, and regulations, and to such approvals by any governmental agencies or national securities exchanges as may be required. With respect to Insiders, transactions under this Plan are intended to comply with all applicable conditions of Rule 16b-3 or its successors under the Exchange Act. To the extent any provision of the Plan or action by the Committee fails to comply with this Section 22.3, it shall be deemed null and void, to the extent permitted by law and deemed advisable by the Committee. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or agreements made pursuant thereto, the Company shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificate or certificates for Shares or uncertificated forms of Shares under the Plan prior to fulfillment of all of the following conditions: (a) Listing or approval for listing upon notice of issuance, of such Shares on the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., or such other securities exchange as may at the time be the principal market for the Shares; (b) Any registration or other qualification of such Shares under any state or federal law or regulation, or the maintaining in effect of any such registration or other qualification which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion upon the advice of counsel, deem necessary or advisable; and (c) Obtaining any other consent, approval, or permit from any state or federal governmental agency which the Committee shall, in its absolute discretion after receiving the advice of counsel, determine to be necessary or advisable. 15 22.4. Governing Law . To the extent not preempted by federal law, the Plan, and all agreements hereunder, shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the State of Delaware. 16 Subsidiaries of Tupperware Brands Corporation As of February 26, 2007 Exhibit 21 Academia de Negocios S/C Ltda. Armand Dupree, Inc. Auburn River Realty Company Avroy Shlain Cosmetics (Botswana) (Pty) Ltd. Avroy Shlain Cosmetics (Namibia) (Pty) Ltd. Avroy Shlain Cosmetics (Pty) Ltd. BBVA Bancomer Trust BC International Cosmetic & Image Services, Inc. BeautiControl Canada, Ltd BeautiControl Cosmeticos do Brasil Ltda. BeautiControl International Services, Inc. BeautiControl Mexico, S. de R.L. BeautiControl, Inc. Centro de Distribuicao Mineira de Produtos de Plastico Ltda. Centro de Distribuicao RS Ltda. Centro Oeste Distribuidora de Produtos Plasticos Ltda. CH Laboratories Pty Ltd (Australia) Confecciones Champion S de RL de CV Control International Investments (ConSecFin) B.V. Corcovado-Plast Distribuidora de Artigos Domesticos Ltda. Cosmetic Manufacturers (Malaysia) Pty. Ltd. (Australia) Dart (Philippines), Inc. Dart Argentina S.A. Dart de Venezuela, C.A. Dart do Brasil Industria e Comercio Ltda. Dart Far East Sdn. Bhd. Dart Holdings, S. de R.L. Dart Industries (New Zealand) Limited Dart Industries Hong Kong Limited Dart Industries Inc. Dart Manufacturing India Pvt. Ltd. Dart, S.A. de C.V. Dartco Manufacturing Inc. Daypar Participacoes Ltda Deerfield Land Corporation Diecraft Australia Pty. Ltd. Direct Selling Business of SL Vendeta Directa do Brasil Ltda Distribuidora Baiana de Produtos Plasticos Ltda Distribuidora Comercial Nordeste de Produtos Plasticos Ltda. Distribuidora Comercial Paulista de Plasticos Ltda. 1 Active Subsidiaries Subsidiary Information System As of December 30, 2006 Distribuidora Esplanada de Produtos Plasticos Ltda Eixo Sul Brasileiro de Artigos Domesticos Ltda. Eventus International, Inc. Fuller Brands BV Fuller Cosmetics SA de CV HOF Newco Philippines House of Fuller Argentina SA (Argentina) House of Fuller Holdings S de RL de CV (Mexico) House of Fuller S de RL de CV (Mexico) Immobiliaria Meck-Mex SA de CV International Investor, Inc. Japan Tupperware Co., Ltd. JLH Properties, Inc. Latin America Investments, Inc. NaturCare Holding YK NaturCare Japan KK Newco Logistica e Participacoes Ltda. NM Holdings (New Zealand) NM Operations Pty. Ltd. (Australia) Nuage Cosmetics (Botswana) (Proprietary) Ltd. Nuage Cosmetics (Proprietary) Ltd. (Swaziland) NuMet Holdings Pty. Ltd. (Australia) Nutrimetics France Holdings SNC Nutrimetics France SNC Nutrimetics International (Australia) Pty Ltd Nutri-Metics International (Brunei) Sdn. Bhd Nutri-metics International (Greece) A.E. Nutrimetics International (NZ) Ltd. (New Zealand Nutri-Metics International (Thailand) Ltd. Nutrimetics International (UK) Limited Nutri-metics Worldwide (M) Sdn. Bhd. (Malaysia) Nuvo Cosmeticos S.A. (Uruguay) Premiere Korea Ltd. Premiere Manufacturing, Inc. Premiere Products Mexico, S. de R.L. Premiere Products, Inc. Probemex SA de CV Probmex Consultoria, S de RL de CV PT Tupperware Indonesia Sara Lee Mexicana Holdings S de RL de CV Sara Lee Mexicana, SA de CV Sara/Lee DE Holdings SA Pty. Ltd (South Africa) Servicios Administrativos Sara Lee S de RL de CV 2 Active Subsidiaries Subsidiary Information System As of December 30, 2006 Swissgarde (Uganda) Ltd. Swissgarde (Zambia) (Proprietary) Ltd Swissgarde (Kenya) Ltd. Swissgarde (Namibia) (Proprietary) Ltd. Swissgarde (Proprietary) Ltd. (South Africa) Swissgarde (Tanzania) Ltd Swissgarde Lesotho (Pty) Ltd. The Tupperware Foundation Tupperware (China) Company Limited Tupperware (Portugal) Artigos Domesticos, Lda. Tupperware (Suisse) SA Tupperware (Thailand) Limited Tupperware Articulos Domesticos, S.L. Tupperware Asia Pacific Holdings Private Limited Tupperware Assets Management Sarl Tupperware Australia Pty. Ltd. Tupperware Belgium N.V. Tupperware Bulgaria EOOD Tupperware Canada Inc. Tupperware Childrens Foundation Tupperware China, LLC Tupperware Corporation Tupperware Czech Republic, spol. s.r.o. Tupperware d.o.o. Tupperware de Costa Rica, S.A. Tupperware de El Salvador, S.A. de C.V. Tupperware de Guatemala, S.A. Tupperware Del Ecuador Cia. Ltda. Tupperware Deutschland GmbH Tupperware Distributors, Inc. Tupperware Egypt Ltd Tupperware Espana, S.A. Tupperware Export Sales, Ltd. Tupperware Factors Inc. Tupperware Finance Company B. V. Tupperware Finance Holding Company B.V. Tupperware France S.A. Tupperware General Services N.V. Tupperware Global Center SARL Tupperware Hellas S.A.I.C. Tupperware Holdings Corporation Tupperware Holdings Ltd. Tupperware Home Parties Corporation Tupperware Honduras, S. de R.L. Tupperware Iberica S.A. 3 Active Subsidiaries Subsidiary Information System As of December 30, 2006 Tupperware India Private Limited Tupperware International Capital Limited Tupperware International Holdings BV Tupperware International Holdings Corporation Tupperware Israel Ltd. Tupperware Italia S.p.A. Tupperware Luxembourg S.ar.l. Tupperware Morocco Tupperware New Zealand Staff Superannuation Plan Tupperware Nordic A/S Tupperware Osterreich G.m.b.H. Tupperware Panama, S.A. Tupperware Philippines, Inc. Tupperware Polska Sp.z.o.o Tupperware Products S.A. Tupperware Products, Inc. Tupperware Realty Corporation Tupperware Services GmbH Tupperware Services, Inc. Tupperware Singapore Pte. Ltd. Tupperware Slovakia s.r.o. Tupperware Southern Africa (Proprietary) Limited Tupperware Southern Europe,Africa and Middle East, S.L. Tupperware Subsidiary Holdings, Inc. (DE) Tupperware Trading Ltd. Tupperware Turkey, Inc. Tupperware U.K. Holdings, Inc. Tupperware U.S., Inc. Tupperware United Kingdom & Ireland Limited Tupperware Uruguay S.A. Tupperware, Industria Lusitana de Artigos Domesticos, Limitada Tupperware, Ltd. Tupperware.com, Inc. TWP S.A. Uniao Norte Distribuidora de Produtos Plasticos Ltda Vlijmense Belegging-Maatschappij BV (Netherlands) All subsidiaries listed above are included in the consolidated financial statements of the Registrant as consolidated subsidiaries, except for subsidiaries owned 50% or less. 4 CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-12125) and Form S-8 (Nos. 333- 137275, 333-137276, 333-111530, 333-48650, 333-04869, 333-04871, 333-18331 and 333-50012) of Tupperware Corporation of our report dated February 26, 2007 relating to the financial statements, financial statement schedule, management’s assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, which appears in this Form 10-K. Exhibit 23 PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP Orlando, Florida February 26, 2007 POWERS OF ATTORNEY Exhibit 24 KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned directors of Tupperware Brands Corporation, a Delaware corporation, (the “Corporation”), hereby constitute and appoint Thomas M. Roehlk and Michael S. Poteshman, true and lawful attorneys-in- fact and agents of the undersigned, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for and in the name, place and stead of the undersigned, in any and all capacities, to sign the Annual Report on Form 10-K of the Corporation for its fiscal year ended December 30, 2006, and any and all amendments thereto, and to file or cause to be filed the same, together with any and all exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents and substitutes, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite or necessary to be done in and about the premises as fully to all intents and purposes as the undersigned might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents and substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have hereunto set their hand and seal this 23rd day of February, 2007. /s/ Catherine A. Bertini Catherine A. Bertini /s/ Rita Bornstein Rita Bornstein /s/ Kriss Cloninger III Kriss Cloninger III /s/ Clifford J. Grum Clifford J. Grum /s/ Joe R. Lee Joe R. Lee /s/ Bob Marbut Bob Marbut /s/ Angel R. Martinez Angel R. Martinez /s/ Robert J. Murray Robert J. Murray /s/ David R. Parker David R. Parker /s/ Joyce M. Roché Joyce M. Roché /s/ J. Patrick Spainhour J. Patrick Spainhour /s/ M. Anne Szostak M. Anne Szostak EXHIBIT 31.1 I, E.V. Goings, certify that: 1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Tupperware Brands Corporation; RULE 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) CERTIFICATIONS 2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; 3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; 4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have: (a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; (b) Designed such internal controls over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; (c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and (d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and 5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent function): (a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and (b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting. Date: February 28, 2007 /s/ E.V. Goings E.V. Goings Chairman and Chief Executive Officer EXHIBIT 31.2 I, Michael S. Poteshman, certify that: 1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Tupperware Brands Corporation; RULE 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) CERTIFICATIONS 2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; 3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; 4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have: (a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; (b) Designed such internal controls over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; (c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and (d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and 5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent function): (a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and (b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting. Date: February 28, 2007 /s/ Michael S. Poteshman Michael S. Poteshman Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer Form of Certification Pursuant to Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code EXHIBIT 32.1 I, E.V. Goings, certify that, to the best of my knowledge, (i) the Form 10-K for the year ended December 30, 2006 fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and (ii) the information contained in such Form 10-K fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of Tupperware Brands Corporation. A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906 has been provided to Tupperware Brands Corporation and will be retained by Tupperware Brands Corporation and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request. /s/ E.V. Goings Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Form of Certification Pursuant to Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code EXHIBIT 32.2 I, Michael S. Poteshman, certify that, to the best of my knowledge, (i) the Form 10-K for the year ended December 30, 2006 fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and (ii) the information contained in such Form 10-K fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of Tupperware Brands Corporation. A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906 has been provided to Tupperware Brands Corporation and will be retained by Tupperware Brands Corporation and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request. /s/ Michael S. Poteshman Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

Continue reading text version or see original annual report in PDF format above